Loading...
Specifications T R A N S M I T T A L 9 fin IN H Montgomery Watson Harza 111 SW 5`h Ave., Suite 1770 Portland, Oregon p Date: July 20, 2005 C + ®'l Tel: 503-226-7377 JUL 21 2005 Fax: 503-226-0023 CITY OF TIGARD BUILDING DIVISION To: Val Henzel From: Brian Schultz,POR-1T ) City of Tigard—Plans Examination 13125 SW.Hall Blyd. • • - Tigard, OR 97223 503.718.2436 The following items are: Requested x Enclosed Sent Separately via Report k Specification Cost Estimate Shop Drawings Test Result. Prints Test Sample x Other No. of Description Copies 1 Updated versions of specifications submitted on December 27, 2004 and April 27, 2005. 1 Copy of MWH Response No. 1 to Miller Consulting Engineers'comments on April 27, 2005. This data is submitted: ' x At your request For your action For your approval x For your files For your review For your information 65 Hello Val, .0.- • \ Arb.� This package contains updated versions of all specific u e et r d t City •of Tigard. In the initial submission on December 27, 2005, there was a sectioN4S �. m Ladders that no longer exists. This has been combined with Section 05500—Miscellanb _4% ork. S-CJdg-7 PA � Thanks, C Brian PT....,, . . ._ . .. SECTION 01300 - CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 GENERAL A. Wherever submittals are required in the Contract Documents, submit them to the ENGINEER. 1.2 PRECONSTRUCTION CONFERENCE SUBMITTALS A. Within 14 Days after the date of commencement as stated in the Notice to Proceed or at the preconstruction conference of Section 01010 - Summary of Work, whichever comes first, the CONTRACTOR shall submit the following items to the ENGINEER for review: 1. A preliminary list of Shop Drawings, Samples, and proposed Substitutes. 2. A preliminary schedule for submission of priority and major Shop Drawings (particularly for long-lead time equipment) and Samples. 3. A list of permits and licenses the CONTRACTOR shall obtain, indicating the agency required to grant the permit, the expected date of submittal for the permit, and required date for receipt of the permit. 4. A preliminary schedule of values in accordance with Section 01301 - Schedule of Values. poo 5. A 60-Day Plan of Operation in accordance with Section 01311 - CPM Construction Schedule. 6. A Project Overview Bar Chart in accordance with Section 01311 - CPM Construction Schedule. 7. Security Management Plan in accordance with Section 01520 — Security. 8. Stormwater Management and Erosion Control Plan and Schedule in accordance with Section 01570 — Stormwater Pollution Prevention. 9. CONTRACTOR submittals in accordance with Section 02140 — Dewatering, Paragraph 1.3. 1.3 SHOP DRAWINGS A. Wherever called for in the Contract Documents or where required by the ENGINEER, the CONTRACTOR shall furnish to the ENGINEER for review, eight"copies plus one reproducible copy or electronic file, of each Shop Drawing submittal. Shop Drawings may include detail design calculations, shop-prepared drawings, fabrication and installation drawings, erection drawings, lists, graphs, catalog sheets, data sheets, and similar items. If a list, graph, catalog sheet, data sheet, etc. includes more that one item, clearly mark which item is the subject of the submittal. Shop drawings shall bear the signature and seal of an engineer registered in the appropriate branch and in the state of Oregon, unless otherwise indicated. Whenever the CONTRACTOR is required to submit \ , design calculations as part of a submittal, such calculations shall bear the signature and MWH-04082005 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS 153075— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01300-1 seal of an engineer registered in the appropriate branch and in the state of Oregon, unless otherwise indicated. B. Shop Drawing submittals shall be accompanied by the ENGINEER's standard submittal transmittal form, a reproducible copy of which is available from the ENGINEER. A submittal without the form or where applicable items on the form are not completed will be returned for resubmittal. C. Organization 1. A single submittal transmittal form shall be used for each technical specification section or item or class of material or equipment for which a submittal is required. A single submittal covering multiple sections will not be acceptable, unless the primary specification references other sections for components. Example: if a pump section references other sections for the motor, shop-applied protective coating, anchor bolts, local control panel, and variable frequency drive, a single submittal would be acceptable. A single submittal covering vertical turbine pumps and horizontal split case pumps would not be acceptable. 2. On the transmittal form, index the components of the submittal and insert tabs in the submittal to match the components. Relate the submittal components to specification paragraph and subparagraph, Drawing number, detail number, schedule title, room number, or building name, as applicable. 3. Unless indicated otherwise,'terminology and equipment names and numbers used in submittals shall match those used in the Contract Documents. D. Format 1. Minimum sheet size shall be 8.5 inches by 11 inches. Maximum sheet size shall be 22 inches by 34 inches. Every page in a submittal shall be numbered in sequence. Each copy of a submittal shall be collated and stapled or bound, as appropriate. The ENGINEER will not collate sheets or copies. 2. Where product data from a manufacturer is submitted, clearly mark which model is proposed, with complete pertinent data capacities, dimensions, clearances, diagrams, controls, connections, anchorage, and supports. Sufficient level of detail shall be presented for assessment of compliance with the Contract Documents. 3. Each submittal shall be assigned a unique number. Submittals shall be numbered sequentially, and the submittal numbers shall be clearly noted on the transmittal. Original submittals shall be assigned a numeric submittal number (e.g., 25). If submittal "25" requires a resubmittal, the first resubmittal will bear the designation "25.A" and the second resubmittal will bear the designation "25.B" and so on. 4. If there is a follow-up submittal related to a previously submitted class of material or type of equipment (e.g., follow-up submittal to submittal "25"), it shall be assigned the number "25.1". If submittal "25.1" requires a resubmittal, the first resubmittal will bear the designation "25.1.A" and the second resubmittal will bear the designation "25.1.B" and so on. E. Disorganized submittals that do not meet the requirements of the Contract Documents will be returned without review. MWH-04082005 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS 153075 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01300-2 ' F. Except as may otherwise be indicated, the ENGINEER will return prints of each submittal to the CONTRACTOR with comments noted thereon, within 21 Days following ot receipt by the ENGINEER. It is considered reasonable that the CONTRACTOR will make a complete and acceptable submittal to the ENGINEER by the first resubmittal on an item. The OWNER reserves the right to withhold monies due to the CONTRACTOR to cover additional costs of the ENGINEER's review beyond the first resubmittal. . The ENGINEER'S maximum review period for each submittal or resubmittal will be 21 Days. G. If a submittal is returned to the CONTRACTOR marked "NO EXCEPTIONS TAKEN," formal revision and resubmission will not be required. H. If a submittal is returned marked "MAKE CORRECTIONS NOTED," CONTRACTOR shall make the corrections on the submittal, but formal revision and resubmission will not be required, except where Section 01660 — Equipment Testing and Plant Startup and { Section 01700 — Project Closeout require otherwise. I. If a submittal is returned marked "AMEND-RESUBMIT," the CONTRACTOR shall revise it and shall resubmit the required number of copies to the ENGINEER for review. Resubmittal of portions of multi-page or multi-drawing submittals will not be allowed. For example, if a Shop Drawing submittal consisting of 10 drawings contains one drawing noted as "AMEND - RESUBMIT," the submittal as a whole is deemed "AMEND - RESUBMIT," and 10 drawings are required to be resubmitted. J. If a submittal is returned marked "REJECTED-RESUBMIT," it shall mean either that the proposed material or product does not satisfy the specification, the submittal is so incomplete that it cannot be reviewed, or is a substitution request not submitted in accordance with the General Conditions and Section 01600 - Products, Materials, Equipment, and Substitutions. In the first 2 cases, the CONTRACTOR shall prepare a new submittal and shall submit the required number of copies to the ENGINEER for review. In the latter case, the CONTRACTOR shall submit the substitution request according to the General Conditions and Section 01600 — Products, Materials, Equipment and Substitutions. K. Resubmittal of rejected portions of a previous submittal will not be allowed. Every change from a submittal to a resubmittal or from a resubmittal to a subsequent resubmittal shall be identified and flagged on the resubmittal. L. Fabrication of an item may commence only after the ENGINEER has reviewed the pertinent submittals and returned copies to the CONTRACTOR marked either "NO EXCEPTIONS TAKEN" or "MAKE CORRECTIONS NOTED". Corrections indicated on submittals shall be considered as changes necessary to meet the requirements of the Contract Documents and shall not be taken as changes to the Contract requirements. . M. Submittals shall be carefully reviewed by an authorized representative of the CONTRACTOR prior to submission to the ENGINEER. Each submittal shall be dated and signed by the CONTRACTOR as being correct and in strict conformance with the Contract Documents. In the case of Shop Drawings, each sheet shall be so dated and signed. Any deviations from the Contract Documents shall be noted by the CONTRACTOR on the transmittal form and such deviation shall be subject to approval in writing by the ENGINEER and OWNER. The ENGINEER will only review submittals that have been so verified by the CONTRACTOR. Non-verified submittals will be returned to the CONTRACTOR without action taken by the ENGINEER, and any delays caused thereby shall be the total responsibility of the CONTRACTOR. MWH-04082005 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS 153075 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01300-3 N. Corrections or comments made on the CONTRACTOR's Shop Drawings during review do not relieve the CONTRACTOR from compliance with Contract Drawings and Specifications. Review is for conformance to the design concept and general compliance with the Contract Documents only. The CONTRACTOR is responsible for confirming and correlating quantities and dimensions, fabrication processes and techniques, coordinating WORK with the trades, and satisfactory and safe performance of the WORK. 1.4 SAMPLES A. The CONTRACTOR shall submit the number of samples indicated by the Specifications. If the number is not indicated, submit not less than 3 samples. Where the amount of each sample is not indicated, submit such amount as necessary for proper examination and testing by the methods indicated. B. Samples shall be individually and indelibly labeled or tagged, indicating the salient physical characteristics and manufacturer's name. Upon acceptance by the ENGINEER, one set of the samples will be stamped and dated by the ENGINEER and returned to the CONTRACTOR, one set of samples will be retained by the ENGINEER, and one set shall remain at the Site in the ENGINEER's field office until completion of the WORK. C. Unless indicated otherwise, the ENGINEER will select colors and textures from the manufacturer's standard colors and standard materials, products, or equipment lines. If certain samples represent non-standard colors, materials, products, or equipment lines that will require an increase in Contract Times or Price, the CONTRACTOR shall clearly state so on the transmittal page of the submittal. D. The CONTRACTOR shall schedule sample submittals such that: 1. Sample submittals for color and texture selection are complete so the ENGINEER has 45 Days to assemble color panels and select color and texture dependent products and materials without delay to the construction schedule, and 2. After the ENGINEER selects colors and textures, the CONTRACTOR has sufficient time to provide the products or materials without delay to the construction schedule. The Contract Times will not be extended for the CONTRACTOR's failure to allow enough review and approval or selection time, failure to submit complete samples requiring color or texture selection, or failure to submit complete or approvable samples. 1.5 TECHNICAL OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE INFORMATION A. The CONTRACTOR shall submit technical operation and maintenance (O&M) information for each item of mechanical, electrical, and instrumentation equipment in an organized manner as specified in Section 01730- O&M Information and in the Technical Specifications of the Contract Documents. O&M information, instructions and data shall be provided for each maintainable material and piece of equipment. It shall be written so that it can be used and understood by the OWNER's operation and maintenance staff. B. Schedule 1. Except where indicated otherwise, technical O&M information shall be submitted in initial draft form to the ENGINEER not later than 90 Days prior to any startup, system testing or operator training. Subsequent drafts shall be provided by the MWH-04082005 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS 153075—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01300-4 CONTRACTOR within 30 Days from the date of CONTRACTOR's receipt of review comments from the ENGINEER. The approved Operation and Maintenance :" Manual must be available prior to any startup, system testing, or operator training. The CONTRACTOR's attention is drawn to Section 01700 — Project Closeout where the submission of the Operation and Maintenance Manual is related to progress payments. 1.6 RECORD DOCUMENTS A. The CONTRACTOR shall maintain one set of Drawings at the Site for the preparation of record drawings. On these, it shall mark every project condition, location, configuration, and any other change or deviation which may differ from the Contract Drawings at the time of award, including buried or concealed construction and utility features that are revealed during the course of construction. Special attention shall be given to recording the horizontal and vertical location of buried utilities that differ from the locations indicated, or that were not indicated on the Contract Drawings. Said record drawings shall be supplemented by any detailed sketches as necessary or as CONTRACTOR is directed, to fully indicate the WORK as actually constructed. These record drawings are the CONTRACTOR's representation of as-built conditions, and shall be maintained up- to-date during the progress of the WORK. Using erasable colored pencils (not ink or indelible pencil), indicate in green when showing information deleted from the Drawings, red when showing information added to the Drawings, and blue and circled in blue to show notes. Notes shall identify relevant Change Orders by number and date. Preparation of record drawings shall conform to the following: 1. Date entries. 2. Call attention to entry by"cloud" drawn around area or areas affected. 3. Legibly mark to record actual changes made during construction, including, but not limited to: • • a. Depths of various elements of foundation in relation to finished first floor data if not shown or where depth differs from that shown. b. Horizontal and vertical locations of existing new Underground Facilities and appurtenances, and other underground structures, equipment, or WORK. Reference to at least two measurements to permanent surface improvements. c. Location of internal utilities and appurtenances concealed in the construction referenced to visible and accessible features of the structure. d. Locate existing facilities, piping, equipment, and items critical to the interface between physical conditions or construction and new construction. e. Changes made by Addenda and Field Orders, Work Change Directives, Change Orders, Written Amendments, and ENGINEER's written interpretations and clarifications using consistent symbols for each and showing appropriate document tracking number. 4. Dimensions of Schematic Layouts: Show record drawings, by dimension, the centerline of each run of items such as are described in previous subparagraph above. MWH-04082005 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS 153075—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01300-5 If a. Clearly identify the item by accurate not such as "cast iron drain," "galv. water," and the like. ' l b. Show, by symbol or note, vertical location of item ("under slab," "in ceiling plenum," "exposed," and the like. c. Make identification so descriptive that it may be related reliably to Specifications. B. The CONTRACTOR shall maintain one set of Specifications at the Site for the preparation of record specifications. On these shall be recorded every change or deviation during the course of the project resulting from Work Change Directives, Field Orders, Substitutions, RFIs or and other reason. Record specifications shall be marked with green, red and blue pencils in the same manner as record drawings, noting the document or other reason that caused the change. C. Prior to submitting each Application for Payment, request ENGINEER's review and approval of current status of record documents. Failure to properly maintain, update, and submit record documents may result in a deferral by ENGINEER to recommend whole or any part of CONTRACTOR's Application for Payment, either partial or final. D. In the case of those drawings that depict the detail requirement for equipment to be assembled and wired in the factory, such as motor control centers and the like, the record drawings shall be updated by indicating those portions which are superseded by change order drawings or final Shop Drawings, and by including appropriate reference information describing the change orders by number and the Shop Drawings by manufacturer, drawing, and revision numbers. E. Disorganized or incomplete record documents will not be accepted. The CONTRACTOR shall revise them and resubmit within 10 Days. F. Record documents shall be accessible to the ENGINEER during the construction period and shall be provided to the OWNER prior to requesting final payment. G. The request for final payment will not be accepted until the record documents have been completed and delivered to the ENGINEER. H. Information submitted by the CONTRACTOR will be assumed to be correct, and the CONTRACTOR shall be responsible for the accuracy of such information. 1.7 QUALITY CONTROL (QC) SUBMITTALS A. Quality control submittals are defined as those required by the Specifications to present documentary evidence to the ENGINEER that the CONTRACTOR has satisfied certain requirements of the Contract Documents. B. Unless otherwise indicated, QC submittals shall be submitted: 1. Before delivery and unloading, for the following types of submittals: a. Manufacturers' installation instructions b. Manufacturers' and Installers' experience qualifications MWH-04082005 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS 153075- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01300-6 c. Ready mix concrete delivery tickets d. Design calculations e. Affidavits and manufacturers' certification of compliance with indicated product requirements f. Laboratory analysis results g. Factory test reports 2. For the following types of submittals, the manufacturer's field representative shall submit a draft certification prior to leaving the Project site and a final certification within 7 days of the event documented: a. Manufacturers' field representative certification of proper installation 3. Within 30 Days of the event documented for the following types of submittals: a. Field measurement b. Field test reports c. Receipt of permit d. Receipt of regulatory approval C. The ENGINEER will record the date that a QC submittal was received and review it for compliance with submittal requirements, but the review procedures above for Shop Drawings and samples will not apply. 1.8 LEED SUBMITTAL REQUIREMENTS A. The CONTRACTOR shall submit information in accordance with Section 01351 — LEED Certification and as required in Divisions 01 through 17. 1.9 DEFERRED SUBMITTAL TO THE CITY OF TIGARD A. For the purposes of this section, Deferred Submittals are defined as those portions of the Project that are CONTRACTOR-designed and must be submitted to the City of Tigard building official for approval and to meet Building Permit plan review requirements. B. The ENGINEER will schedule a pre-submittal conference with the CONTRACTOR and City of Tigard building official to discuss proposed Deferred Submittal items, requirements, and review schedule. C. The CONTRACTOR shall list the Deferred Submittals on the title or cover sheet of the Drawings for submission to the City of Tigard and shall state the design criteria/assumptions of the Deferred Submittal items on the plans. Deferred Submittals shall include details for connection of materials to the structure and calculations showing that the specified structural requirements are met. MWH-04082005 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS 153075—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01300-7 D. The CONTRACTOR shall submit Deferred Submittals to the ENGINEER for review for general conformance to the design of the structure. Neither the OWNER nor the ENGINEER is responsible for coordination of Deferred Submittal components with Contract Documents. Review does not lessen nor shift burden of responsibility from CONTRACTOR or assigned subcontractor/supplier to the OWNER or ENGINEER. The ENGINEER, upon confirming the Deferred Submittals are in general conformance with the design, shall forward the Deferred Submittals to the building official. CONTRACTOR is responsible, with no exceptions, to ensure that City of Tigard's Deferred Submittal review will not adversely affect Project's construction schedule. The Deferred Submittal items shall not be installed by the CONTRACTOR until the design and Deferred Submittals have been approved by the building official. E. Anticipated Deferred Submittals include but are not limited to: 1. Acoustic ceiling system. 2. Exit illumination. • 3. Glazing systems. 4. Metal guardrails and handrails. 5. Pre-cast concrete structural members or panels. 6. Prefabricated stair units to include steel, aluminum or pre-cast concrete. 7. Prefabricated wall panel. 8. Signs. 9. Skylights. 10. Specialty retaining walls. 11. Stone veneer. 12. Steel roof trusses and steel canopies. 13. Louvers. 14. Equipment supports. 15. Anchorages. 1.10 INFORMATIONAL SUBMITTALS . . . A. Informational submittals formalize the flow of information between the CONTRACTOR and the ENGINEER. Forms will be employed for such purpose. Paper or electronic copies of blank forms may be obtained from the ENGINEER. B. The following forms may be used but the list is not necessarily inclusive: CM - 205 Allocation of Total Contract Price CM - 302 Request for Clarification MWH-04082005 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS 153075 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01300-8 I�t CM - 306 Contractor's Submittal Transmittal Form CM - 307 Memorandum of Delay CM - 432 Deactivation Request CM - 427 Manufacturer's Certification of Proper Installation CM - 503 Request for Shutdown CM - 1001 Monthly Payment Estimate Summary CM - 1003 Request for Payment for Material on Hand CM - 1004 Request for Adjustment of Retainage CM - 1005 Consent of Surety for Reduction of Partial Release of Retainage CM - 1006 Consent of Surety for Final Payment CM - 1007 Affidavit of Payment CM - 1101 Field Order CM - 1102 Initiator Change Order Request CM - 1106 Deviation Request CM - 1110 Substitution Request Form CM - 1202 Contractor's Certification of Completion CM - 1301 Partial Waiver of Lien CM - 1302 Final Waiver of Lien CM - 1303 Affidavit of Release of Lien 1.11 CONSTRUCTION PHOTOGRAPHS A. CONTRACTOR shall provide aerial photographs every 30 days from the Notice to Proceed until Substantial Completion and one at final payment. The photographs provided for review shall include six vertical photographs and six oblique photographs as directed by the ENGINEER. Each photograph shall include the entire Project Site. unless directed by the ENGINEER. B. ENGINEER may then choose two photographs for enlargement. ENGINEER will choose the cropping areas. The cropped area will be developed to 8-inch by 10-inch photographs. C. The two photo negatives chosen will be provided in an electronic format on a CD for use on Windows-based system. The digital image shall be a 2,000 dpi negative scan. D. Oblique photographs shall be taken with a medium format camera. Vertical photographs shall be taken with 9 by 9 mapping area. E. Photography shall be by a professional commercial photographer, experienced in shooting aerial photographs, in good and inclement weather. F. Film handling and development shall be done by a commercial laboratory. G. The photographs and the negatives shall become the property of OWNER for OWNER's use. H. Digital Images: 1. Archive using a commercially available photo management system. 2. Label each disk with Project and OWNER's name, and week and year images were produced. MWH-04082005 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS 153075— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01300-9 PART 2-- PRODUCTS (NOT USED) PART 3 -- EXECUTION (NOT USED) - END OF SECTION - • MWH-04082005 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS 153075- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01300-10 SECTION 01450 - SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. This specification section is intended to inform the CONTRACTOR of the OWNER's quality assurance program and the extent of the CONTRACTOR's responsibilities. 1.2 SCHEDULE OF INSPECTIONS/OBSERVATIONS A. Required inspections and tests are described in Appendix A - "Schedule of Special Inspections" following this specification, and in the individual Specification Sections for the items to be inspected or tested. B. Required Structural Observations are described in Appendix B - "Schedule of Structural Observations" following this specification. 1.3 DEFINITIONS A. Approved Agency: An established and recognized agency regularly engaged in conducting tests or furnishing inspection services, when such agency has been approved by the Building Official. B. Approved Fabricator: An established and qualified person, firm, or corporation approved by the Building Official. Approval is based on written procedural and quality control manuals and periodic auditing of fabrication practices by an approved special inspection agency. C. Building Official: Local department or representatives responsible for enforcing local codes and reviewing construction documents and issuing permits for the erection, alteration, demolition, and moving of buildings and structures. D. Continuous Special Inspection: The full-time observation of WORK by an approved special inspector who is present in the area where the WORK is being performed. E. Fabricated Item: Structural, load bearing or lateral load-resisting assemblies consisting of materials assembled prior to installation in a building or structure, or subjected to operations such as heat treatment, thermal cutting, cold working or reforming after manufacture and prior to installation in the building or structure. Materials produced in accordance with standard specifications referenced in the Contract Documents or the local governing codes, such as rolled structural steel shapes, steel-reinforcing bars, masonry units and plywood sheets, shall not be considered "fabricated items". F. Periodic Special Inspection: The part-time or intermittent observation of WORK by an approved special inspector who is present in the area where the WORK has been or is being performed and at the completion of the WORK. G. Special Inspection: Inspection as herein required of the materials, installation, fabrication, erection or placement of components and connections requiring special expertise to ensure compliance with the Contract Documents and referenced standards. H. Special Inspector: An agency regularly engaged in conducting tests and furnishing inspection services. The special inspector is an authorized representative of the MWH - 04082005 SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01450-1 ENGINEER who provides inspections during construction. The Special Inspector shall be approved/registered by the local Building Official. I. Structural Observer: Registered design professional and authorized representative of the ENGINEER, who provides structural observation services during construction. J. Structural Observation: Visual observation by a structural observer of the structural system for general conformance to the Contract Documents at significant construction stages and at completion of the structural system. Structural observation does not include or waive the responsibility for the inspections required by the Contract Documents. 1.4 SUBMITTALS A. The CONTRACTOR and Subcontractors, whose work will be inspected or tested, shall disclose any past or present business relationship or potential conflict of interest with the Special Inspector and Testing Laboratory. B. When fabrication of assemblies that would otherwise require special inspection is done on an approved fabricators premises, the following shall be submitted: 1. At completion of fabrication, the approved fabricator shall submit to the, CONTRACTOR, ENGINEER and the building official a certificate of compliance stating that the WORK was performed in accordance with the approved construction documents. 1.5 PAYMENT A. The OWNER shall engage and pay for the services of the Special Inspector, Agents of the Special Inspector, Testing Laboratory, and Structural Observer. B. The CONTRACTOR shall be responsible for the cost of any re-testing or re-inspection of work that fails to comply with the requirements of the Contract Documents. 1.6 CONTRACTOR RESPONSIBILITIES A. The CONTRACTOR shall cooperate with the Special Inspector, his agents, and the Structural Observer, so that the special inspections, observation, and testing may be performed without hindrance. B. The CONTRACTOR shall review the "Schedule of Special Inspections" - Appendix A, "Schedule of Structural Observations" - Appendix B, and individual specification sections and shall be responsible for coordinating and scheduling inspections, observations, and tests. The CONTRACTOR shall notify the Special Inspector, Testing Laboratory, or Structural Observer at least 48 hours in advance of a required inspection, observation, or test. C. Failure by the CONTRACTOR to meet observation, inspection, or testing schedules may require removal of any subsequent work for observation, inspection and testing. Removal and replacement of any finished work and/or framing damaged by the removal process or as required for corrective action shall be at the CONTRACTOR's expense. Uninspected WORK that required inspection may be rejected solely on that basis. D. The CONTRACTOR shall provide incidental labor and facilities to provide access to the WORK to be inspected, observed, or tested, to obtain and handle samples at the site or MWH-04082005 SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01450-2 at source of products to be tested, to facilitate tests, observations, inspections, storage, and curing of test samples. E. The CONTRACTOR shall keep at the project site the latest set of construction drawings, field sketches, change orders, approved shop drawings, and specifications for use by the Special Inspector and Structural Observer. F. The Special Inspection and observation program shall in no way relieve the CONTRACTOR of its obligation to perform WORK in accordance with the requirements of the Contract Documents or from implementing an effective Quality Control program. The CONTRACTOR's quality control personnel shall first review all work that is to be subjected to Special Inspections or Structural Observation. G. The CONTRACTOR shall be solely responsible for construction site safety. H. Prior to the beginning of construction, the CONTRACTOR shall have a pre-construction meeting with the ENGINEER, Building Official, CONTRACTOR, OWNER, Special Inspector, Structural Observer, and Testing Laboratories, to review the special inspection and structural observation requirements. 1.7 INSPECTION OF FABRICATIONS A. When WORK is done on the premises of an approved fabricator, special inspection is not required. 1.8 RECORDS AND REPORTS A. The Special Inspector shall prepare detailed daily reports of each special inspection or test. B. The Structural Observer shall prepare detailed reports of each structural observation. C. Any discrepancies from the Contract Documents found during a special inspection or structural observation shall be immediately reported to the CONTRACTOR. If the discrepancies are not corrected the Special Inspector or Observer shall notify the ENGINEER and Building Official. Reports shall document all discrepancies identified and the corrective action taken. D. FINAL REPORTS OF SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1. The "Final Report of Special Inspections" shall be completed by the Special Inspector and submitted to the ENGINEER and Building Official prior to the issuance of a Certificate of Use and Occupancy. 2. The "Final Report of Special Inspections" will certify that all required inspections have been performed and will itemize any discrepancies that were not corrected or resolved. 3. The "Final Structural Observation Report" will certify that site visits have been made and identify any reported deficiencies, which, to the best of the Structural Observer's knowledge, have not been resolved. MWH - 04082005 SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01450-3 PART 2 -- PRODUCTS (NOT USED) PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 Prior to the commencement of the WORK the CONTRACTOR will be advised of the name of the testing laboratory, and the firms to be obtained to perform the special inspections, and structural observations. • MWH - 04082005 SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01450-4 APPENDIX A - SCHEDULE OF SPECIAL INSPECTIONS - Required inspections and tests are described in the following "Schedule of Special Inspections", and in the individual Specification Sections for the items to be inspected or tested. 1. FABRICATORS A. Where fabrication of structural load-bearing members and assemblies is being performed on the premises of a fabricator's shop, the fabricator shall be registered and approved to perform such work without special inspection. Approval shall be based upon review of the fabricator's written procedural and quality control manuals and periodic auditing of fabrication practices by an approved special inspection agency. 2. STEEL CONSTRUCTION A. Welding inspection shall be in compliance with AWS D1.1. B. The Special Inspector shall perform an inspection of the steel to verify compliance with the details shown on the approved construction documents, such as bracing, stiffening, members' locations and proper application of joint details at each connection. C. Installation of high-strength bolts shall be periodically inspected in accordance with AISC specifications and IBC requirements. 1) While the work is in progress, the special inspector shall determine that the requirements for bolts, nuts, washers, and paint; bolted parts; and installation and tightening in such standards are met. 2) For bolts requiring pretensioning, the special inspector shall observe the pre- installation testing and calibration procedures when such procedures are required by the installation method or by the Contract Documents; determine that all plies of connected materials have been drawn together and properly snugged; and monitor the installation of bolts to verify that the selected procedure for installation is properly used to tighten bolts. For joints required to be tightened only to the snug tight condition, the special inspector need only verify that the connected materials have been drawn together and properly snugged. 3) Monitoring of bolt installation for pretensioning is permitted to be performed on a periodic basis when using the turn-of-nut method with matchmarking techniques, the direct tension indicator method, or the alternate design faster (twist-off bolt) method. Joints designed as snug tight need be inspected only on a periodic basis. 4) Monitoring of bolt installation for pretensioning using the calibrated wrench method or the turn-of-nut method without matchmarking shall be performed on a continuous basis. D. Cold-formed steel framing shall have the following special inspections: 1) Periodic special inspections during welding operations of elements of the seismic- force-resisting system. 2) Periodic special inspections for screw attachment, bolting, anchoring and other fastening of components within the seismic-force-resisting system, including struts, braces, and hold-downs. MWH -04082005 SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01450-5 REQUIRED VERIFICATION AND INSPECTION OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION Inspection Verification And Inspection Continuous Periodic Referenced Standards Material verification of high-strength X Applicable ASTM material bolts, nuts, and washers: specifications; • Identification markings to conform to ASTM standards indicated in AISC ASD, Section A3.4; the Contract Documents. • Manufacturer's certificate of AISC LRFD, Section A3.3 compliance required. Inspection of high-strength bolting: AISC LRFD Section M 2.5 • Bearing-type constructions. X • Slip-critical connections. X X IBC 1704.3.3 Material verification of structural steel: • Identification markings to conform ASTM A 6 or ASTM 568 to ASTM standards indicated in the Contract Documents. IBC 1708.4 • Manufacturer's certified mill test reports required. Material verification of weld filler materials: • Identification markings to conform AISC, ASD, Section A3.6; to AWS specification indicated in the Contract Documents. AISC LRFD, Section A3.5 • Manufacturer's certificate of compliance required. Inspection of welding - Structural steel: • Complete and partial penetration X groove welds. )41'i • Multi-pass fillet welds. X S • Single-pass fillet welds > 5/16" X AWS D1.1 (7.9 mm). • Single-pass fillet welds < 5/16" X AISC Seismic (7.9 mm). • Welded studs when used for X AWS D1.3 structural diaphragms. • Welded sheet steel for cold- X IBC 1704.3 formed steel framing members such as studs and joists. • Welding of stairs and railing X systems. • Floor and deck welds. X Inspection of welding - Reinforcing AWS D1.4 steel: • Verification of weldability of X ACI 318 - 3.5.2 reinforcing steel other than ASTM A 706 IBC 1903.5.2 MWH - 04082005 SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01450-6 Inspection Verification And Inspection Continuous Periodic Referenced Standards 1 • Reinforcing steel-resisting flexural X and axial forces in intermediate and special moment frames, and boundary elements of special reinforced concrete shear walls, and shear reinforcement. • Shear reinforcement. X • Other reinforcing steel. X Inspection of steel frame joint details X for compliance with the Contract Documents: • Details such as bracing and IBC 1704.3.2 stiffening. • Member locations. • Application of joint details at each connection. 3. CONCRETE CONSTRUCTION REQUIRED VERIFICATION AND INSPECTION OF CONCRETE CONSTRUCTION Verification And Inspection Inspection Referenced Standards Continuous Periodic Inspection of reinforcing steel, X ACI 318 - 3.5, 7.1-7.7 including prestressing tendons, and placement. IBC 1903.5, 1907.1, 1907.7 & 1914.4 Inspection of reinforcing steel welding AWS D1.4 in accordance with inspection of steel table above. ACI 318 - 3.5.2 IBC 1903.5.2 Inspect bolts to be installed in X - concrete prior to and during IBC 1912.5 placement of concrete where allowable loads have been increased. Verifying use of required design mix. X ACI 318 - Ch. 4 & 5.2-5.4 IBC 1904,1905.2-1905.4, 1914.2 & 1914.3 Sampling fresh concrete and X ASTM C 172 performing slump, air content and determining the temperature of fresh ASTM C 31 concrete at the time of making specimens for strength tests. ACI 318 - 5.6, 5.8 IBC 1905.6 & 1914.10 Inspection of concrete and shotcrete X ACI 318 - 5.9 & 5.10 placement for proper application techniques. IBC 1905.9, 1905.10, 1914.6, 1914.7& 1914.8 MWH - 04082005 SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01450-7 Verification And Inspection Inspection Referenced Standards Continuous Periodic 4 _ Inspection for maintenance of X ACI 318 - 5.11-5.13 specified curing temperature and techniques. IBC 1905.11, 1905.13 & 1914.9 Inspection of prestressed concrete: • Application of prestressing forces. X • Grouting of bonded prestressing X ACI 318 - 18.18 & 18.16.4 tendons in the seismic-force- resisting system. Erection of precast concrete X ACI 318 - Ch. 16 members. Verification of in-situ concrete X strength, prior to stressing of tendons ACI 318 - 6.2 in posttensioned concrete and prior to removal of shores and forms from IBC 1906.2 beams to structural slabs. Adhesive anchor installation. X Per ICBO Report 4. MASONRY CONSTRUCTION REQUIRED VERIFICATION AND INSPECTION OF MASONRY CONSTRUCTION Verification And Inspection Inspection' Referenced Standards Continuous Periodic From the beginning of masonry construction, the following shall be verified to ensure compliance: • Proportions of site-mixed mortar X ACI 530 Sec. 1.12.3 and grout. • Placement of masonry units and X ACI 530.1 Art. 2.6A, 3.2D, construction of mortar joints. 3.3B, 3.4 & 3.5 • Placement of reinforcement and X connectors. • Grout space prior to grouting. X • Placement of grout. X The inspection program shall verify: ACI 530 Sec. 1.15.4, 2.1.2, • Size and location of structural X 1.12, 2.1.8.6 & 2.1.8.6.2 elements. • Type, size and location of X ACI 530.1 Art. 3.3G, 2.4, 3.4 anchors, including other details of & 1.8 anchorage of masonry to structural members frames or IBC 2108.9.2.11 Item 2, other construction. 2104.2 & 2104.4 • Specified size, grades, and types X of reinforcement. • Welding of reinforcing bars X MWH - 04082005 SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01450-8 Verification And Inspection Inspection' Referenced Standards Continuous Periodic • Protection of masonry during cold X weather (temperature below 40 degrees F) or hot weather (temperatures above 90 degrees F) Preparation of any required grout X ACI 530.1 Art. 1.4 specimens, mortar specimens, and/or prisms shall be observed. IBC 2105.3, 2105.4 & 2105.5 Compliance with required inspection X provisions of the Contract Documents ACI 530.1 Art. 1.5 and the approved submittals shall be verified. Adhesive Anchor Installation X Per ICBO Report 5. SOILS A. Site Preparation: Prior to placement of the prepared fill, the special inspector shall determine that the site has been prepared in accordance with the approved soils report and the Contract Documents. B. During Fill Placement: During placement and compaction of the fill material, the Special Inspector shall determine that the material being used and the maximum lift thickness comply with the approved soils report and the Contract Documents. C. Evaluation of In-Place Density: The Special Inspector shall determine, at the specified frequency, that the in-place dry density of the compacted fill complies with the approved 41, soils report and the Contract Documents. 6. PILE /PILE FOUNDATIONS A. A Special Inspector shall be present when pile foundations are being installed and during tests. The special inspector shall make records of the installation of each pile and results of load tests. Records shall include the cutoff and tip elevation of each pile relative to a permanent reference. B. Special inspection is required for pier foundations. 7. WALL PANELS AND VENEERS A. Special inspection is required for exterior and interior architectural wall panels and the anchoring of veneers for buildings. Special inspection of such masonry veneer shall be in accordance with the inspection of masonry above. 8. SPRAYED FIRE-RESISTANT MATERIALS A. Special inspection for sprayed fire-resistant materials applied to structural elements and decks shall be in accordance with [IBC Sections 1704.11.1 through .1704.11.5.] Special inspection shall be based on the fire-resistance design as designated in the Contract Documents. B. The following items shall be inspected: 1) The prepared surface of structural members to be sprayed shall be inspected before the application of the sprayed fire-resistant material. 2) The application of the sprayed fire-resistant material shall be in accordance the manufacture's written instructions and the Contract Documents. MWH - 04082005 SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, ,IPS PAGE 01450-9 3) Special Inspector shall verify that the average thicknesses of the sprayed fire- resistant materials are not less than the required thickness. 4) Density of the sprayed fire-resistant material shall not be less then specified. 5) The cohesive/adhesive bond strength of the cured sprayed fire-resistant material. ■ MWH - 04082005 SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01450-10 9. EXTERIOR INSULATION AND FINISH SYSTEMS (EIFS) A. Special inspections shall be required for all EIFS applications. 10.SMOKE CONTROL SYSTEMS A. Smoke control systems shall be tested by a Special Inspector B. Tests shall consist of leakage testing and recording of device locations during erection of ductwork and prior to concealment. C. Pressure difference testing, flow measurements, and detection and control verification shall be tested prior to occupancy and after sufficient completion. 11.MECHANICAL AND ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS A. Periodic special inspections are required for the following per IBC 1707.7: 1) During the anchorage of electrical equipment for emergency or standby power systems. 2) During the anchorage of other electrical equipment. 3) During installation of piping systems intended to carry flammable, combustible or highly toxic contents and their associated mechanical units. 4) During the installation of HVAC ductwork that will contain hazardous materials. 5) Installation of equipment using combustible energy sources. 6) Installation of electrical motors, transformers, switchgear unit substations and motor control centers. 7) Reciprocating and rotating-type machinery. 8) Piping distribution systems 3-inches and larger. 9) Tanks, heat exchangers, and pressure vessels. 12.MISCELLANEOUS ITEMS A. The following items shall receive periodic special inspections: 1) Access floors during anchorage. 2) Storage racks 8 feet or greater in height during the anchorage. 3) Exterior cladding during erections and fastening. 4) Interior and exterior nonload bearing walls during erection and fastening. 5) Veneer during erection and fastening. 6) Suspended ceiling systems and their anchorage. 7) Isolator and energy dissipation devices during the fabrication and installation if used as part of the seismic isolation system. MWH - 04082005 SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01450-11 APPENDIX B - SCHEDULE OF STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS Required observations are described in the following "Schedule of Structural Observations". When to do the Observation What to Observe FOUNDATIONS Prior to the first concrete pour, but after Review areas of particular concern such as placement of reinforcing is well under way highly congested areas or any mechanically coupled splices and check that approved placing plans are being used. Review anchor bolt placement and placement of hold-down bolts or steel embeds. STEEL FRAMING After the first tier has been erected and Observe the work in progress and try to plumbed and bolt tightening and joint meet with the special inspectors for the welding is under way welding and bolt tightening operations. Pay particular attention to the procedures used for welding of moment frame joints. After one level of steel deck is in place and Check the welding procedures have been welding of shear studs is underway. qualified by the inspector on the job. CONCRETE CONSTRUCTION Prior to close-up of the first level column or Go , wall forms. For concrete moment frames, after Meet with the special inspector to make placement of reinforcement has started sure the inspection is continuous and that and again prior to close-up of column or the inspector is aware of the critical areas beam forms. around the joints. Establish lines of communication to assure notification regarding field problems such as reinforcement interference or utility penetrations in critical areas. During placement of slab/beam/joist The engineer may elect to personally reinforcement or post-tensioning tendons. observe concrete placement for critical structural elements. MASONRY CONSTRUCTION During lay-up of the first section of wall Special inspection may not include full time with special reinforcement requirements, inspection of lay-up or reinforcement such as boundary elements placement, so it may be important to verify that reinforcement is placed with the appropriate positioners. Prior to grouting of the first lift. Verify that the special inspector is performing the required special inspections and that elements for connection of other framing are in place. -- END OF SECTION -- MWH -04082005 SPECIAL INSPECTIONS AND STRUCTURAL OBSERVATIONS 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 01450-12 SECTION 02834- SEGMENTAL RETAINING WALLS PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall design, furnish and construct mechanically stabilized earth segmental retaining wall system having high molecular weight, high tenacity polyester geogrids positively connected to Segmental Concrete Blocks. Work shall be done in accordance with these specifications and in reasonably close conformity with the lines, grades, design and dimensions shown on the plans. B. Work includes preparing foundation soil, furnishing and installing leveling pad, unit drainage fill and backfill to the lines and grades shown on the construction drawings. C. Work includes furnishing and installing geogrid soil reinforcement of the type, size, location, and lengths designated on the construction drawings. 1.2 REFERENCE DOCUMENTS A. American Society for Testing and Materials (ASTM) 1. C-1372 Standard Specification for Segmental Retaining Wall Units 2. C-140-91 Method of Sampling and Testing Concrete Masonry Units 3. C-150-94 Specification for Portland Cement 4. C-33-93 Specification for Concrete Aggregates 5. C-595/C595M Specification for Blended Hydraulic Cement 6. C-90-93 Specification for Load-bearing Concrete Masonry Units 7. D-123 Standard Terminology Relating to Textiles 8. D-422 Gradation of Soils 9. D-424 Atterburg Limit of Soils 10. D-698 Test method for Laboratory Compaction Characteristics of Soil Using Standard Effort 11. D-5262 Test Method for Evaluating the Unconfined Tension Creep Behavior of Geosynthetics 12. D-4355 Test Method for Deterioration of Geotextiles from Exposures to Ultraviolet Light and Moisture 13. D-4439 Standard Terminology for Geosynthetics 14. D-4595 Test Method for Tensile Properties of Geotextiles by the Wide Strip Method MWH - 04082005 SEGMENTAL RETAINING WALLS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 02834-1 15. D-3034 Polyvinyl Chloride Pipe (PVC) 16. D-1248 Corrugated Plastic Pipe B. Geosynthetic Research Institute (GRI) 1. GG-1 Standard Test Method for Geogrid Rib Tensile Strength 2. GG-4 Standard Practice for Determination of Long Term Design Strength of Geosynthetic Reinforcements 3. GG-5 Standard Test Method for Determination of Geogrid Pullout C. National Concrete Masonry Association (NCMA) 1. NCMA Design Manual for Segmental Retaining Walls, Second Edition 2. NCMASRWU-1 - Determination of Connection Strength between Geosynthetics and Segmental Concrete Units 3. NCMASRWU-2 - Determination of Connection Strength between Segmental Concrete Units 1.3 SUBMITTALS/CERTIFICATION A. CONTRACTOR shall submit a Manufacturer's certification, prior to start of work, that the retaining wall system components meet the requirements of this specification and the structure design. B. CONTRACTOR shall submit shop drawings and design calculations for the retaining wall system prepared and stamped by a Professional Engineer registered in the State of Oregon. The engineering designs, techniques, and material evaluations shall be in accordance with the Manufacturer's Design Manual and NCMA Design Guidelines For Segmental Retaining Walls. 1. Shop Drawings — Shop Drawings shall include, but not be limited to: a. General notes providing necessary information on design and construction of the retaining wall b. Materials and quantity summary list showing all items of each wall, including incidental items. c. Plan View showing the construction centerline and related horizontal curve data, the offset from the construction centerline to the face of the wall at all changes in horizontal alignment, and the centerline of any utility or drainage structure or pipe that is behind or passes under or through the wall. The Plan View shall also indicate the soil reinforcement limits. d. Elevation View showing the elevation at the top of the wall at all horizontal and vertical break points. The Elevation View shall indicate the type and size of facing components; the length, size, and number of soil reinforcements; and the distance along the face of the wall to where changes in the length of the soil reinforcement occur. MWH - 04082005 SEGMENTAL RETAINING WALLS 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 02834-2 e. Typical Sections showing wall construction, limits of backfill, and soil reinforcement limits. f. Structural and Geometric Details including, but not limited to, loading conditions, footing and/or leveling pad details, final front face batter. Show all dimensions and details necessary to construct the soil reinforcements. g. Show all details for appurtenances not detailed in the plans, including connections to concrete barriers, coping, parapets, soundwalls, fences, and attached lighting. Show all details for construction around utility and drainage facilities or other structures. For facing components, show all dimensions, including thickness; all details necessary to construct the facing components; all reinforcing steel in the component; and the location of tensile soil reinforcement attachment devices embedded in the facing. Show the type of concrete finish. 2. Design Calculations — Design calculations shall include, but not be limited to: a. General: Include wall geometry, soil parameters, and both permanent and temporary design loads, including applied loads from vehicular traffic, guardrail, pavement, and concrete barrier. b. External Stability Calculations: Indicate factors of safety against sliding and overturning. c. Foundation Bearing Pressure Calculations: Indicate the factor of safety against foundation bearing failure and calculate anticipated settlement. d. Internal Stability: Indicate reduction factors and factors of safety against soil reinforcement rupture, pullout, and facing connection strength. e. Local Stability: Indicate factors of safety against sliding and bulging of segmental retaining wall facing units. C. CONTRACTOR shall submit a test report documenting strength of specific modular concrete unit and geogrid reinforcement connection. The maximum design tensile load of the geogrid shall be equal to the laboratory tested ultimate strength of geogrid /facing unit connection at a maximum normal force limited by the "Hinge Height" of the structure divided by a safety factor of 1.5. The connection strength evaluation shall be performed in accordance with NCMA test method SRWU-1. D. Field Construction Manual — The field construction manual shall be prepared by the provider of the proprietary retaining wall selected, and shall provide step-by-step directions for constructing the retaining wall. E. LEED Product Data 1. Credit MR 4: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. 2. Credit MR 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting manufacturing locations for products manufactured within a 500-mile radius of the • project site. MWH - 04082005 SEGMENTAL RETAINING WALLS 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 02834-3 3. Credit MR 5.2: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting location of extraction, recovery or harvest for materials contained in products addressed in item 2 above that originated within a 500-mile radius of the project. 1.4 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. CONTRACTOR shall submit certification, prior to start of work, that the retaining wall system (modular concrete units and specific geogrid): 1. has been successfully utilized on a minimum of 5 similar projects, i.e., height, soil fill types, erection tolerances, etc.; and 2. has been successfully installed on a minimum of 250,000 square feet of retaining walls. C. Construction: CONTRACTOR performing work in this section shall have a minimum of 5 years experience and have constructed at least 25,000 square feet of segmental concrete retaining walls on projects of like scope. When requested, evidence of experience, noting project, owner, and design professional shall be furnished to the OWNER or OWNER's agent. D. Testing: An independent testing lab shall be required to test the select fill material to determine suitability of material for the project and shall conduct compaction tests for each layer of fill material at the rate of at least 1 test per 5 feet of lift. E. Provide for a field representative from the selected retaining wall manufacturer to be present at the start of retaining wall construction for a minimum of 1 day and during construction of the 19 foot high east retaining wall for a minimum of 2 days. 1.5 DELIVERY, STORAGE AND HANDLING A. CONTRACTOR shall check all materials upon delivery to assure that the proper type, grade, color, and certification has been received. B. CONTRACTOR shall protect all materials from damage due to jobsite conditions and in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations. Damaged materials shall not be incorporated into the work. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 DEFINITIONS A. Geosynthetic terms not defined in this section may be found in ASTM D123 or ASTM D4439. B. Segmental Concrete Block: A concrete retaining wall element machine made from portland cement, water, and aggregates. C. Geogrid: A structural element formed by a regular network of integrally connected tensile elements with apertures of sufficient size to allow interlocking with surrounding (.�j soil, rock, or earth and function primarily as reinforcement. MWH -04082005 SEGMENTAL RETAINING WALLS 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 02834-4 D. Class B MSE Granular Backfill: Backfill material with a specific gradation that is intended for use in conjunction with extensible tensile reinforcements. E. Class C MSE Granular Backfill: Backfill material with a specific gradation that is intended for use in a zone beneath a spread footing. F. Unit Fill: Free-draining, coarse granular crushed rock or crushed gravel which is placed within, between and behind the Segmental Concrete Blocks. G. Reinforced Backfill: Compacted soil, which is placed within the reinforced soil volume as outlined on the plans. 2.2 SEGMENTAL CONCRETE BLOCK A. Segmental Concrete Block shall conform to the following architectural requirements: 1. General — segmental concrete blocks shall be of the interlocking design, with one homogeneous concrete pour having one long and one short face without blemishes or chips. Blocks shall have 3 inch chamfered edges designed to provide 8 square inches of drainage area per block. 2. Face color - concrete gray - standard manufacturers' color may be specified by the ENGINEER. 3. Face finish - sculptured rock face. Other face finishes will not be allowed without written approval of ENGINEER. 4. Interlocking — each segmental concrete block shall be designed with two cross keyways equidistant from the ends and sides to provide maximum shear capacity. The blocks shall have a male/female key combination that allows the blocks to be locked parallel or perpendicular to each other. Keyways shall have +1/2" tolerance for easy installation. 5. Exposed surfaces of units shall be free of chips, cracks or other imperfections when viewed from a distance of 10 feet under diffused lighting. B. Segmental Concrete Block materials shall conform to the requirements of ASTM C1372 - Standard Specifications for Segmental Retaining Wall Units. C. Modular concrete units shall conform to the following structural and geometric requirements measured in accordance with appropriate references: 1. Compressive strength = 2500 psi minimum. 2. Absorption = 8 % maximum (6% in northern states) for standard weight aggregates. 3. Dimensional tolerances = ± 1/8" from nominal unit dimensions not including rough split face, ±1/16" unit height - top and bottom planes. 4. Unit size — 29.5" (H) x 59" (W) x 29.5" (D) minimum. 5. Unit weight - 4000-lbs./unit minimum for standard weight aggregates. 6. Inter-unit shear strength - 1500 plf minimum at 2 psi normal pressure. MWH- 04082005 SEGMENTAL RETAINING WALLS 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 02834-5 7. Materials — segmental concrete block shall be manufactured with returned/surplus concrete (post consumer waste); air entrainment is not required. 8. Geogrid/unit peak connection strength - 1000 plf minimum at 2 psi normal force. 9. Each segmental concrete block shall be furnished with a 7 strand steel (270 Kpa) loop lifting eye located in the center of the standard block between the two crossed keyways. Steel rebar is unacceptable as a lifting eye. D. Segmental Retaining Wall Block shall be Lock-Block M.S.E. Wall Systems by Ultrablock , Inc. E. No or equal. 2.3 CONNECTORS A. Shear connectors shall be capable of holding the geogrid in the proper design position during grid pre-tensioning and backfilling. B. Shear connectors to geogrid connection strength: 1000 plf 2.4 BASE LEVELING PAD MATERIAL A. Construct a leveling pad at each foundation level as shown. Material shall consist of a compacted crushed stone base or non-reinforced concrete as shown on the Drawings. 2.5 UNIT FILL A. Unit fill shall consist of clean 1" minus crushed stone or crushed gravel meeting the following gradation tested in accordance with ASTM D-422: Sieve Size Percent Passing • 1 inch 100 3/4 inch 75-100 No. 4 0 - 10 No. 50 0 - 5 B. One cubic foot, minimum, of drainage fill shall be used for each square foot of wall face. Drainage fill shall be placed within cores of, between, and behind units to meet this requirement. 2.6 REINFORCED BACKFILL A. Reinforced backfill shall be free of debris and meet the following gradation tested in accordance with ASTM D-422: Sieve Size Percent Passing 2 inch 100-75 3/4 inch 100-75 No. 40 0-60 No. 200 0-35 Plasticity Index (PI) <15 and Liquid Limit <40 per ASTM D-4318. MWH- 04082005 SEGMENTAL RETAINING WALLS 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 02834-6 B. The maximum aggregate size shall be limited to 3/4 inch unless field tests have been performed to evaluate potential strength reductions to the geogrid design due to damage during construction. C. Material can be site-excavated soils where the above requirements and the requirements of Section 02200 - Earthwork Type 6 (Select Native Material) can be met. Unsuitable soils for backfill (medium to high plastic clays, silts, or organic soils) shall not be used in the backfill or in the reinforced soil mass. D. CONTRACTOR shall submit reinforced fill sample and laboratory test results to the ENGINEER for approval prior to the use of any proposed reinforced fill material. E. Where backfilling of retaining walls interferes with backfilling of IPS, materials for IPS backfill shall govern as shown on the Drawings and in Section 02200 - Earthwork. 2.7 GEOGRID SOIL REINFORCEMENT A. Refer to Section 02274— Geotextiles. B. Geosynthetic reinforcement shall consist of geogrids manufactured specifically for soil reinforcement applications and shall be manufactured from high tenacity polyester yarn . Polyester geogrid shall be knitted from high tenacity polyester filament yarn with a molecular weight exceeding 25,000 Meg/m and a carboxyl end group values less than 30. Polyester geogrid shall be coated with an impregnated PVC coating that resists peeling, cracking, and stripping. C. LTDS, Long Term Allowable Tensile Design Load, of the geogrid material shall be determined as follows: LTDS = Tult/ (RFcr x RFd x Rfid x FS) LTDS shall be evaluated based on a 75-year design life. 1. Tult, Short Term Ultimate Tensile Strength. Tult is based on the minimum average roll values (MARV) 2. RFcr, Reduction Factor for Long Term Tension Creep. RFcr shall be determined from 10,000-hour creep testing performed in accordance with ASTM D5262. Reduction value = 1.60 minimum. 3. RFd, Reduction Factor for Durability. RFd shall be determined from polymer specific durability testing covering the range of expected soil environments. RFd = 1.10 minimum. 4. RFid, Reduction Factor for Installation Damage. RFid shall be determined from product specific construction damage testing. performed in accordance with• GRI- GG4. Test results shall be provided for each product to be used with project specific or more severe soil type. RFid = 1.10 minimum. 5. FS, Overall Design Factor of Safety. FS shall be 1.5 unless otherwise noted for the maximum allowable working stress calculation. D. Minimum LTDS for segmental retaining wall construction: 5000 lbs./ft. •ii) MWH - 04082005 SEGMENTAL RETAINING WALLS 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 02834-7 E. The maximum design tensile load of the geogrid shall not exceed the laboratory tested ultimate strength of the geogrid/facing unit connection as limited by the "Hinge Height" divided by a factor of safety of 1.5. The connection strength testing and computation procedures shall be in accordance with NCMA SRWU-1 Test Method for Determining Connection Strength of SRW. F. Soil Interaction Coefficient, Ci. Ci values shall be determined per GRI:GG5 at a maximum 0.75-inch displacement. G. Manufacturing Quality Control 1. The geogrid manufacturer shall have a manufacturing quality control program that includes QC testing by an independent laboratory. a. The QC testing shall include: 1) Tensile Strength Testing 2) Molecular Weight (Polyester) 2.8 DRAINAGE PIPE A. The drainage pipe shall be perforated or slotted PVC pipe manufactured in accordance with ASTM D-3034 or corrugated HDPE pipe manufactured in accordance with ASTM D- 1248. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 Excavation and compaction per Section 02200 - Earthwork. 3.2 BASE LEVELING PAD A. Leveling pad material shall be placed to the lines and grades shown on the Drawings, to a minimum thickness of 6 inches and extend laterally a minimum of 6 inches in front and behind the modular wall unit. B. Leveling pad materials shall be compacted to a minimum of 95% Standard Proctor density per ASTM D-698 C. Leveling pad shall be prepared to insure full contact to the base surface of the concrete units. 3.3 SEGMENTAL CONCRETE BLOCK INSTALLATION A. First course of units shall be placed on the leveling pad at the appropriate line and grade. Alignment and level shall be checked in all directions and insure that all units are in full contact with the base and properly seated. B. Place the front of units side-by-side. Do not leave gaps between adjacent units. Layout of corners and curves shall be in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations. C. Install shear/connecting devices per manufacturer's recommendations. MWH - 04082005 SEGMENTAL RETAINING WALLS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 02834-8 D. Place and compact drainage fill within and behind wall units. Place and compact backfill soil behind drainage fill. Follow wall erection and drainage fill closely with structure backfill. Remove excess backfill from the top of the blocks prior to installing the next course of blocks. E. Maximum stacked vertical height of wall units, prior to unit drainage fill and backfill placement and compaction, shall not exceed two courses. 3.4 GEOGRID INSTALLATION A. Geogrid shall be oriented with the highest strength axis perpendicular to the wall alignment. B. Geogrid reinforcement shall be placed at the strengths, lengths, and elevations shown on the construction design drawings or as directed by the ENGINEER. C. The geogrid shall be laid horizontally on compacted backfill and attached to the modular wall units. Place the next course of modular concrete units over the geogrid. The geogrid shall be pulled taut and anchored prior to backfill placement on the geogrid. D. Geogrid reinforcements shall be continuous throughout their embedment lengths and placed side-by-side to provide 100% coverage at each level. Spliced connections are not permitted. 3.5 REINFORCED BACKFILL PLACEMENT A. Reinforced backfill shall be placed, spread, and compacted in such a manner that minimizes the development of slack in the geogrid and installation damage. B. Reinforced backfill shall be placed and compacted in lifts not to exceed 6 inches where hand compaction is used or 8 to 10 inches where heavy compaction equipment is used. Lift thickness shall be decreased to achieve the required density as required. C. Reinforced backfill shall be compacted to 95% of the maximum density as determined by ASTM D698. The moisture content of the backfill material prior to and during compaction shall be uniformly distributed throughout each layer and shall be dry of optimum, + 0%, - 3%. D. Only lightweight hand-operated equipment shall be allowed within 3 feet from the tail of the modular concrete unit. E. Tracked construction equipment shall not be operated directly upon the geogrid reinforcement. A minimum fill thickness of 6 inches is required prior to operation of tracked vehicles over the geogrid. Tracked vehicle turning should be kept to a minimum to prevent tracks from displacing the fill and damaging the geogrid. F. Rubber tired equipment may pass over geogrid reinforcement at slow speeds, less than 10 MPH. Sudden braking and sharp turning shall be avoided. G. At the end of each day's operation, the CONTRACTOR shall slope the last lift of reinforced backfill away from the wall units to direct runoff away from wall face. The CONTRACTOR shall not allow surface runoff from adjacent areas to enter the wall construction site. MWH - 04082005 SEGMENTAL RETAINING WALLS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 02834-9 3.6 CAP INSTALLATION A. Cap units shall be glued to underlying units with an all-weather adhesive recommended by the manufacturer. 3.7 AS-BUILT CONSTRUCTION TOLERANCES A. Vertical alignment: ± 1.5" over any 10-foot distance. B. Wall Batter: within 2 degrees of design batter. C. Horizontal alignment: ± 1.5" over any 10-foot distance. Corners, bends, curves ± 1 ft to theoretical location. D. Maximum horizontal gap between erected units shall be 1/2 inch. 3.8 FIELD QUALITY CONTROL A. Quality Assurance: The OWNER will engage inspection and testing services, including independent laboratories, to provide quality assurance and testing services during construction. This does not relieve the CONTRACTOR from securing the necessary construction quality control testing. B. Quality assurance will include foundation soil inspection. Verification of geotechnical design parameters, and verification that the CONTRACTOR's quality control testing is adequate as a minimum. Quality assurance will also include observation of construction for general compliance with design drawings and project specifications. C. Quality Control: The CONTRACTOR shall engage inspection and testing services to perform the minimum quality control testing described in the retaining wall design plans and specifications. Only qualified and experienced technicians and engineers shall perform testing and inspection services. D. Quality control testing shall include soil and backfill testing to verify soil types and compaction and verification that the retaining wall is being constructed in accordance with the design plans and project specifications. - END OF SECTION - MWH - 04082005 SEGMENTAL RETAINING WALLS 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 02834-10 SECTION 03100 - CONCRETE FORMWORK PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall furnish concrete formwork, bracing, shoring, and supports for cast-in-place concrete and shall design and construct falsework in accordance with the Contract Documents. 1.2 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Manufacturer's information demonstrating compliance with requirements for the following: 1. Form ties and related accessories, including taper tie plugs, if taper ties are used. 2. Form gaskets. 3. Form release agent, including NSF certification if not using mineral oil. 4. Manufacturer's information on formwork, form materials, any certifications of proper installation and locations for use. 5. Plastic Form Liners 6. Statement of qualifications for formwork designer exhibiting shoring design by a licensed engineer with 5 plus years of experience designing formwork. C. Shop Drawings: Detailed plans for the fabrication and erection of falsework to be used. Such plans shall be in sufficient detail to indicate the general layout, sizes of members, anticipated stresses, grade of materials to be used in the falsework, means of protecting existing construction which supports falsework, and typical soil conditions. Include a list of form materials and locations for use. D. Falsework and Formwork Calculations and Drawings: The CONTRACTOR shall have all falsework or vertical shoring installations where the height of the falsework or vertical shoring, as measured from the top of the sills to the soffit of the superstructure, exceeds 14 feet, or where individual horizontal span lengths exceed 16 feet, or provision for vehicular or railroad traffic through falsework or vertical shoring is made, approved and signed by a civil engineer, registered in the State of Oregon; provided further, that a copy of the falsework plan or shoring layout shall be available on the Site at all times. 1.3 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Tolerances: The variation from required lines or grade shall not exceed 1/4-inch in 10 feet, non-cumulative, and there shall be no offsets or visible waviness in the finished surface. Other tolerances shall be within the tolerances of ACI 117 - Standard Tolerances for Concrete Construction and Materials MWH - 04082005 CONCRETE FORMWORK 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03100 - 1 PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 GENERAL A. Except as otherwise expressly accepted by the ENGINEER, lumber brought on the Site for use as forms, shoring, or bracing shall be new material. Forms shall be smooth surface forms and shall be of the following materials: Walls - Steel, fiberglass, or plywood panel Columns - Steel, plywood or fiberglass Roof and floor - Plywood All other WORK - Steel panels, fiberglass, plywood or tongue and groove lumber B. Form materials that may remain or leave residues on or in the concrete shall be certified as compliant with NSF Standard 61 — Drinking Water System Components. 2.2 FORM AND FALSEWORK MATERIALS A. Materials for concrete forms, formwork, and falsework shall conform to ACI 347, ACI 318 and the following requirements: 1. Lumber shall be Douglas Fir or Southern Yellow Pine, construction grade or better, in conformance with U.S. Product Standard PS 20 - American Softwood Lumber Standard. 2. Plywood for concrete formwork shall be new, waterproof, synthetic resin bonded, exterior type Douglas Fir or Southern Yellow Pine plywood manufactured especially for concrete formwork, shall conform to the requirements of PS 1 — Construction and Industrial Plywood, for Concrete Forms, Class I, and shall be edge sealed. 3. Form materials shall be metal, wood, plywood, or other material that will not adversely affect the concrete and will facilitate placement of concrete to the shape, form, line, and grade indicated. Metal forms shall accomplish such results. Wood forms for surfaces to be painted or all exposed surfaces shall be High Density Overlaid plywood, HDO Ext. Grade. B. Unless otherwise indicated, exterior corners in concrete members shall be provided with 3/4-inch chamfers or be tooled to 1/2-inch radius. Re-entrant corners in concrete members shall not have fillets unless otherwise indicated. C. Forms and falsework to support the roof and floor slabs shall be designed for the total dead load, plus a live load of 50 psf minimum. The minimum design load for combined dead and live loads shall be 100 psf. D. Plastic form liner shall be in accordance with the requirements of Section 09815 — PVC Liner for Concrete. 2.3 FORM TIES A. Form ties shall be provided with a plastic cone or other suitable means for forming a conical hole to insure that the form tie may be broken off back of the face of the concrete. The maximum diameter of removable cones for rod ties or other removable form tie fasteners having a circular cross-section shall not exceed 1-1/2 inches; and all such fasteners shall be such as to leave holes of regular shape for reaming. Form ties MWH -04082005 CONCRETE FORMWORK 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03100 -2 for water-retaining structures shall have integral waterstops that tightly fit the form tie so that they cannot be moved from mid-point of the tie. Form ties shall be Wrench Head Snap Tie by MeadowBurke; Snap-Ties by Dayton/Richmond; or equal. B. Removable taper ties may be used when approved by the ENGINEER. A preformed neoprene or polyurethane tapered plug sized to seat at the center of the wall shall be inserted in the hole left by the removal of the taper tie. Use Taper-Tie by MeadowBurke; Taper-Tie by Dayton/Richmond; or equal. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 GENERAL A. Forms to confine the concrete and shape it to the required lines shall be used wherever necessary. The CONTRACTOR shall assume full responsibility for the adequate design of forms, and any forms that are unsafe or inadequate in any respect shall promptly be removed from the WORK and replaced. Provide worker protection from protruding reinforcement bars in accordance with applicable safety codes. A sufficient number of forms of each kind shall be available to permit the required rate of progress to be maintained. The design and inspection of concrete forms, falsework, and shoring shall comply with applicable local, state, and Federal regulations. Plumb and string lines shall be installed before concrete placement and shall be maintained during placement. Such lines shall be used by CONTRACTOR's personnel and by the ENGINEER and shall be in sufficient number and properly installed. During concrete placement, the CONTRACTOR shall continually monitor plumb and string line form positions and immediately correct deficiencies. B. Concrete forms shall conform to the shape, lines, and dimensions of members required, and shall be substantial, free from surface defects, and sufficiently tight to prevent leakage. Forms shall be properly braced or tied together to maintain their position and shape under a load of freshly-placed concrete. If adequate foundation for shores cannot be secured, trussed supports shall be provided. 3.2 FORM DESIGN A. Forms shall be true in every respect to the required shape and size, shall conform to the established alignment and grade, and shall be of sufficient strength and rigidity to maintain their position and shape under the loads and operations incident to placing and vibrating the concrete including concrete with high range water reducing admixtures. Suitable and effective means shall be provided on forms for holding adjacent edges and ends of panels and sections tightly together and in accurate alignment so as to prevent the formation of ridges, fins, offsets, or similar surface defects in the finished concrete. Limit panel deflections to L/360 of each component span to achieve tolerances specified. Plywood, 5/8-inch and greater in thickness, may be fastened directly to studding if the studs are spaced close enough to prevent visible deflection marks in the concrete. The forms shall be tight so as to prevent the loss of water, cement, and fines during placing and vibrating of the concrete. Specifically, the bottom of wall forms that rest on concrete footings or slabs shall be provided with a gasket to prevent loss of fines and paste during placement and vibration of concrete. Such gasket may be a 1- to 1-1/2-inch diameter polyethylene rod held in position to the underside of the wall form. Adequate clean-out holes shall be provided at the bottom of each lift of forms. The size, number, and location of such clean-outs shall be as acceptable to the ENGINEER. Whenever concrete cannot be placed from the top of a wall form in a manner that meets the requirements of the Contract Documents, form windows shall be provided in the size and MWH - 04082005 CONCRETE FORMWORK 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03100 -3 spacing needed to allow placement of concrete to the requirements of Section 03300 - Cast-in-Place Concrete. The size, number, and location of such form windows shall be as acceptable to the ENGINEER. 3.3 CONSTRUCTION A. Vertical Surfaces: Vertical surfaces of concrete members shall be formed, except where placement of the concrete against the ground is indicated. Not less than 1-inch of concrete shall be added to the indicated thickness of a concrete member where concrete is permitted to be placed against trimmed ground in lieu of forms. Permission to do this on other concrete members will be granted only for members of comparatively limited height and where the character of the ground is such that it can be trimmed to the required lines and will stand securely without caving or sloughing until the concrete has been placed. B. Construction Joints: Concrete construction joints will not be permitted at locations other than those indicated, except as may be acceptable to the ENGINEER. When a second lift is placed on hardened concrete, special precautions shall be taken in the way of the number, location, and tightening of ties at the top of the old lift and bottom of the new to prevent any unsatisfactory effect whatsoever on the concrete. Pipe stubs and anchor bolts shall be set in the forms where required. C. Form Ties: 1. Embedded Ties: Holes left by the removal of form tie cones shall be reamed with suitable toothed reamers so as to leave the surface of the holes clean and rough before being filled with mortar. Wire ties for holding forms will not be permitted. No form-tying device or part thereof, other than metal, shall be left embedded in the concrete. Ties shall not be removed in such manner as to leave a hole extending through the interior of the concrete members. The use of snap-ties that cause spalling of the concrete upon form stripping or tie removal will not be permitted. If steel panel forms are used, rubber grommets shall be provided where the ties pass through the form in order to prevent loss of cement paste. Where metal rods extending through the concrete are used to support or to strengthen forms, the rods shall remain embedded and shall terminate not less than 1-inch back from the formed face or faces of the concrete. 2. Removable Ties: Where taper ties are approved for use, the larger end of the taper tie shall be on the wet side of walls in water retaining structures. After the taper tie is removed, the hole shall be thoroughly cleaned and roughened for bond. A precast neoprene or polyurethane tapered plug shall be located at the wall centerline. The hole shall be completely filled with non-shrink grout for water bearing and below-grade walls. The hole shall be completely filled with non-shrink or regular cement grout for above-grade walls that are dry on both sides. Exposed faces of walls shall have the outer 2-inches of the exposed face filled with a cement grout that shall match the color and texture of the surrounding wall surface. 3.4 REUSE OF FORMS A. Forms may be reused only if in good condition and only if acceptable to the ENGINEER. Light sanding between uses will be required wherever necessary to obtain uniform surface texture on exposed concrete surfaces. Exposed concrete surfaces are defined as surfaces which are permanently exposed to view. In the case of forms for the inside wall surfaces of hydraulic/water retaining structures, unused tie rod holes in forms shall MWH -04082005 CONCRETE FORMWORK 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03100 -4 be covered with metal caps or shall be filled by other methods acceptable to the ENGINEER. 3.5 REMOVAL OF FORMS A. 'Careful procedures for the removal of forms shall be strictly followed, and this WORK shall be done with care so as to avoid injury to the concrete. No heavy loading on green concrete will be permitted. In the case of roof slabs, suspended floor slabs and beams, forms shall remain in place until test cylinders for concrete attain a minimum compressive strength of 75 percent of the 28 Day strength in Section 03300 — Cast-In- Place Concrete. No forms shall be disturbed or removed under an individual panel or unit before the concrete in the adjacent panel or unit has attained 75 percent of the 28 Day strength and has been in place for a minimum of 7 Days. The time required to establish said strength shall be as determined by the ENGINEER who will make several test cylinders for this purpose from concrete used in the first group of panels placed. If the time so determined is more than the 7 Day minimum, then that time shall be used as the minimum length of time. Forms for vertical walls of waterholding structures shall remain in place at least 36 hours after the concrete has been placed. Forms for parts of the WORK not specifically mentioned herein shall remain in place for periods of time as recommended in ACI 347 - Guide to Formwork for Concrete. 3.6 MAINTENANCE OF FORMS A. Forms shall be maintained in good condition, particularly as to size, shape, strength, rigidity, tightness, and smoothness of surface. Before concrete is placed, the forms shall be thoroughly cleaned. The form surfaces shall be treated with a nonstaining mineral oil or other lubricant acceptable to the ENGINEER. Any excess lubricant shall be satisfactorily removed before placing the concrete. Where field oiling of forms is required, the CONTRACTOR shall perform the oiling at least 2 weeks in advance of their use. Care shall be exercised to keep oil off the surfaces of steel reinforcement and other metal items to be embedded in concrete. 3.7 FALSEWORK A. The CONTRACTOR shall be responsible for the design, engineering, construction, maintenance, and safety of falsework, including staging, walkways, forms, ladders, and similar appurtenances, which shall equal or exceed the applicable requirements of the provisions of the OSHA Safety and Health Standards for Construction and the requirements herein. B. Falsework shall be designed and constructed to provide the necessary rigidity and to support the loads. Falsework for the support of a superstructure shall be designed to support the loads that would be imposed if the entire superstructure were placed at one time. C. Falsework shall be placed upon a solid footing, safe against undermining, and be protected from softening. When the falsework is supported on timber piles, the maximum calculated pile loading shall not exceed 20 tons. When falsework is supported on any portion of the structure which is already constructed, the load imposed by the falsework shall be spread, distributed, and braced in such a way as to avoid any possibility of damage to the structure. - END OF SECTION - MWH - 04082005 CONCRETE FORMWORK 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03100 - 5 SECTION 03200 - REINFORCEMENT STEEL PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide reinforcement steel and appurtenant WORK, complete and in place, in accordance with the Contract Documents. 1.2 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Shop Drawings: 1. Shop bending diagrams, placing lists, and drawings of reinforcement steel prior to fabrication. The shop bending diagrams shall show the actual lengths of bars to the nearest inch measured to the intersection of the extensions (tangents for bars of circular cross section) of the outside surface. Include bar placement diagrams that clearly indicate the dimensions of each bar splice. 2. Details of the concrete reinforcement steel and concrete inserts shall be submitted at the earliest possible date after receipt by the CONTRACTOR of the Notice to Proceed. Said details of reinforcement steel for fabrication and erection shall conform to ACI 315 - Details and Detailing of Concrete Reinforcement, and the requirements herein. 3. Where mechanical couplers are required or permitted to be used to splice reinforcement steel, the CONTRACTOR shall submit manufacturer's literature which contains instructions and recommendations for installation for each type of coupler used; certified test reports which verify the load capacity of each type and size of coupler used; and Shop Drawings which show the location of each coupler with details of how they are to be installed in the formwork. 4. If reinforcement steel is spliced by welding at any location, the CONTRACTOR shall submit mill test reports which shall contain the information necessary for the determination of the carbon equivalent per AWS D1.4 - Structural Steel Welding Code - Reinforcing Steel. The CONTRACTOR shall submit a written welding procedure for each type of weld for each size of bar which is to be spliced by welding; merely a statement that AWS procedures will be followed is not acceptable. 5. If reinforcement steel is spliced by welding at any location, the CONTRACTOR shall submit certifications of procedure qualifications for each welding procedure and certification of welder qualifications, for each welding procedure, and for each welder performing on the WORK. C. LEED Product Data: 1. Credit MR 4: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. MWH -04082005 REINFORCEMENT STEEL 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03200 - 1 2. Credit MR 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting manufacturing locations for products manufactured within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 3. Credit MR 5.2: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting location of extraction, recovery or harvest for materials contained in products addressed in item 2 above that originated within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 1.3 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. If requested by the ENGINEER, the CONTRACTOR shall furnish samples from each heat of reinforcement steel in a quantity adequate for testing. Costs of initial tests will be paid by the OWNER. Costs of additional tests if material fails initial tests shall be the CONTRACTOR's responsibility. B. Welder qualifications and procedure qualifications shall be as specified in AWS D1.4. C. If requested by the ENGINEER, the CONTRACTOR shall furnish samples of each type of welded splice in a quantity and of dimensions adequate for testing. At the discretion of the ENGINEER, radiographic testing of direct butt welded splices will be performed. The CONTRACTOR shall provide assistance necessary to facilitate testing. The CONTRACTOR shall repair any weld which fails to meet the requirements of AWS D1.4. The costs of testing will be paid by the OWNER, but the costs of tests that fail to meet requirements shall be the CONTRACTOR's responsibility. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIAL REQUIREMENTS A. Subject to project requirements, give preference to steel containing highest recycled content. B. Subject to project requirements, give preference to steel manufactured within a 500 mile radius of the project. 2.2 REINFORCEMENT STEEL A. Reinforcement steel for cast-in-place reinforced concrete construction shall conform to the following requirements: 1. Bar and spiral reinforcement shall conform to the requirements of ASTM A 615 — Deformed and Plain Billet— Steel Bars, for Grade 60 reinforcement unless otherwise indicated. 2. Welded wire fabric reinforcement shall conform to the requirements of ASTM A 185 — Welded Steel Wire Fabric, Plain, for Concrete Reinforcement, and the details indicated. Welded wire fabric with longitudinal wire of W4 size wire and smaller shall be in flat sheets or in rolls with a core diameter of not less than 10-inches. Welded wire fabric with longitudinal wires larger than W4 size shall be in flat sheets only. MWH -04082005 REINFORCEMENT STEEL 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03200-2 B. Accessories 1. Accessories shall include necessary chairs, slab bolsters, concrete blocks, tie wires, dips, supports, spacers, and other devices to position reinforcement during concrete placement. Bar supports shall meet the requirements of the CRSI Manual of Standard Practice, including special requirements for supporting epoxy coated reinforcing bars. Wire bar supports shall be CRSI Class 1 for maximum protection with a 1/8-inch minimum thickness of plastic coating that extends at least 1A-inch from the concrete surface. Plastic shall be gray in color. 2. Concrete blocks (dobies) used to support and position reinforcement steel shall have the same or higher compressive strength as required for the concrete in which they are located. Wire ties shall be embedded in concrete block bar supports. C. Epoxy coating for reinforcing and accessories, where indicated, shall conform to ASTM A 775 — Epoxy— Coated Reinforcing Steel Bars. 2.3 MECHANICAL COUPLERS A. Mechanical couplers shall be provided where indicated and where approved by the ENGINEER. The couplers shall develop a tensile strength that exceeds 125 percent of the yield strength of the reinforcement bars being spliced at each splice. B. Where the type of coupler used is composed of more than one component, components required for a complete splice shall be provided. This shall apply to mechanical splices, including those splices intended for future connections. C. The reinforcement steel and coupler used shall be compatible for obtaining the required strength of the connection. Straight threaded type couplers shall require the use of the next larger size reinforcing bar or shall be used with reinforcing bars with specially forged ends which provide upset threads which do not decrease the basic cross section of the bar. D. Couplers shall be Lenton Form Saver by Erico Products; Dowel Bar Splicer System by Dayton/Richmond; or equal. 2.4 WELDED SPLICES A. Welded splices shall be provided where indicated and where approved by the ENGINEER. Welded splices of reinforcement steel shall develop a tensile strength that exceeds 125 percent of the yield strength of the reinforcement bars that are connected. B. Materials required to conform the welded splices to the requirements of AWS D1.4 shall be provided. 2.5 EPDXY GROUT A. Epoxy for grouting reinforcing bars shall be specifically formulated for such application, for the moisture condition, application temperature, and orientation of the hole to be filled. Epoxy grout shall meet the requirements in Section 03315 — Grout. MWH -04082005 REINFORCEMENT STEEL 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03200 -3 PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 GENERAL A. Reinforcement steel, welded wire fabric, couplers, and other appurtenances shall be fabricated, and placed in accordance with the requirements of the Building Code and the supplementary requirements herein. 3.2 FABRICATION A. General 1. Reinforcement steel shall be accurately formed to the dimensions and shapes indicated, and the fabricating details shall be prepared in accordance with ACI 315 and ACI 318 — Building Code Requirements for Reinforced Concrete, except as modified by the Drawings. Bars shall be bent cold. Bars shall be bent per ACI 318. 2. The CONTRACTOR shall fabricate reinforcement bars for structures in accordance with bending diagrams, placing lists, and placing drawings. B. Fabricating Tolerances: Bars used for concrete reinforcement shall satisfy the following fabricating tolerances: 1. Sheared length: plus and minus 1-inch 2. Depth of truss bars: plus 0, minus 1/2-inch 3. Stirrups, ties, and spirals: plus and minus '/2-inch 4. Other bends: plus and minus 1-inch 3.3 PLACING A. Reinforcement steel shall be accurately positioned as indicated and shall be supported and wired together to prevent displacement, using annealed iron wire ties or suitable clips at intersections. Reinforcement steel shall be supported by concrete, plastic or metal supports, spacers or metal hangers that are strong and rigid enough to prevent any displacement of the reinforcement steel. Where concrete is to be placed on the ground, supporting concrete blocks (or dobies) shall be used in sufficient numbers to support the bars without settlement, but in no case shall such support be continuous. Concrete blocks used to support reinforcement steel shall be tied to the steel with wire ties that are embedded in the blocks. For concrete over formwork, the CONTRACTOR shall provide concrete, metal, plastic, or other acceptable bar chairs and spacers. B. Limitations on the use of bar support materials shall be-as follows. 1. Concrete Dobies: permitted at any location except where architectural finish is required. 2. Wire Bar Supports: permitted only at slabs over dry areas, interior dry wall surfaces, and exterior wall surfaces. 3. Plastic Bar Supports: permitted at every location except on grade. MWH -04082005 REINFORCEMENT STEEL 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03200 -4 C. Tie wires shall be bent away from the forms in order to provide the required concrete coverage. D. Bars additional to those indicated which may be found necessary or desirable by the CONTRACTOR for the purpose of securing reinforcement in position shall be provided by the CONTRACTOR at its own expense. E. Unless otherwise indicated, reinforcement placing tolerances shall be within the limits in Section 7.5 of ACI 318 except where in conflict with the requirements of the Building Code. F. Bars may be moved as necessary to avoid interference with other reinforcement steel, conduits, or embedded items. If bars are moved more than one bar diameter, or enough to exceed the above tolerances, the resulting arrangement of bars shall be as reviewed and accepted by the ENGINEER. G. Welded wire fabric reinforcement placed over horizontal forms shall be supported on slab bolsters. Slab bolsters shall be spaced not more than 30-inches on centers, shall extend continuously across the entire width of the reinforcement mat, and shall support the reinforcement mat in the plane indicated. H. Welded wire fabric placed over the ground shall be supported on wired concrete blocks (dobies) spaced not more than 3-feet on centers in any direction. The construction practice of placing welded wire fabric on the ground and hooking into place in the freshly placed concrete shall not be used. I. Epoxy coated reinforcing bars shall be stored, transported, and placed in such a manner as to avoid chipping of the epoxy coating. Non-abrasive slings made of nylon and similar materials shall be used. Specially coated bar supports shall be used. Chips or cracks in the epoxy coating shall be repaired with a compatible epoxy repair material prior to placing concrete. J. Accessories supporting reinforcing bars shall be spaced such that there is no deflection of the accessory from the weight of the supported bars. When used to space the reinforcing bars from wall forms, the forms and bars shall be located so that there is no deflection of the accessory when the forms are tightened into position. 3.4 SPACING OF BARS A. The clear distance between parallel bars (except in columns and between multiple layers of bars in beams) shall be not less than the nominal diameter of the bars, nor less than 1-1/3 times the maximum size of the coarse aggregate, nor less than one-inch. B. Where reinforcement in beams or girders is placed in 2 or more layers, the clear distance between layers shall be not less than one-inch. C. In columns, the clear distance between longitudinal bars shall be not less than 1-1/2 . times the bar diameter, nor less than 1-1/2 times the maximum size of the coarse aggregate, nor less than 1-1/2 inches. D. The clear distance between bars shall also apply to the distance between a contact splice and adjacent splices or bars. MWH -04082005 REINFORCEMENT STEEL 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03200 -5 3.5 SPLICING A. General 1. Reinforcement bar splices shall only be used at locations indicated. When it is necessary to splice reinforcement at points other than where indicated, the character of the splice shall be as reviewed and accepted by the ENGINEER. 2. Unless otherwise indicated, dowels shall match the size and spacing of the spliced bar. B. Splices of Reinforcement 1. The length of lap for reinforcement bars, unless otherwise indicated, shall be in accordance with ACI 318, Section 12.15.1 for a Class B splice. 2. Laps of welded wire fabric shall be in accordance with ACI 318. Adjoining sheets shall be securely tied together with No. 14 tie wire, one tie for each 2 running feet. Wires shall be staggered and tied in such a manner that they cannot slip. 3. Splices in column spiral reinforcement, when necessary, shall be made by welding or by a lap of 1-1/2 turns. C. Bending or Straightening: Reinforcement shall not be straightened or rebent in a manner which will injure the material. Bars shall be bent or straight as indicated. Do not use bends different from the bends indicated. Bars shall be bent cold, unless otherwise permitted by the ENGINEER. No bars partially embedded in concrete shall be field-bent except as indicated or specifically permitted by the ENGINEER. D. Couplers that are located at a joint face shall be a type that can be set either flush or recessed from the face as indicated. The couplers shall be sealed during concrete placement to completely eliminate concrete or cement paste from entering. Couplers intended for future connections shall be recessed a minimum of 1/2-inch from the concrete surface. After the concrete is placed, the coupler shall be plugged with plastic plugs which have an 0-ring seal and the recess filled with sealant to prevent any contact with water or other corrosive materials. Threaded couplers shall be plugged . E. Unless indicated otherwise, mechanical coupler spacing and capacity shall match the spacing and capacity of the reinforcing indicated for the adjacent section. 3.6 CLEANING AND PROTECTION A. Reinforcement steel shall always be protected from conditions conducive to corrosion until concrete is placed around it. B. The surfaces of reinforcement steel and other metalwork to be in contact with concrete shall be thoroughly cleaned of dirt, grease, loose scale and rust, grout, mortar, and other foreign substances immediately before the concrete is placed. Where there is delay in depositing concrete, reinforcement shall be reinspected and, if necessary, recleaned. MWH -04082005 REINFORCEMENT STEEL 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03200 - 6 3.7 EMBEDMENT OF DRILLED REINFORCING STEEL DOWELS A. Hole Preparation: 1. The hole diameter shall be as recommended by the epoxy manufacturer but shall be no larger than 1/4-inch greater than the diameter of the outer surface of the reinforcing bar deformations. 2. The depth of the hole shall be as recommended by the epoxy manufacturer to fully develop the bar but shall not be less than 12 bar diameters, unless indicated otherwise. 3. The hole shall be drilled by methods that do not interfere with the proper bonding of epoxy. 4. Existing reinforcing steel in the vicinity of proposed holes shall be located prior to drilling. The location of holes shall be adjusted to avoid drilling through or nicking any existing reinforcing bars. 5. The hole shall be blown clean with clean, dry compressed air to remove dust and loose particles. B. Embedment: 1. Epoxy shall be injected into the hole through a tube placed to the bottom of the hole. The tube shall be withdrawn as epoxy is placed but kept immersed to prevent formation of air pockets. The hole shall be filled to a depth that insures that excess material will be expelled from the hole during dowel placement. 2. Dowels shall be twisted during insertion into the partially filled hole so as to guarantee full wetting of the bar surface with epoxy. The bar shall be inserted slowly enough to avoid developing air pockets. - END OF SECTION - MWH -04082005 REINFORCEMENT STEEL 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03200 - 7 SECTION 03290 - JOINTS IN CONCRETE PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide joints in concrete, complete and in place, in accordance with the Contract Documents. B. Joints in concrete structures shall be the types defined below and will be permitted only where indicated, unless specifically accepted by the ENGINEER. 1.2 TYPES OF JOINTS A. Construction Joints: When fresh concrete is placed against a hardened concrete surface, the joint between the two pours is defined as a construction joint. Unless otherwise indicated, joints in water-bearing members shall be provided with a waterstop and/or sealant groove of the shape indicated. B. Contraction Joints: Contraction joints are similar to construction joints except that the fresh concrete shall not bond to the hardened surface of the earlier pour. The slab reinforcement shall be stopped 4-1/2 inches from the joint; which is provided with a sleeve-type dowel, to allow shrinkage of the concrete of the later pour. Waterstop and sealant groove shall also be provided where indicated. C. Expansion Joints: To allow the concrete to expand freely, a space is provided between the 2 pours, and the joint shall be formed as indicated. The space is obtained by placing a filler joint material against the earlier pour to act as a form for the later pour. Unless otherwise indicated, expansion joints in water bearing members shall be provided with a center-bulb type waterstop as indicated. 1. Premolded expansion joint material shall be installed with the edge at the indicated distance below or back from finished concrete surface and shall have a slightly tapered, dressed, and oiled wood strip secured to or placed at the edge thereof during concrete placement. The strip shall later be removed to form space for sealing material. 2. The space so formed shall be filled with a joint sealant material as indicated below. In order to keep the 2 wall or slab elements in line the joint shall also be provided with a sleeve-type dowel as indicated. D. Control Joints: The function of the control joint is to provide a weaker plane in the concrete where shrinkage cracks will probably occur. A groove, of the shape and dimensions indicated, is formed or saw-cut in the concrete. This groove is afterward filled with a joint sealant material. 1.3 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Shop Drawings: 1. Placement drawings showing the location and types of joints for each structure. MWH - 04082005 JOINTS IN CONCRETE 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03290 - 1 2. Certified test reports from the sealant manufacturer on the actual batch of material supplied, indicating compliance with requirements. Furnish test report before using the sealant on the project. 3. Copies of the waterstop welding certification by manufacturer or authorized agent of the manufacturer. Every person who is to be involved with waterstop installation is required to have individual certification on file with ENGINEER, stating that the named individuals are certified and trained to install waterstop per manufacturer's recommendations and specifications. 4. Manufacturer's information demonstrating compliance of the following with indicated requirements: a. Bearing Pad b. Neoprene Sponge c. Preformed Joint Filler d. Backing Rod e. Waterstop f. Slip Dowels g. PVC Tubing C. Samples: 1. Prior to production of the material required under this Section, qualification samples of waterstops shall be submitted which represent accurately the material proposed. Such samples shall be extruded or molded sections of each size or shape to be installed. The balance of the material to be used shall not be produced until after the ENGINEER has reviewed the qualification samples. D. Certificates: Written certification from the manufacturer as an integral part of the shipping form, that the material shipped to the Site meets or exceeds the physical property requirements of the Contract Documents. Supplier certificates are not acceptable. 1.4 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Waterstop Inspection: Waterstop field joints shall be subject to inspection, and no such WORK shall be scheduled or started without having made prior arrangements with the ENGINEER for the required inspections. Not less than 24 hours notice shall be given for scheduling such inspections. B. Field joints in waterstops shall be subject to inspection for misalignment, bubbles, inadequate bond, porosity, cracks, offsets, and other defects that would reduce the potential resistance of the material to water pressure at any point. Defective joints shall be replaced with material that passes inspection; faulty material shall be removed from the Site and destroyed. C. The following waterstop defects represent a partial list of defects which shall be grounds for rejection: MWH -04082005 JOINTS IN CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03290 -2 1. Offsets at joints greater than 1/16-inch or 15 percent of material thickness, at any point, whichever is less. 2. Exterior cracking at joint, due to incomplete bond, which is deeper than 1/16-inch or 15 percent of material thickness, at any point, whichever is less. 3. Any combination of offset or exterior cracking that will result in a net reduction in the cross section of the waterstop in excess of 1/16-inch or 15 percent of material thickness at any point, whichever is less. 4. Misalignment of joint which results in misalignment of the waterstop in excess of 1/2-inch in 10 feet. 5. Porosity in the welded joint as evidenced by visual inspection. 6. Bubbles or inadequate bonding which can be detected with a penknife test. (If, while prodding the entire joint with the point of a pen knife, the knife breaks through the outer portion of the weld into a bubble, the joint shall be considered defective.) 7. Visible signs of separation when the cooled splice is bent by hand at any sharp angle. 8. Any evidence of burned material. D. PVC Waterstop Samples: Prior to use of the waterstop material in the field, a sample of a prefabricated (shop made fitting) mitered cross and a tee constructed of each size or shape of material to be used shall be submitted. Samples shall be prefabricated (shop made fitting) so that the material and workmanship represent the fittings to be provided. Field samples of prefabricated fittings (crosses, tees, etc.) will also be selected at random by the ENGINEER for testing by a laboratory at the OWNER's expense. When tested, tensile strength across the joints shall be at least 1120 psi. E. Construction Joint Sealant: The CONTRACTOR shall prepare adhesion and cohesion test specimens at intervals of 5 Days while sealants are being installed. The sealant material shall show no signs of adhesive or cohesive failure when tested in accordance with the following procedure in laboratory and field tests: 1. Sealant specimen shall be prepared between 2 concrete blocks (1-inch by 2-inches by 3-inches). Spacing between the blocks shall be 1-inch. Coated spacers (2- inches by 1-1/2 inches by 1/2-inch) shall be used to set and hold sealant cross- sections of 1/2-inch by 2 inches with a width of 1-inch. 2. Sealant shall be cast and cured according to manufacturer's recommendations except that curing period shall be not less than 24 hours. 3. Following curing period, the gap between blocks shall be widened to 1-1/2 inches. Spacers shall be used to maintain this gap for 24 hours prior to inspection for failure. 1.5 SPECIAL WARRANTY REQUIREMENTS A. The CONTRACTOR shall furnish a 5 year written warranty of the entire sealant installation against faulty and/or incompatible materials and workmanship, together with a statement that it agrees to repair or replace, to the satisfaction of the OWNER, any such defective areas which become evident within the 5 year period. MWH - 04082005 JOINTS IN CONCRETE 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03290 - 3 PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 GENERAL A. Joint materials shall be listed as compliant with NSF Standard 61. 2.2 WATERSTOPS A. PVC Waterstops: Waterstops shall be extruded from an elastomeric polyvinyl chloride compound containing the plasticizers, resins, stabilizers, and other materials necessary to meet the requirements of this Section. No reclaimed or scrap material shall be used. The CONTRACTOR shall obtain from the waterstop manufacturer and shall furnish to the ENGINEER for review, current test reports and a written certification of the manufacturer that the material to be shipped to the Site meets the physical requirements as outlined in the U.S. Army Corps of Engineers Specification CRD-0572-PVC Waterstops, and those listed herein. 1. Flatstrip and Center-Bulb Waterstops: Flatstrip and center-bulb waterstops shall be as manufactured by Greenstreak Plastic Products Co., Profiles 646, 679, 732, and 735; Tamms Horn/Durajoint Types 9,10, 11, and 11A; or equal, provided that at no place shall the thickness of waterstops, including the center bulb type, be less than 3/8-inch. Waterstop shall be provided with factory installed hog rings at 12- inches on centers along the waterstop. 2. Multi-Rib Waterstops: Multi-rib waterstops, where required, shall be as manufactured by Greenstreak Plastic Products Co., Profiles 789 and 790; Tamms Horn/Durajoint Types 25 and 26; or equal. Prefabricated joint fittings shall be used at intersections of the ribbed-type waterstops. 3. Retrofit Waterstops: Retrofit waterstops and batten bars shall be as manufactured by Greenstreak Plastic Products Co., Style #609, or equal. Waterstop shall be supplied as a complete system including waterstop, SS batten bar, SS anchor bolts, and epoxy gel. 4. Waterstop Testing Requirements: When tested in accordance with the test standards, the waterstop material shall meet or exceed the following requirements: Physical Property, Sheet Material Value ASTM Std Tensile Strength-min, psi 2000 D 638, Type IV Ultimate Elongation-min, percent 350 D 638, Type IV Low Temp Brittleness, max degrees F -35 D 746 Stiffness in Flexure, min, psi 600 D 747 Accelerated Extraction (CRD-0572 Tensile Strength-min, psi 1500 D 638, Type IV Ultimate Elongation, min, percent 300 D 638, Type IV MWH - 04082005 JOINTS IN CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03290 -4 Effect of Alkalies (CRD-0572 Change in Weight, percent plus 0.25/minus 0.10 Change in Durometer, Shore A plus and minus 5 D 2240 Finish Waterstop Tensile Strength-min, psi 1400 D 638, Type IV Ultimate Elongation, min percent 280 D 638, Type IV B. Preformed Hydrophilic Waterstop: Hydrophilic (bentonite-free) waterstops shall be Hydrotite CJ10202k as manufactured by Greenstreak Plastic Products Co., or Adeka Ultraseal MC2010 as manufactured by Asahi Denka. 1. Hydrophilic waterstop shall be the type that expands in the presence of water to form a watertight joint seal without damaging the concrete in which it is cast. 2. Waterstop shall be manufactured from chloroprene rubber and modified chloroprene rubber with hydrophilic properties. Waterstop shall have a delay coating to inhibit initial expansion due to moisture present in fresh concrete. The minimum expansion ratio of modified chloroprene shall be not less than 2 to 1 volumetric change in distilled water at 70 degrees F. Physical Property, Chloroprene Value ASTM Std Tensile Strength-min, psi 1275 D 412 Ultimate Elongation, min percent 350 D 412 Hardness, Shore A 55 plus and minus 5 D 2240 Physical Property, Modified Value ASTM Std. Chloroprene Tensile Strength, min psi 300 D 412 Ultimate Elongation, min percent 600 D 412 Hardness, Shore A 55 plus and minus 5 D 2240 3. Bonding agent for hydrophilic waterstop shall be the manufacturer's recommended adhesive for wet, rough concrete. C. Other Types of Waterstops: When types of waterstops not listed above are indicated, they shall be subjected to the same requirements as those listed herein. MWH - 04082005 JOINTS IN CONCRETE 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03290 - 5 2.3 JOINT SEALANT FOR WATER BEARING JOINTS A. Joint sealant shall be polyurethane polymer designed for bonding to concrete which is continuously submerged in water. No material will be acceptable which has an unsatisfactory history as to bond or durability when used in the joints of water retaining structures. B. Joint sealant material shall meet the following requirements (73 degrees F and 5percent R.H.): Work Life, minutes 45 - 180 Time to Reach 20 Shore "A" Hardness (at 77 degrees F, 24 hours 200 gr quantity), max Ultimate Hardness (ASTM D 2240, Shore A) 20 - 45 Tensile Strength (ASTM D 412), min 175 psi Ultimate Elongation (ASTM D 412), minimum 400 percent Tear Resistance (Die C, ASTM D 624), pounds per inch of 75 thickness, min Color Light Gray C. Polyurethane sealants for waterstop joints in concrete shall conform to the following requirements: 1. Sealant shall be 2 part polyurethane with the physical properties of the cured sealant conforming to or exceeding the requirements of ASTM C 920 — Elastomeric Joint Sealant, or Federal Specification TT-S-0227 E(3) - Sealing Compound, Elastomeric Type, Multicomponent, for Caulking, Sealing, and Glazing Buildings and Other Structures, for 2 part material, as applicable. 2. For vertical joints and overhead horizontal joints, only "non-sag" compounds shall be used. Such compounds shall conform to the requirements of ASTM C 920, Class 25, Grade NS, or Federal Specification TT-S-0227 E(3), Type II, Class A. 3. For plane horizontal joints, use the self-leveling compounds meeting the requirements of ASTM C 920 Class 25, Grade P, or Federal Specification TT-S- 0227 E(3), Type I. For joints subject to either pedestrian or vehicular traffic, a compound providing non-tracking characteristics and having a Shore "A" hardness range of 35 to 45 shall be used. 4. Primer materials, if recommended by the sealant manufacturer, shall conform to the printed recommendations of the manufacturer. D. Sealants shall be PSI-270 as manufactured by Polymeric Systems Inc., Sikaflex 2C, as manufactured by Sika Corporation, or equal. E. Sealants for non-waterstop joints in concrete shall conform to Section 07920 - Sealants and Caulking. MWH - 04082005 JOINTS IN CONCRETE 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03290 -6 2.4 JOINT MATERIALS A. Bearing Pad: Bearing pad shall be neoprene conforming to ASTM D 2000 - Standard Classification System for Rubber Products in Automotive Applications, BC 420, 40 durometer hardness unless otherwise indicated. B. Neoprene Sponge: Sponge shall be neoprene, closed-cell, expanded, conforming to ASTM D 1056 - Flexible Cellular Materials - Sponge or Expanded Rubber, type 2C5-E1. C. Joint Filler 1. Joint filler for expansion joints in waterholding structures shall be neoprene conforming to ASTM D 1056, Type 2C5-E1. 2. Joint filler material in other locations shall be of the preformed non-extruding type, constructed of cellular neoprene sponge rubber or polyurethane of firm texture. Bituminous fiber type will not be permitted. Non-extruding and resilient-type preformed expansion joint fillers shall conform to the requirements and tests set forth in ASTM D 1752 - Preformed Sponge Rubber and Cork Expansion Joint Fillers for Concrete Paving and Structural Construction, for Type I, except as otherwise indicated. 2.5 BACKING ROD A. Backing rod shall be an extruded closed-cell, polyethylene foam rod. The material shall be compatible with the joint sealant material and shall have a tensile strength of not less than 40 psi and a compression deflection of approximately 25 percent at 8 psi. The rod shall be 1/8-inch larger in diameter than the joint width except that a one-inch diameter rod shall be used for a 3/4-inch wide joint. 2.6 SLIP DOWELS A. Slip dowels in joints shall be smooth epoxy-coated bars conforming to ASTM A 775 - Epoxy Coated Reinforcing Steel Bars. 2.7 PVC TUBING A. PVC tubing in joints shall be SDR 13.5, conforming to ASTM D 2241 - Poly (Vinyl Chloride) (PVC) Pressure-Rated Pipe (SDR Series). PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 GENERAL A. Waterstops shall be embedded in the concrete across joints as indicated. Waterstops shall be fully continuous for the extent of the joint. Splices necessary to provide such continuity shall conform to printed instructions of manufacturer of the waterstops. The CONTRACTOR shall take suitable precautions and provide means to support and protect the waterstops during the progress of the WORK and shall repair or replace at its own expense any waterstops damaged during progress. Waterstops shall be stored so as to permit free circulation of air around the waterstop material. B. When any waterstop is installed in the concrete on one side of a joint while the other portion of the waterstop remains exposed to the atmosphere for more than 2 Days, MWH - 04082005 JOINTS IN CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03290 - 7 suitable precautions shall be taken to shade and protect the exposed waterstop from direct rays of the sun during the entire exposure time until the exposed portion of waterstop is embedded in concrete. 3.2 SPLICES IN PVC WATERSTOPS A. Splices in PVC waterstops shall be performed by heat sealing the adjacent waterstop sections in accordance with the manufacturer's printed recommendations. It is essential that: 1. The material not be damaged by heat sealing. 2. The splices have a tensile strength of not less than 80 percent of the unspliced material tensile strength. 3. The continuity of the waterstop ribs and of its tubular center axis be maintained. No edge welding is allowed. B. Butt joints of the ends of 2 identical waterstop sections may be made while the material is in the forms. C. Joints with waterstops involving more than 2 ends to be jointed together, and joints that involve an angle cut, alignment change, or the joining of 2 dissimilar waterstop sections shall be prefabricated prior to placement in the forms, allowing not less than 24-inch long strips of waterstop material beyond the joint. Upon inspection and approval, such prefabricated waterstop joint assemblies shall be installed in the forms and the ends of the 24-inch strips shall be butt welded to the straight run portions of waterstop in place in the forms. D. Where a centerbulb waterstop intersects and is jointed with a non-centerbulb waterstop, care shall be taken to seal the end of the centerbulb, using additional PVC material if needed. 3.3 JOINT CONSTRUCTION A. Setting Waterstops: In order to eliminate faulty installation that may result in joint leakage, particular care shall be taken of the correct positioning of the waterstops during installation. Adequate provisions must be made to support and anchor the waterstops during the progress of the WORK and to insure proper embedment in the concrete. The symmetrical halves of the waterstops shall be equally divided between the concrete pours at the joints. The center axis of the waterstops shall be coincident with the joint openings. Maximum density and imperviousness of the concrete shall be insured by thoroughly working it in the vicinity of joints. B. In placing PVC waterstops in the forms, means shall be-provided to prevent them from being folded over by the concrete as it is placed. Waterstops shall be held in place with light wire ties on 12-inch centers which shall be passed through hog rings at the edge of the waterstop and tied to the curtain of reinforcing steel. Horizontal waterstops, with their flat face in a vertical plane, shall be held in place with continuous supports to which the top edge of the waterstop shall be tacked. In placing concrete around horizontal waterstops with their flat face in a horizontal plane, concrete shall be worked under the waterstops by hand so as to avoid the formation of air and rock pockets. C. In placing centerbulb waterstops in expansion joints, the centerbulb shall be centered on the joint filler material. MWH - 04082005 JOINTS IN CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03290 -8 D. Waterstop in vertical wall joints shall stop 6 inches from the top of the wall where such waterstop does not connect with any other waterstop and is not to be connected to a future concrete placement. E. Joint Location: Construction joints and other types of joints shall be provided where indicated. When not indicated, construction joints shall be provided at 25-foot maximum spacing. Where joints are indicated spaced greater than 40-feet apart, additional joints shall be provided to maintain the 25-foot maximum spacing. The location of joints, regardless of type, shall be submitted for acceptance by the ENGINEER. F. Joint Preparation: Special care shall be used in preparing concrete surfaces at joints where bonding between 2 sections of concrete is required. Unless otherwise indicated, such bonding will be required at every horizontal joint in walls. Surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with Section 03300 - Cast-in-Place Concrete. G. Retrofit Joint Preparation: Existing surfaces to receive a retrofit waterstop shall be clean and free from any loose or foreign material. Surface shall be given a light sandblast or hydroblast finish to 1/8-inch amplitude prior to application of epoxy and waterstop. H. Construction Joint Sealant: Construction joints in water-bearing floor slabs and elsewhere as indicated shall be provided with tapered grooves which shall be filled with a construction joint sealant. The material used to form the tapered grooves shall be left in the grooves until just before the grooves are cleaned and filled with joint sealant. After removing the forms from the grooves, laitance and fins shall be removed, and the grooves shall be sand-blasted. The grooves shall be allowed to thoroughly dry, after which they shall be blown out and immediately thereafter they shall be primed and filled with the construction joint sealant. The primer shall be furnished by the sealant manufacturer. No sealant shall be used without a primer. Care shall be used to completely fill the sealant grooves. Areas designated to receive a sealant fillet shall be thoroughly cleaned as outlined for the tapered grooves prior to application of the sealant. I. The primer and sealant shall be placed strictly in accordance with the printed recommendations of the manufacturer, taking special care to properly mix the sealant prior to application. The sides of the sealant groove shall not be coated with bond breaker, curing compound, or any other substance which would interfere with proper bonding of the sealant. Sealant shall achieve final cure at least 7 days before the structure is filled with water. J. Sealant shall be installed by a competent waterproofing specialty contractor that has a successful record of performance in similar installations. K. Thorough, uniform mixing of 2 part, catalyst-cured materials is essential; special care shall be taken to properly mix the sealer before its application. Before any sealer is placed, the CONTRACTOR shall arrange to have the crew doing the WORK carefully instructed on the proper method of mixing and application by a representative of the sealant manufacturer. L. Any joint sealant that fails to fully and properly cure after the manufacturer's recommended curing time for the conditions of the WORK shall be completely removed; the groove shall be thoroughly sandblasted to remove traces of the uncured or partially cured sealant and primer. The groove shall be re-sealed with the indicated joint sealant. Costs of such removal, joint treatment, re-sealing, and appurtenant WORK shall be the CONTRACTOR's responsibility as part of the WORK. MWH - 04082005 JOINTS IN CONCRETE 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03290 - 9 M. Hydrophilic Waterstop 1. Where a hydrophilic waterstop is called for in the Contract Documents, it shall be installed per the manufacturer's instructions and recommendations except as modified herein. 2. When requested by the ENGINEER, the CONTRACTOR shall arrange for the manufacturer to furnish technical assistance in the field. 3. Hydrophilic waterstop shall only be used where complete confinement by concrete is provided. Hydrophilic waterstop shall not be used in expansion or contraction joints nor in the first 6 inches of any non-intersecting joint. 4. The hydrophilic waterstop shall be located as near as possible to the center of the joint, and it shall be continuous around the entire joint. The minimum distance from the edge of the waterstop to the face of the member shall be 5 inches. 5. Where the thickness of the concrete member to be placed on the hydrophilic waterstop is less than 12 inches, the waterstop shall be placed in grooves formed or ground into the concrete. The groove shall be at least 3/4-inch deep and 1-1/4 inches wide. When placed in the groove, the minimum distance from the edge of the waterstop to the face of the member shall be 2-1/2 inches. 6. Where a hydrophilic waterstop is used in combination with PVC waterstop, the hydrophilic waterstop shall overlap the PVC waterstop for a minimum of 6 inches and shall be adhered to PVC waterstop by a single component water-swelling sealant as recommended by manufacturer. 7. The hydrophilic waterstop shall not be installed where the air temperature falls outside the manufacturer's recommended range. 8. The concrete surface under the hydrophilic waterstop shall be smooth and uniform. The concrete shall be ground smooth if needed. Alternately, the hydrophilic waterstop shall be bonded to the surface using an epoxy grout that completely fills voids and irregularities beneath the waterstop material. Prior to installation, the concrete surface shall be wire brushed to remove any laitance or other materials that may interfere with the bonding of epoxy. 9. The hydrophilic waterstop shall be secured in place with concrete nails and washers at 12-inch maximum spacing. This shall be in addition to the adhesive recommended by the manufacturer. N. Retrofit Waterstop: Retrofit waterstops shall be set in a bed of epoxy over a sandblasted surface with stainless steel batten bars and 1/4-inch diameter stainless steel anchors at 6 inches on center, staggered, and in accordance with the manufacturer's written recommendations. - END OF SECTION - MWH - 04082005 JOINTS IN CONCRETE 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03290 - 10 SECTION 03300 - CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide cast-in-place concrete in accordance with the Contract Documents. B. The following types of concrete are covered in this Section: 1. Structural Concrete: Concrete to be used in all cases except where indicated otherwise in the Contract Documents. 2. Pea Gravel Concrete: Concrete in thin sections and areas with congested reinforcing, at the option of the CONTRACTOR and with written approval of the ENGINEER for the specific location. 3. Sitework Concrete: Concrete to be used for curbs, gutters, catch basins, sidewalks, pavements, fence and guard post embedment, underground pipe encasement, underground duct bank encasement and other concrete appurtenant to electrical facilities unless otherwise indicated. 4. Lean Concrete: Concrete to be used for thrust blocks, pipe trench cut-off blocks that are indicated on the Drawings as unreinforced. Lean concrete shall be used as protective cover for dowels intended for future connection. C. The term "hydraulic structure" used in these specifications means environmental engineering concrete structures for the containment, treatment, or transmission of water, wastewater, other fluids, or gases. 1.2 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300— Contractor Submittals. B. LEED Product Data: 1. Credit MR 4: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. 2. Credit MR 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting manufacturing locations for products manufactured within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 3. Credit MR 5.2: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting location of extraction, recovery or harvest for materials contained in products addressed in item 2 above that originated within a 500-mile radius of the project. C. Mix Designs: Prior to beginning the WORK and within 14 Days of the Notice to Proceed, submit preliminary concrete mix designs which shall show the proportions and gradations of materials proposed for each class and type of concrete. Mix designs shall be checked through trial batch and laboratory testing by an independent testing laboratory acceptable to the ENGINEER. Costs related to trial batch and related laboratory testing shall be CONTRACTOR'S responsibility as part of the WORK. Since MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 1 laboratory trial batches require 35 calendar days to complete, the CONTRACTOR shall test a minimum of 2 mix designs for each class of concrete. D. Delivery Tickets: Where ready-mix concrete is used, the CONTRACTOR shall furnish delivery tickets at the time of delivery of each load of concrete. Each ticket shall show the state-certified equipment used for measuring and the total quantities, by weight, of cement, sand, each class of aggregate, admixtures, and the amounts of water in the aggregate added at the batching plant, and the amount allowed to be added at the Site for the specific design mix. In addition, each ticket shall state the mix number, total yield in cubic yards, and the time of day, to the nearest minute, corresponding to the times when the batch was dispatched, when it left the plant, when it arrived at the Site, when unloading began, and when unloading was finished. E. Test data relating to the cement, aggregate, and admixtures shall be less than 6 months old. Furnish the following submittals in accordance with ACI 301 — Structural Concrete for Buildings: 1. Mill tests for cement. 2. Admixture certification. Chloride ion content shall be included. 3. Aggregate gradation test results and certification. 4. Materials and methods for curing. 1.3 CONCRETE CONFERENCE A. A meeting to review the detailed requirements of the CONTRACTOR's proposed concrete design mixes and to determine the procedures for producing proper concrete construction shall be held no later than 14 Days after the Notice to Proceed. B. Parties involved in the concrete WORK shall attend the conference, including the following at a minimum: 1. CONTRACTOR's representative 2. Testing laboratory representative 3. Concrete subcontractor 4. Reinforcing steel subcontractor and detailer 5. Concrete supplier 6. Admixture manufacturer's representative C. The conference shall be held at a mutually agreed upon time and place. The ENGINEER shall be notified no less than 5 Days prior to the date of the conference. 1.4 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. General 1. Tests on component materials and for compressive strength and shrinkage of concrete shall be performed as indicated. Tests for determining slump shall be in MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 -2 accordance with the requirements of ASTM C 143 — Test Method for Slump of Hydraulic Cement Concrete. 2. Testing for aggregate shall include sand equivalence, reactivity, organic impurities, abrasion resistance, and soundness, according to ASTM C 33 — Concrete Aggregates. 3. The cost of trial batch laboratory tests on cement, aggregates, and concrete shall be the CONTRACTOR's responsibility. The cost of laboratory tests on field-placed cement, aggregates, and concrete will be the OWNER'S responsibility. However, the CONTRACTOR shall pay the cost of any additional tests and investigation on WORK that does not meet the specifications. The laboratory will meet or exceed the requirements of ASTM C 1077 — Practice for Laboratories Testing Concrete and Concrete Aggregates for use in Construction and Criteria for Laboratory Evaluation. 4. Concrete for testing shall be furnished by the CONTRACTOR, and the CONTRACTOR shall assist the ENGINEER in obtaining samples, and disposal and cleanup of excess material. B. Inspections: Continuous inspection by a special inspector approved by the ENGINEER and local building department having jurisdiction will be required where necessary to conform with the 2003 IBC code requirements. Costs of the special inspector shall be paid by the OWNER. Inspection reports shall be submitted to the ENGINEER. The special inspector shall observe the following work for conformance with the Drawings and Specifications: 1. During the preparation and taking of required test specimens. 2. Placing of concrete except Sitework concrete fully supported on earth. C. Field Compression Tests: 1. Compression test specimens shall be taken during construction from the first placement of each class of concrete and shall conform to the requirements of Section 5.6.2 of the ACI 318 Code for the frequency of testing to insure continued compliance with these specifications. Each set of test specimens shall be a minimum of 5 cylinders. 2. Compression test specimens for concrete shall be made in accordance with Section 9.2 of ASTM C 31 — Practices for Making and Curing Concrete Test Specimens in the Field. Specimens shall be 6-inch diameter by 12-inch high cylinders. 3. Compression tests shall be performed in accordance with ASTM C 39 — Test Method for Compressive Strength of Cylindrical Concrete Specimens. One test cylinder will be tested at 7 Days and 2 at 28 Days. The remaining cylinders will be held to verify test results, if needed. D. Evaluation and Acceptance of Concrete: 1. Evaluation and acceptance of the compressive strength of concrete will be according to the requirements of ACI 318 — Building Code Requirements for Reinforced Concrete, Chapter 5 "Concrete Quality," and as indicated. 2. A statistical analysis of compression test results will be performed according to the requirements of ACI 214 — Recommended Practice for Evaluation of Strength Test MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 3 Methods. The standard deviation of the test results shall not exceed 640 psi, when ordered at equivalent water content as estimated by slump. 3. If any concrete fails to meet these requirements, immediate corrective action shall be taken to increase the compressive strength for subsequent batches of the type of concrete affected. 4. When the standard deviation of the test results exceeds 640 psi, the average strength for which the mix is designed shall be increased by an amount necessary to satisfy the statistical requirement that the probability of any test being more than 500 psi below or the average of any 3 consecutive tests being below the required compressive strength is 1 in 100. The required average strength shall be calculated by Criterion No. 3 of ACI 214 using the actual standard of deviation. 5. Concrete that fails to meet the ACI requirements and these Specifications is subject to removal and replacement. E. Shrinkage Tests: 1. Drying shrinkage tests shall be performed for the trial batches indicated in the Article below entitled "Trial Batch and Laboratory Tests," the first placement of each class of structural concrete, and during construction to insure continued compliance with these specifications. 2. Drying shrinkage specimens shall be 4-inch by 4-inch by 11-inch prisms with an effective gauge length of 10-inches; fabricated, cured, dried, and measured in accordance with ASTM C 157 - Test Method for Length Change of Hardened Hydraulic Cement Mortar and Concrete, modified as follows: specimens shall be removed from molds at an age of 23 hours plus or minus 1 hour after trial batching, shall be placed immediately in water at 70 degrees F plus or minus 3 degrees F for at least 30 minutes, and shall be measured within 30 minutes thereafter to determine original length and then submerged in saturated lime water at 73 degrees F plus or minus 3 degrees F. Measurement to determine expansion expressed as a percentage of original length shall be made at age 7 Days, This length at age 7 Days shall be the base length for drying shrinkage calculations ("0" days drying age). Specimens then shall be stored immediately in a humidity control room maintained at 73 degrees F plus or minus 3 degrees F and 50 percent plus or minus 4 percent relative humidity for the remainder of the test. Measurements to determine shrinkage expressed as percentage of base length shall be made and reported separately for 7, 14, 21, and 28 Days of drying after 7 Days of moist curing. 3. The drying shrinkage deformation of each specimen shall be computed as the difference between the base length (at "0" days drying age) and the length after drying at each test age. The average drying shrinkage deformation of the specimens shall be computed to the nearest 0.0001 inch at each test age. If the drying shrinkage of any specimen departs from the average of that test age by more than 0.0004-inch, the results obtained from that specimen shall be disregarded. Results of the shrinkage test shall be reported to the nearest 0.001 percent of shrinkage. Compression test specimens shall be taken in each case from the same concrete used for preparing drying shrinkage specimens. These tests shall be considered a part of the normal compression tests for the project. Allowable shrinkage limitations shall be as indicated in Part 2 below. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 -4 F. Aggregate Testing: Aggregate testing shall be made for the trial batch in the Article below entitled "Trial Batch and Laboratory Tests," prior to construction and every 12 months during construction to insure continued compliance with these specifications. G. Construction Tolerances: The CONTRACTOR shall set and maintain concrete forms and perform finishing operations to ensure that the completed WORK is within tolerances. Surface defects and irregularities are defined as finishes and are to be distinguished from tolerances. Tolerance is the permissible variation from lines, grades, or dimensions indicated on the Drawings. Where tolerances are not stated in the specifications, permissible deviations will be in accordance with ACI 117 — Standard Tolerance for Concrete Construction and Materials. 1. The following non-cumulative construction tolerances apply to finished walls and slab unless otherwise indicated: Item Tolerance Variation of the constructed linear outline In 10 feet: 1/4-inch; from the established position in plan. In 20 feet or more: 1/2-inch Variation from the level or from the grades In 10 feet: 1/4-inch; indicated. In 20 feet or more: 1/2-inch Variation from plumb In 10 feet: 1/4-inch; In 20 feet or more: 1/2-inch Variation in the thickness of slabs and Minus 1/4-inch; walls. Plus 1/2-inch Variation in the locations and sizes of slabs Plus or minus 1/4-inch and wall openings PART 2-- PRODUCTS 2.1 CONCRETE MATERIALS A. General 1. Cement for concrete shall not be obtained from kilns that burn metal rich hazardous waste fuel. 2. Materials shall be delivered, stored, and handled so as to prevent damage by water or breakage. Cement reclaimed from cleaning bags or leaking containers shall not be used. Cement shall be used in the sequence of receipt of shipments. B. Materials shall comply with the requirements of Sections 201, 203, and 204 of ACI 301, as applicable. C. Storage of materials shall conform to the requirements of Section 205 of ACI 301. D. Materials for concrete shall conform to the following requirements: 1. Cement shall be standard brand portland cement conforming to ASTM C 150 — Portland Cement, for Type II or Type V. A minimum of 85 percent of cement by MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 5 weight shall pass a 325 screen. A single brand of cement shall be used throughout the WORK, and prior to its use, the brand shall be accepted by the ENGINEER. The cement shall be suitably protected from exposure to moisture until used. Cement that has become lumpy shall not be used. Sacked cement shall be stored in such a manner so as to permit access for inspection and sampling. Certified mill test reports, including fineness, for each shipment of cement to be used shall be submitted to the ENGINEER, if requested, regarding compliance with these specifications. 2. Water for mixing and curing shall be potable, clean, and free from objectionable quantities of silty organic matter, alkali, salts, and other impurities. The water shall be considered potable, for the purposes of this Section only, if it meets the requirements of the local governmental agencies. Agricultural water with high total dissolved solids (greater than 1000 mg/I TDS) shall not be used. 3. Aggregates shall be obtained from pits acceptable to the ENGINEER, shall be non- reactive, and shall conform to the requirements of ASTM C 33 — Concrete Aggregates. Maximum size of coarse aggregate shall be as indicated. Lightweight sand for fine aggregate will not be permitted. a. Coarse aggregates shall consist of clean, hard, durable gravel, crushed gravel, crushed rock, or a combination thereof. The coarse aggregates shall be prepared and handled in 2 or more size groups for combined aggregates with a maximum size greater than 3/4-inch. When the aggregates are proportioned for each batch of concrete, the 2 size groups shall be combined. See the article below entitled "Trial Batch and Laboratory Tests" for the use of the size groups. b. Fine aggregates shall be natural sand or a combination of natural and manufactured sand that is hard and durable. When tested in accordance with ASTM D 2419 — Test Methods for Sand Equivalent Value of Soils and Fine Aggregate, the sand equivalency shall not be less than 75 percent for an average of 3 samples, nor less than 70 percent for an individual test. Gradation of fine aggregate shall conform to ASTM C 33 when tested in accordance with ASTM C 136 for the fineness modulus of the sand used, including the optional grading in Section 6.2. The fineness modulus of sand used shall not be over 3.1. c. Combined aggregates shall be well graded from coarse to fine sizes and shall be uniformly graded between screen sizes to produce a concrete that has optimum workability and consolidation characteristics. Where a trial batch is required for a mix design, the final combined aggregate gradations will be established during the trial batch process. d. When tested in accordance with ASTM C. 33, the ratio of silica released to reduction in alkalinity shall not exceed 1.0. e. When tested in accordance with ASTM C 33, the fine aggregate shall produce a color in the supernatant liquid no darker than the reference standard color solution. f. When tested in accordance with ASTM C 33, the coarse aggregate shall show a loss not exceeding 42 percent after 500 revolutions or 10.5 percent after 100 revolutions. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 -6 g. When tested in accordance with ASTM C 33, the loss resulting after 5 cycles of the soundness test shall not exceed 10 percent for fine aggregate and 12 percent for coarse aggregate when using sodium sulfate. 4. Ready-mix concrete shall conform to the requirements of ASTM C 94 — Ready Mixed Concrete. 5. Admixtures: Admixtures shall be compatible and be furnished by a single manufacturer capable of providing qualified field service representation. Admixtures shall be used in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations. If the use of an admixture is producing an inferior end result, the CONTRACTOR shall discontinue use of the admixture. Admixtures shall not contain thiocyanates nor more than 0.05 percent chloride ion, and shall be non-toxic after 30 days. a. Air-entraining agent meeting the requirements of ASTM C 260 — Air Entraining Admixtures for Concrete shall be used. Sufficient air-entraining agent shall be used to provide a total air content of 3 to 5 percent. Concrete floors to receive a dry-shake floor hardener shall have an air content not to exceed 3 percent. The OWNER reserves the right, at any time, to sample and test the air- entraining agent. The air-entraining agent shall be added to the batch in a portion of the mixing water. The solution shall be batched by means of a mechanical batcher capable of accurate measurement. Air content shall be tested at the point of placement. Air entraining agent shall be Micro-Air by Master Builders; Daravair by W.R. Grace; Sika AEA-15 by Sika Corporation; or equal. b. Set controlling and water reducing admixtures: Admixtures may be added at the CONTRACTOR's option, subject to the ENGINEER's approval, to control the set, effect water reduction, and increase workability. The cost of adding an admixture shall be the CONTRACTOR's responsibility. Concrete containing an admixture shall be first placed at a location determined by the ENGINEER. Admixtures shall conform to the requirements of ASTM C 494 — Chemical Admixtures for Concrete. The required quantity of cement shall be used in the mix regardless of whether or not an admixture is used. 1) Concrete shall not contain more than one water reducing admixture. 2) Set controlling admixture may be either with or without water-reducing properties. Where the air temperature at the time of placement is expected to be consistently greater than 80 degrees F, a set retarding admixture such as Plastocrete 161MR by Sika Corporation; Pozzolith 300R by Master Builders; Daratard by W.R. Grace; or equal shall be used. Where the air temperature at the time of placement is expected to be consistently less than 40 degrees F, a non-corrosive set accelerating admixture such as Plastocrete 161 FL by Sika Corporation; Pozzutec 20 by Master Builders; Polarset by W.R. Grace; or equal shall be used. 3) Normal range water reducer shall conform to ASTM C 494, Type A. WRDA 64 or 79 by W.R. Grace; Pozzolith 322-N by Master Builders; Plastocrete 161 by Sika Corporation; or equal. The quantity of admixture used and the method of mixing shall be in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions and recommendations. 4) High range water reducer shall conform to ASTM C 494, Type F or G. Daracem 100 or ADVA 100 by W.R. Grace; Sikament FF or Sikament 86 by Sika Corporation; Rheobuild 1000 by Master Builders; or equal. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 7 High range water reducer shall be added to the concrete after all other ingredients have been mixed and initial slump has been verified. No more than 14 ounces of water reducer per sack of cement shall be used. Water reducer shall be considered as part of the mixing water when calculating the water/cement ratio. 5) Concrete shall be mixed at mixing speed for a minimum of 70 mixer revolutions or 5 minutes after the addition of the high range water reducer, unless recommended otherwise by the manufacturer. 6) Flyash: Flyash shall not be used. 2.2 CURING MATERIALS A. Materials for curing concrete shall conform to the following requirements and ASTM C 309 — Liquid Membrane — Forming Components for Curing Concrete. 1. Curing compounds shall be white pigmented, resin based, and compliant with local VOC requirements. Sodium silicate compounds shall not be allowed. Concrete curing compound shall be Kurez VOX White Pigmented by Euclid Chemicals Company; L&M Cure R-2 by L&M Construction Chemicals; 1200-White by W.R. Meadow; or equal. When curing compound must be removed for finishes or grouting, compounds shall be Korez DR VOX by Euclid Chemical Company; Masterkure-100W by ChemRex MBT; L&M Cure R-2 by L & M Construction Chemicals;1100-Clear by W.R. Meadows; or equal. 2. Polyethylene sheet for use as concrete curing blanket shall be white and shall have a nominal thickness of 6 mils. The loss of moisture when determined in accordance with the requirements of ASTM C 156 — Test Method for Water Retention by Concrete Curing Materials, shall not exceed 0.055 grams per square centimeter of surface. 3. Polyethylene-coated waterproof paper sheeting for use as concrete curing blanket shall consist of white polyethylene sheeting free of visible defects, uniform in appearance, have a nominal thickness of 2 mils, and be permanently bonded to waterproof paper conforming to the requirements of Federal Specification UU-B- 790A — Building Paper, Vegetable Fiber (Kraft, Waterproofed, Water Repellant and Fire Resistant). The loss of moisture, when determined in accordance with the requirements of ASTM C 156, shall not exceed 0.055 gram per square centimeter of surface. 4. Polyethylene-coated burlap for use as concrete curing blanket shall be 4 mil thick, white opaque polyethylene film impregnated or extruded into one side of the burlap. Burlap shall weigh not less than 9 ounces per square yard. The loss of moisture, when determined in accordance with the requirements of ASTM C 156, shall not exceed 0.055 grams per square centimeter of surface. 5. Curing mats for use in Curing Method 6 below, shall be heavy shag rugs or carpets or cotton mats quilted at 4-inches on center. Curing mats shall weigh a minimum of 12 ounces per square yard when dry. 6. Evaporation retardant shall be a material such as Confilm by ChemRex MBT; Eucobar by Euclid Chemical Company; E-CON by L & M Construction Chemicals, Inc.; or equal. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 8 2.3 NON-WATERSTOP JOINT MATERIALS A. Materials for non-waterstop joints in concrete shall conform to the,following requirements: 1. Preformed joint filler shall be a non-extruding, neoprene sponge or polyurethane type conforming to Section 03290 - Joints in Concrete. 2. Elastomeric joint sealer shall conform to the requirements of Section 07920 - Sealants and Caulking. 3. Mastic joint sealer shall be a material that does not contain evaporating solvents; that will tenaciously adhere to concrete surfaces; that will remain permanently resilient and pliable; that will not be affected by continuous presence of water and will not in any way contaminate potable water; and that will effectively seal the joints against moisture infiltration even when the joints are subject to movement due to expansion and contraction. The sealer shall be composed of special asphalts or similar materials blended with lubricating and plasticizing agents to form a tough, durable mastic substance containing no volatile oils or lubricants and shall be capable of meeting the test requirements set forth below, if testing is required by the ENGINEER. 2.4 MISCELLANEOUS MATERIALS A. Dampproofing agent shall be an asphalt emulsion such as Hydrocide 600 by ChemRex Sonneborn; Emulsified Asphalt by Euclid Chemical Company; Sealmastic by W. R. Meadows Inc., or equal. B. Bonding agents shall be epoxy adhesives conforming to the following: 1. For bonding freshly-mixed, plastic concrete to hardened concrete, Sikadur 32 Hi- Mod Epoxy Adhesive by Sika Corporation; Concresive Liquid (LPL), by ChemRex MBT; BurkEpoxy MV by Burke by Edoco; or equal. 2. For bonding hardened concrete or masonry to steel, Sikadur 31 Hi-Mod Gel by Sika Corporation; BurkEpoxy NS by Burke by Edoco; Concresive Paste (LPL) by ChemRex MBT; or equal. C. Vapor Retarder: Vapor retarder shall be 30-mil thick, Class A, 3 ply, nylon or polyester cord reinforced high density polyethylene sheet laminated to a non-woven geotextile fabric, in accordance with ASTM E 1745 - Plastic Water Vapor Retarders Used in Contact with Soil or Granular Fill Under Concrete Slabs. Reef Industries, Inc., Griffolyn T-65 G or equal. D. Granular Material Above Vapor Retarder: Crushed stone, gravel, or sand with the following size distribution and meeting the deleterious substance limits of ASTM C 33 for fine aggregates. Sieve Size Percentage Passing 3/8-inch 100 4.75 mm 85-100 MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 -9 1 No. 100 10—30 E. Seams in vapor retarder sheet shall be sealed with tape, adhesive, or other material as recommended by sheet manufacturer for the areas to be sealed and sheet material. F. Colorant for duct bank concrete shall be an integral red oxide coloring pigment used in the proportion of 8 pounds per cubic yard of concrete. 2.5 CONCRETE DESIGN REQUIREMENTS A. General: Concrete shall be composed of cement, admixtures, aggregates, and water of the qualities indicated. The exact proportions in which these materials are to be used for different parts of the WORK will be determined during the trial batch. In general, the mix shall be designed to produce a concrete capable of being deposited so as to obtain maximum density and minimum shrinkage, and, where deposited in forms, to have good consolidation properties and maximum smoothness of surface. The aggregate gradations shall be formulated to provide fresh concrete that will not promote rock pockets around reinforcing steel or embedded items. The proportions shall be changed whenever necessary or desirable to meet the required results. Changes shall be subject to review by the ENGINEER. B. Fine Aggregate Composition: In mix designs for structural concrete, the percentage of fine aggregate in total aggregate by weight, shall be as indicated in the following table. FINE AGGREGATE Fineness Modulus Maximum Percent 2.7 or less 41 2.7 to 2.8 42 2.8 to 2.9 43 2.9 to 3.1 44 1. For other concrete, the maximum percentage of fine aggregate of total aggregate, by weight, shall not exceed 50. C. Duct bank concrete shall contain an integral red-oxide coloring pigment. Concrete shall be dyed red throughout. Surface treatment to color duct banks will not be acceptable. D. Water/Cement Ratio and Compressive Strength: The water/cement ratio indicated is for saturated-surface dry condition of aggregate. Every day, throughout the day, the batch water added shall be adjusted for the total free-water in the aggregates. 1. Total free moisture of aggregates shall be determined by: a. Starting with the total moisture content of all aggregate, calculated by ASTM C 566 -Test Method for Total Moisture Content of Aggregate by Drying b. Subtracting the moisture absorbed by the coarse aggregate, calculated by ASTM C 127 — Standard Test Method for Density, Relative Density (Specific Gravity) and Absorption of Coarse Aggregate MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 10 c. Subtracting the moisture absorbed by the fine aggregate, calculated by ASTM C 128 — Standard Test Method for Density, Relative Density (Specific Gravity) and Absorption of Fine Aggregate 2. Concrete shall have the following minimum properties: Type of Work Min 28-Day Maximum Size Cement Content Maximum Compressive Aggregate, in per cubic yd, lbs. W/C Ratio Strength, psi (by weight) Structural Concrete Roof, floor slabs, columns, walls, and all other 4,000 1 564 to 600 0.45 concrete items not indicated elsewhere. 12-inch and thicker walls, 4,000 1-1/2 564 to 600 0.45 slabs on grade, and footings (optional) Pea Gravel Concrete 1.At starter wall 2.In thin sections and areas with congested reinforcing, at the CO NTRACTO R's option and with 4,000 3/8 752 to 788 0.40 the written approval of the ENGINEER for the specific location. Maximum fine aggregate 50 percent by weight of aggregate. Sitework 3,000 1 470 (min) 0.50 concrete Lean concrete 2,000 1 376 (min) 0.60 NOTE: The CONTRACTOR is cautioned that the limiting parameters above are not a mix design. Admixtures may be required to achieve workability required by the CONTRACTOR'S construction methods and aggregates. The CONTRACTOR is responsible for providing concrete with the required workability. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 11 E. Adjustments to Mix Design: The CONTRACTOR may elect to decrease the water/cement ratio to achieve the strength and shrinkage requirements and/or add water reducers, as required to achieve workability. The mixes shall be changed whenever such change is necessary or desirable to secure the required strength, density, workability, and surface finish, and the CONTRACTOR shall be entitled to no additional compensation because of such changes. Any changes to the accepted concrete mix design shall be submitted to the ENGINEER for review and shall be tested again in accordance with these Specifications. 2.6 CONSISTENCY A. The quantity of water in a batch of concrete shall be just sufficient, with a normal mixing period, to produce a concrete that can be worked properly into place without segregation and which can be compacted by vibratory methods to give the desired density, impermeability, and smoothness of surface. The quantity of water shall be changed as necessary, with variations in the nature or moisture content of the aggregates, to maintain uniform production of a desired consistency. The consistency of the concrete in successive batches shall be determined by slump tests in accordance with ASTM C 143 — Test Method for Slump of Hydraulic Cement Concrete. The slumps shall be as follows: Part of Work Slump (in) All concrete, unless indicated otherwise 3 inches plus or minus 1 inch With high range water reducer added 7 inches plus or minus 2 inches Pea gravel mix 7 inches plus or minus 2 inches Ductbank and pipe encasement 5 inches plus or minus 1 inch 2.7 TRIAL BATCH AND LABORATORY TESTS A. The CONTRACTOR shall only use a mix design for construction that has first met the trial batch testing requirements. B. Before placing any concrete, a testing laboratory selected by the ENGINEER shall prepare a trial batch of each class of structural concrete, based on the preliminary concrete mixes submitted by the CONTRACTOR. During the trial batch the aggregate proportions may be adjusted by the testing laboratory using the two coarse aggregate size ranges to obtain the required properties. If one size range produces an acceptable mix, a second size range need not be used. Such adjustments will be considered refinements to the mix design and will not be the basis for extra compensation to the CONTRACTOR. Concrete shall conform to the requirements of this Section, whether the aggregate proportions are from the CONTRACTOR's preliminary mix design, or whether the proportions have been adjusted during the trial batch process. The trial batch shall be prepared using the aggregates, cement, and admixture proposed for the project. The trial batch materials shall be of a quantity such that the testing laboratory can obtain 3 drying shrinkage, and 6 compression test specimens from each batch. C. The determination of compressive strength will be made by testing 6-inch diameter by 12-inch high cylinders; made, cured and tested in accordance with ASTM C 192 - Practice for Making and Curing Concrete Test Specimens in the Laboratory and ASTM C 39. Three compression test cylinders will be tested at 7 Days and 3 at 28 Days. The MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 12 average compressive strength for the 3 cylinders tested at 28 Days for any given trial batch shall not be less than 125 percent of the indicated compressive strength. D. A sieve analysis of the combined aggregate for each trial batch shall be performed according to the requirements of ASTM C 136 — Method for Sieve Analysis of Fine and Coarse Aggregates. Values shall be given for percent passing each sieve. 2.8 SHRINKAGE LIMITATION A. The maximum concrete shrinkage for specimens cast in the laboratory from the trial batch, as measured at 21 Day drying age or at 28 Day drying age shall be 0.036 percent or 0.042 percent, respectively. Standard deviation will not be considered. The CONTRACTOR shall only use a mix design for construction that has first met the trial batch shrinkage requirements. Shrinkage limitations apply only to structural concrete. B. The maximum concrete shrinkage for specimens cast in the field shall not exceed the trial batch maximum shrinkage requirement by more than 25 percent. C. If the required shrinkage limitation is not met during construction, the CONTRACTOR shall take any or all of the following actions to reestablish compliance. These actions may include changing the source of aggregates, cement and/or admixtures; reducing water/cement ratio; washing of coarse and/or fine aggregate to reduce fines; increasing the number of construction joints; modifying the curing requirements; or other actions designed to minimize shrinkage or the effects of shrinkage. 2.9 MEASUREMENT OF CEMENT AND AGGREGATE A. The amount of cement and of each separate size of aggregate entering into each batch of concrete shall be determined by direct weighing equipment furnished by the CONTRACTOR and acceptable to the ENGINEER. B. Weighing tolerances Material Percent of Total Weight Cement 1 Aggregates 3 Admixtures 3 2.10 MEASUREMENT OF WATER A. The quantity of water entering the mixer shall be measured by a suitable water meter or other measuring device of a type acceptable to the ENGINEER and capable of measuring the water in variable amounts within a tolerance of one percent. The water feed control mechanism shall be capable of being locked in position so as to deliver constantly any required amount of water to each batch of concrete. A positive quick- acting valve shall be used for a cut-off in the water line to the mixer. The operating mechanism shall prevent leakage when the valves are closed. 2.11 READY-MIXED CONCRETE A. At the CONTRACTOR's option, ready-mixed concrete may be used if it meets the requirements as to materials, batching, mixing, transporting, and placing indicated herein MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 13 and is in accordance with ASTM C 94, including the following supplementary requirements. B. Ready-mixed concrete shall be delivered to the WORK, and discharge shall be completed within one hour after the addition of the cement to the aggregates or before the drum has been revolved 250 revolutions, whichever is first. C. Truck mixers shall be equipped with electrically actuated counters by which the number of revolutions of the drum or blades may be readily verified. The counter shall be of the resettable, recording type, and shall be mounted in the driver's cab. The counters shall be actuated at the time of starting mixers at mixing speeds. D. Each batch of concrete shall be mixed in a truck mixer for not less than 70 revolutions of the drum or blades at the rate of rotation designated by the manufacturer of equipment. Additional mixing, if any, shall be at the speed designated by the manufacturer of the equipment as agitating speed. Materials including mixing water shall be in the mixer drum before actuating the revolution counter for determining the number of revolution of mixing. E. Truck mixers and their operation shall be such that the concrete throughout the mixed batch as discharged is within acceptable limits of uniformity with respect to consistency, mix, and grading. If slump tests taken at approximately the 1/4 and 3/4 points of the load during discharge give slumps differing by more than one-inch when the required slump is 3 inches or less, or if they differ by more than 2 inches when the required slump is more than 3 inches, the mixer shall not be used on the WORK unless the causative condition is corrected and satisfactory performance is verified by additional slump tests. Mechanical details of the mixer, such as water measuring and discharge apparatus, condition of the blades, speed of rotation, general mechanical condition of the unit, and clearance of the drum, shall be checked before a further attempt to use the unit will be permitted. F. Each batch of ready-mixed concrete delivered to the Site shall be accompanied by a delivery ticket furnished to the ENGINEER in accordance with the Paragraph above entitled "Delivery Tickets." G. The use of non-agitating equipment for transporting ready-mixed concrete will not be permitted. Combination truck and trailer equipment for transporting ready-mixed concrete will not be permitted. The quality and quantity of materials used in ready-mixed concrete and in batch aggregates shall be subject to continuous inspection at the batching plant by the ENGINEER. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 PROPORTIONING AND MIXING A. Proportioning: Proportioning of the mix shall conform to the requirements of Chapter 3 "Proportioning" of ACI 301. B. Mixing: Mixing shall conform to the requirements of Chapter 7 of ACI 301. C. Slump: Slumps shall be as indicated herein. D. Retempering: Retempering of concrete or mortar that has partially hardened shall not be permitted. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 14 3.2 PREPARATION OF SURFACES FOR CONCRETING A. General: Earth surfaces shall be thoroughly wetted by sprinkling prior to the placing of any concrete, and these surfaces shall be kept moist by frequent sprinkling up to the time of placing concrete thereon. The surface shall be free from standing water, mud, and debris at the time of placing concrete. B. Vapor Retarder Sheet: 1. Sheet shall be installed under on-grade building floor slabs of occupiable (non- hydraulic) structures and at other locations indicated. 2. Sand base shall be at least 2 inches thick within the foundation line after moistening and compaction by mechanical means. Sand surface shall be flat and level within a tolerance of plus 0-inches to minus 3/4-inch. 3. Place, protect, and repair defects in sheet according to ASTM E 1643 — Standard Practice for Installation of Water Vapor Retarders Used in Contact with Earth or Granular Fill Under Concrete Slabs, and the manufacturer's written instructions. Seams shall be lapped and sealed in accordance with ASTM E 1643. 4. Granular material above the sheet shall be moistened and compacted to 2-inch thickness within the same flatness criteria as the sand base. C. Joints in Concrete: Concrete surfaces upon or against which concrete is to be placed, where the placement of the concrete has been stopped or interrupted so that, as determined by the ENGINEER, the new concrete cannot be incorporated integrally with that previously placed, are defined as construction joints. The surfaces of horizontal joints shall be given a compacted, roughened surface for good bonding. Except where the Drawings call for joint surfaces to be coated, the joint surfaces shall be cleaned of all laitance, loose or defective concrete, foreign material, and be roughened to a minimum 1/4-inch amplitude. Such cleaning and roughening shall be accomplished by hydroblasting or sandblasting (exposing aggregate) followed by thorough washing. Pools of water shall be removed from the surface of construction joints before the new concrete is placed. D. After the surfaces have been prepared, each approximately horizontal construction joint shall be covered with a 6-inch lift of a pea gravel mix. The mix shall be placed and spread uniformly. Wall concrete shall follow immediately and shall be placed upon the fresh pea gravel mix. E. Placing Interruptions: When placing of concrete is to be interrupted long enough for the concrete to take a set, the working face shall be given a shape by the use of forms or other means that will secure proper union with subsequent WORK; provided that construction joints shall be made only where acceptable to the ENGINEER. F. Embedded Items: No concrete shall be placed until formwork, installation of parts to be embedded, reinforcement steel, and preparation of surfaces involved in the placing have been completed and accepted by the ENGINEER at least 4 hours before placement of concrete. Surfaces of forms and embedded items that have become encrusted with dried grout from previous usage shall be cleaned before the surrounding or adjacent concrete is placed. G. Inserts or other embedded items shall conform to the requirements herein. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 15 H. Reinforcement, anchor bolts, sleeves, inserts, and similar items shall be set and secured in the forms at locations indicated on the Drawings or shown by Shop Drawings and shall be acceptable to the ENGINEER before any concrete is placed. Accuracy of placement is the responsibility of the CONTRACTOR. I. Casting New Concrete Against Old: Where concrete is to be cast against old concrete (any concrete which is greater than 60 Days of age), the surface of the old concrete shall be thoroughly cleaned and roughened by hydroblasting or sandblasting to expose aggregate. The joint surface shall be coated with an epoxy bonding agent unless indicated otherwise by the ENGINEER. J. No concrete shall be placed in any structure until all water entering the space to be filled with concrete has been properly cut off or has been diverted by pipes, or other means, and carried out of the forms, clear of the WORK. No concrete shall be deposited underwater nor shall the CONTRACTOR allow still water to rise on any concrete until the concrete has attained its initial set. Water shall not be permitted to flow over the surface of any concrete in such manner and at such velocity as will injure the surface finish of the concrete. Pumping or other necessary dewatering operations for removing ground water, if required, shall be subject to the review of the ENGINEER. K. Corrosion Protection: Pipe, conduit, dowels, and other ferrous items required to be embedded in concrete construction shall be so positioned and supported prior to placement of concrete that there will be a minimum of 2 inches clearance between said items and any part of the concrete reinforcement. Securing such items in position by wiring or welding them to the reinforcement will not be permitted. L. Openings for pipes, inserts for pipe hangers and brackets, and anchors shall, where practicable, be provided during the placing of concrete. M. Anchor bolts shall be accurately set and shall be maintained in position by templates while being embedded in concrete. N. Cleaning: The surfaces of metalwork to be in contact with concrete shall be thoroughly cleaned of dirt, grease, loose scale and rust, grout, mortar, and other foreign substances immediately before the concrete is placed. 3.3 HANDLING, TRANSPORTING, AND PLACING A. General: Placing of concrete shall conform to the applicable requirements of Chapter 8 of ACI 301 and the requirements of this Section. No aluminum materials shall be used in conveying any concrete. B. Non-Conforming WORK or Materials: Concrete, which during or before placing is found not to conform to the requirements indicated herein, shall be rejected and immediately removed from the WORK. Concrete which is not placed in accordance with these requirements or which is of inferior quality shall be removed and replaced. C. Unauthorized Placement: No concrete shall be placed except in the presence of a duly authorized representative of the ENGINEER. The CONTRACTOR shall notify the ENGINEER in writing at least 24 hours in advance of placement of any concrete. D. Placement in Wall and Column Forms: Concrete shall not be dropped through reinforcement steel or into any deep form, nor shall concrete be placed in any form in such a manner as to leave accumulation of mortar on the form surfaces above the placed concrete. In such cases, means such as hoppers and, if necessary, vertical ducts of canvas, rubber, or metal shall be used for placing concrete in the forms in a MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 16 manner that it may reach the place of final deposit without separation. In no case shall the free fall of concrete below the ends of ducts, chutes, or buggies exceed 4 feet in walls and 8 feet in columns. Concrete shall be uniformly distributed during the process of depositing and in no case after depositing shall any portion be displaced in the forms more than 6 feet in horizontal direction. Concrete in wall forms shall be deposited in uniform horizontal layers not deeper than 2 feet; and care shall be taken to avoid inclined layers or inclined construction joints except where such are required for sloping members. Each layer shall be placed while the previous layer is still soft. The rate of placing concrete in wall forms shall not exceed 5 feet of vertical rise per hour. Sufficient illumination shall be provided in the interior of forms so that the concrete at the places of deposit is visible from the deck or runway. E. Casting New Concrete Against Old: Epoxy adhesive bonding agent shall be applied to the old surfaces according to the manufacturer's written recommendations. This provision shall not apply to joints where waterstop is provided. See Section 03290 - Joints in Concrete. F. Conveyor Belts and Chutes: Ends of chutes, hopper gates, and other points of concrete discharge throughout the CONTRACTOR's conveying, hoisting, and placing system shall be designed and arranged so that concrete passing from them will not fall separated into whatever receptacle immediately receives it. Conveyor belts, if used, shall be of a type acceptable to the ENGINEER. Chutes longer than 50 feet will not be permitted. Minimum slopes of chutes shall be such that concrete of the indicated consistency will readily flow in them. If a conveyor belt is used, it shall be wiped clean by a device operated in such a manner that none of the mortar adhering to the belt will be wasted. Conveyor belts and chutes shall be covered. G. Placement in Slabs: Concrete placed in sloping slabs shall proceed uniformly from the bottom of the slab to the top, for the full width of the placement. As the WORK progresses, the concrete shall be vibrated and carefully worked around the slab reinforcement, and the surface of the slab shall be screeded in an up-slope direction. H. Temperature of Concrete: The temperature of concrete when it is being placed shall be not more than 90 degrees F nor less than 55 degrees F for sections less than 12 inches thick nor less than 50 degrees for other sections. Concrete ingredients shall not be heated to a temperature higher than that necessary to keep the temperature of the mixed concrete, as placed, from falling below the minimum temperature. When the temperature of the concrete is 85 degrees F or above, the time between the introduction of the cement to the aggregates and discharge shall not exceed 45 minutes. If concrete is placed when the weather is such that the temperature of the concrete would exceed 90 degrees F, the CONTRACTOR shall employ effective means, such as precooling of aggregates and mixing water using ice or placing at night, as necessary to maintain the temperature of the concrete below 90 degrees F as it is placed. The CONTRACTOR shall be entitled to no additional compensation on account of the foregoing requirements. I. Cold Weather Placement: 1. Placement of concrete shall conform to ACI 306.1 - Cold Weather Concreting, and the following. 2. Remove snow, ice, and frost from the surfaces, including reinforcement, against which concrete is to be placed. Before beginning concrete placement, thaw the subgrade to a minimum depth of 6-inches. Reinforcement and embedded items shall be warmed to above 32 degrees F prior to concrete placement. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 17 3. Maintain the concrete temperature above 50 degrees F for at least 72 hours after placement. 3.4 PUMPING OF CONCRETE A. General: If the pumped concrete does not produce satisfactory end results, the CONTRACTOR shall discontinue the pumping operation and proceed with the placing of concrete using conventional methods. B. Pumping Equipment: The pumping equipment shall have 2 cylinders and be designed to operate with one cylinder in case the other one is not functioning. In lieu of this requirement, the CONTRACTOR may have a standby pump on the Site during pumping. C. The minimum diameter of the hose conduits shall be in accordance with ACI 304.2R — Placing Concrete by Pumping Methods. D. Pumping equipment and hose conduits that are not functioning properly shall be replaced. E. Aluminum conduits for conveying the concrete shall not be permitted. F. Field Control: Concrete samples for slump, air content, and test cylinders will be taken at the placement end of the hose. 3.5 ORDER OF PLACING CONCRETE A. The order of placing concrete in all parts of the WORK shall be acceptable to the ENGINEER. In order to minimize the effects of shrinkage, the concrete shall be placed in units as bounded by construction joints at the indicated locations. The placing of units shall be done by placing alternate units in a manner such that each unit placed shall have cured at least 5 Days for hydraulic structures and 2 Days for all other structures before the contiguous unit or units are placed, except that the corner sections of vertical walls shall not be placed until the 2 adjacent wall panels have cured at least 10 Days for hydraulic structures and 4 Days for all other structures. B. The surface of the concrete shall be level whenever a run of concrete is stopped. To insure a level, straight joint on the exposed surface of walls, a wood strip at least 3/4- inch thick shall be tacked to the forms on these surfaces. The concrete shall be carried about 1/2-inch above the underside of the strip. About one hour after the concrete is placed, the strip shall be removed and any irregularities in the edge formed by the strip shall be leveled with a trowel and laitance shall be removed. 3.6 TAMPING AND VIBRATING A. As concrete is placed in the forms or in excavations, it shall be thoroughly settled and compacted throughout the entire depth of the layer which is being consolidated, into a dense, homogeneous mass, filling all corners and angles, thoroughly embedding the reinforcement, eliminating rock pockets, and bringing only a slight excess of water to the exposed surface of concrete. Vibrators shall be Group 3 per ACI 309 — Consolidation of Concrete, high speed power vibrators (8000 to 12,000 rpm) of an immersion type in sufficient number and with at least one standby unit as required. Group 2 vibrators may be used only at specific locations when accepted by the ENGINEER. B. Care shall be used in placing concrete around waterstops. The concrete shall be carefully worked by rodding and vibrating to make sure that all air and rock pockets have been eliminated. Where flat-strip type waterstops are placed horizontally, the concrete MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 18 shall be worked under the waterstops by hand, making sure that air and rock pockets have been eliminated. Concrete surrounding the waterstops shall be given additional vibration over and above that used for adjacent concrete placement to assure complete embedment of the waterstops in the concrete. C. Concrete in walls shall be internally vibrated and at the same time rammed, stirred, or worked with suitable appliances, tamping bars, shovels, or forked tools until it completely fills the forms or excavations and closes snugly against each surface. Subsequent layers of concrete shall not be placed until the layers previously placed have been worked thoroughly. Vibrators shall be provided in sufficient numbers, with standby units as required, to accomplish the required results within 15 minutes after concrete of the prescribed consistency is placed in the forms. The vibrating head shall not contact the surfaces of the forms. Care shall be taken not to vibrate concrete excessively or to work it in any manner that causes segregation of its constituents. 3.7 FINISHING CONCRETE SURFACES A. General: Surfaces shall be free from fins, bulges, ridges, offsets, honeycombing, or roughness of any kind, and shall present a finished, smooth, continuous hard surface. Allowable deviations from plumb or level and from the alignment, profiles, and dimensions indicated are defined as tolerances and are indicated above. These tolerances are to be distinguished from irregularities in finish as described herein. Aluminum finishing tools shall not be used. B. Formed Surfaces: Treatment is required after form removal, curing, repair of defective concrete, treatment of surface defects and as defined in Section 3.8 Architectural Finish. Where architectural finish is required, it shall be as indicated. 1. Surface holes larger than 1A-inch in diameter or deeper than 1/4-inch are defined as surface defects in basins and exposed walls. C. Unformed Surfaces: After proper and adequate vibration and tamping, unformed top surfaces of slabs, floors, walls, and curbs shall be brought to a uniform surface with suitable tools. Slabs shall be finished per the requirements of ACI 302.1R. Immediately after the concrete has been screeded, it shall be treated with a liquid evaporation retardant. The retardant shall be used again after each work operation as necessary to prevent drying shrinkage cracks. Round off edges of slabs with steel edging tool, except where cove or other finishes are shown. Steel edging tool radius shall be 1/4 inch for slabs subject to wheeled traffic. The classes of finish for unformed concrete surfaces are designated and defined as follows: 1. Finish U1 - Sufficient leveling and screeding to produce an even, uniform surface with surface irregularities not to exceed 3/8-inch. No further special finish is required. 2. Finish U2 — (Wood/Steel Float Finish) After sufficient stiffening of the screeded concrete, surfaces shall be float finished with wood or metal floats or with a finishing machine using float blades. Excessive floating of surfaces while the concrete is plastic and dusting of dry cement and sand on the concrete surface to absorb excess moisture will not be permitted. Floating shall be the minimum necessary to produce a surface that is free from screed marks and is uniform in texture. Surface irregularities shall not exceed 1/4-inch. Joints and edges shall be tooled where indicated or as determined by the ENGINEER. 3. Finish U3 — (Steel Troweled Finish) After the Finish U2 surface has hardened sufficiently to prevent excess of fine material from being drawn to the surface use MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 19 evaporation retarder. Steel troweling shall be performed with firm pressure such as will flatten the sandy texture of the floated surface and produce a dense, uniform surface free from blemishes, ripples, and trowel marks. The finish shall be smooth and free of all irregularities. The final troweling shall produce a ringing sound from the trowel. Excessive troweling is not permitted. Power trowel finishing will only be permitted when done in accordance with directions of machine manufacturer. 4. Finish U4 — (Broomed Finish) Trowel the Finish U3 surface to remove local depressions or high points. In addition, the surface shall be given a light broom finish with brooming perpendicular to drainage unless otherwise indicated. The resulting surface shall be rough enough to provide a nonskid finish. 5. Type U5 — (Sidewalk Finish) Slope walks down '/4 inch per foot away from structures, unless otherwise shown. Complete the Finish U4 with the broom finish perpendicular to the direction of travel or as shown. Lay out sidewalk surfaces in blocks, as shown or as directed by ENGINEER, with grooving tool. 6. Type U6 — (Concrete Curbs) Float top surface of curb smooth, and finish all discontinuous edges with steel edger. After concrete has taken its initial set, remove front form and give exposed vertical surface an ordinary wall finish, Type W-1. 7. Unformed surfaces shall be finished according to the following schedule: UNFORMED SURFACE FINISH SCHEDULE Area Finish Grade slabs and foundations to be covered with U1 concrete or fill material Floors to be covered with grouted tile or topping grout U2 Water bearing slabs with slopes 10 percent and less U3 Water bearing slabs with slopes greater than 10 U3 percent Slabs not water bearing U4 Slabs to be covered with built-up roofing U2 Interior slabs and floors to receive architectural finish U3 or protective coating system C-1 (See Section 09800) Top surface of walls (Exposed) U3 3.8 ARCHITECTURAL FINISH A. General: Architectural finishes shall be provided only where specifically indicated below or as shown on the Drawings. In other locations, the paragraph entitled Finishing Concrete Surfaces shall apply. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 -20 B. Type W-1 (Ordinary Wall Finish) Immediately after the forms have been stripped, the concrete surface shall be inspected and any poor joints, voids, rock pockets, or other defective areas shall be repaired and form-tie holes filled as indicated herein. C. Architectural finishes shall not be applied until the concrete surface has been repaired as required and the concrete has cured at least 14 Days. D. Architecturally treated concrete surfaces shall conform to the accepted sample in texture, color, and quality. It shall be the CONTRACTOR's responsibility to maintain and protect the concrete finish. E. Type W-2 (Smooth Wall Finish): Finish per type W-1 and repair any rough spots resulting from form release agent failure or other reasons to provide smooth uniform appearance. Provide 100 percent grind of wall surface resulting in uniform surface texture and appearance. F. Type W-3 (below grade waterproofed) 1. Concrete has been cured for a minimum of 14 days 2. Surface are light broom finish or smoother; dry, clean, firm, and free from laitance, frost, dust, dirt, oil, curing compounds or other foreign matter detrimental to performance of membrane. 3. Voids, cracks, holes, and other damaged surfaces have been repaired with material compatible with membrane. 4. Joint and transitions between planes are sharply formed and free of broken edges or loose aggregates, and are completely free of preformed joint fillers, sealants, or back-up material to depth at least twice width of joint. G. Type W-7 (Smooth Rubbed Concrete Finish) 1. The concrete surface shall be finished per Type W-1 and W-2 the same day forms are removed. The concrete surface shall then be wetted, and a grout shall be applied with a brush. The grout shall be made by mixing one part portland cement and one part of fine sand that will pass a No. 16 sieve with sufficient water to give it the consistency of thick paint. The cement used in said grout shall be 1/2 gray and 1/2 white portland cement, or other proportion as determined by the ENGINEER. White portland cement shall be Atlas white, or equal. Calcium chloride at 5 percent by volume of the cement shall be used in the brush coat. The freshly applied grout shall be vigorously rubbed into the concrete surface with a wood float filling all small air holes. After all the surface grout has been removed with a steel trowel, the surface shall be allowed to dry and, when dry, shall be vigorously rubbed with burlap to remove completely all surface grout so that there is no visible paint- like film of grout on the concrete. The entire cleaning operation for any area shall be completed the day it is started, and no grout shall be left on the surface overnight. 2. Cleaning operations for any given day shall be terminated at panel joints. It is required that the various operations be carefully timed to secure the desired effect which is a light-colored concrete surface of uniform color and texture without any appearance of a paint or grout film. 3. In the event that improper manipulation results in an inferior finish, the CONTRACTOR shall rub such inferior areas with carborundum bricks. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 21 4. Before beginning any of the final treatment on exposed surfaces, the CONTRACTOR shall treat in a satisfactory manner a trial area of at least 200 square feet in some inconspicuous place selected by the ENGINEER and shall preserve said trial area undisturbed until final completion. H. Type W-9 (Grout Cleaned Finish) 1. Meet requirement for Type W-7, and grout shall be 1 part Portland cement and 1-1/2 parts fine sand and boding agent to produce grout consistency of thick paint. White Portland cement shall be used for the entire portion of Portland cement in order to produce color matching of surrounding concrete, as determined by trial batch. 2. Wet surface of concrete sufficiently to prevent absorption of water fro grout uniformly with brushes or spray gun. A latex bonding admixture may be used. I. Sandblasted Concrete Finish: 1. Sandblasting shall be done in a safe manner acceptable to local authorities and per OSHA requirements. The sandblasting shall be a light sandblast to remove laitance and to produce a uniform fine aggregate surface texture with approximately 1/32- to 1/16-inch of surface sandblasted off. Corners, patches, form panel joints, and soft spots shall be sandblasted with care. 2. The CONTRACTOR shall provide a 3-sq ft sample panel of the sandblasted finish for acceptance by the ENGINEER prior to starting the sandblasting WORK. The sample panel shall include a corner, plugs, and joints and shall be marked after approval. Other sandblasting shall be equal in finish to the sample panel. 3. Protection against sandblasting shall be provided on adjacent surfaces and materials not requiring sandblasting. After sandblasting, the concrete surfaces shall be washed with clean water and excess sand removed.] J. Wall surfaces shall be finished according to the following schedule: WALL SURFACE FINISH SCHEDULE Area Finish Exterior Wall Surfaces Above grade/exposed (above a point 6" below finish W-2 grade Above grade/covered with brick veneer or other finish W-1 material Backfilled/waterproofed (below a point 6" below final W-3 grade) Backfilled/not waterproofed (below a point 6" below W-1 final grade) MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 22 Above grade walls requiring architectural finish per W-7 or W-9 drawings Interior Wall Surfaces Liquid holding structures not painted or coated W-1 Building and other dry areas not painted or coated W-2 3.9 CURING AND DAMPPROOFING A. General: Concrete shall be cured for not less than 7 Days after placing, in accordance with the methods indicated below for the different parts of the WORK. Surface to be Cured or Dampproofed Method Unstripped forms 1 Wall sections with forms removed 6 Construction joints between footings and walls, and between floor 2 slab and columns Encasement and ductbank concrete and thrust blocks 3 All concrete surfaces not specifically indicated in this Paragraph 4 Floor slabs on grade in hydraulic structures 5 Slabs not on grade, and concrete surface receiving coating, 6 hardener, and concrete wall surface receiving waterproofing All concrete containing silica fume 7 B. Method 1: Wooden forms shall be wetted immediately after concrete has been placed and shall be kept wet with water until removal. If steel forms are used the exposed concrete surfaces shall be kept continuously wet until the forms are removed. If forms are removed within 7 Days of placing the concrete, curing shall be continued in accordance with Method 6 below. C. Method 2: The surface shall be covered with burlap mats which shall be kept wet with water for the duration of the curing period, until the concrete in the walls has been placed. No curing compound shall be applied to surfaces.cured under Method 2.. D. Method 3: The surface shall be covered with moist earth not less than 4 hours nor more than 24 hours after the concrete is placed. Earthwork operations that may damage the concrete shall not begin until at least 7 Days after placement of concrete. E. Method 4: The surface shall be sprayed with a liquid curing compound. 1. It shall be applied in accordance with the manufacturer's printed instructions at a maximum coverage rate of 200 square feet per gallon and in such a manner as to cover the surface with a uniform film that will seal thoroughly. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 -23 2. Where the curing compound method is used, care shall be exercised to avoid damage to the seal during the 7 Day curing period. If the seal is damaged or broken before the expiration of the curing period, the break shall be repaired immediately by the application of additional curing compound over the damaged portion. 3. Wherever curing compound has been applied by mistake to surfaces against which concrete subsequently is to be placed and to which it is to adhere, compound shall be entirely removed by wet sandblasting just prior to the placing of new concrete. 4. Curing compound shall be applied as soon as the concrete has hardened enough to prevent marring on unformed surfaces and within 2 hours after removal of forms. Repairs to formed surfaces shall be made within the 2 hour period; provided, however, that any such repairs which cannot be made within the said 2 hour period shall be delayed until after the curing compound has been applied. When repairs are to be made to an area on which curing compound has been applied, the area involved shall first be wet-sandblasted to remove the curing compound. 5. At locations where concrete is placed adjacent to a panel which has been coated with curing compound, the panel shall have curing compound reapplied to an area within 6-feet of the joint and to any other location where the curing membrane has been disturbed. 6. Prior to final acceptance of the WORK, visible traces of curing compound shall be removed from surfaces in such a manner that does not damage the surface finish. F. Method 5: 1. Until the concrete surface is covered with curing compound, the entire surface shall be kept damp by applying water using nozzles that atomize the flow so that the surface is not marred or washed. The concrete shall be given a coat of curing compound in accordance with Method 4 above. Not less than one hour nor more than 4 hours after the curing compound has been applied, the surface shall be wetted with water delivered through a fog nozzle, and concrete-curing blankets shall be placed on the slabs. The curing blankets shall be polyethylene sheet, polyethylene-coated waterproof paper sheeting, or polyethylene-coated burlap. The blankets shall be laid with the edges butted together and with the joints between strips sealed with 2-inch wide strips of sealing tape or with edges lapped not less than 3-inches and fastened together with a waterproof cement to form a continuous watertight joint. 2. The curing blankets shall be left in place during the 7 Day curing period and shall not be removed until after concrete for adjacent work has been placed. If the curing blankets become torn or otherwise ineffective, the CONTRACTOR shall replace damaged sections. During the first 3 Days of the curing period, no traffic of any nature and no depositing, temporary or otherwise, of any materials shall be permitted on the curing blankets. During the remainder of the curing period, foot traffic and temporary depositing of materials that impose light pressure will be permitted only on top of plywood sheets 5/8-inch minimum thickness, laid over the curing blanket. The CONTRACTOR shall add water under the curing blanket as often as necessary to maintain damp concrete surfaces at all times. G. Method 6: This method applies to both walls and slabs. 1. The concrete shall be kept continuously wet by the application of water for a minimum period of at least 7 days beginning immediately after the concrete has MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 24 reached final set or forms have been removed. Wall surface receiving waterproofing shall be kept continuously wet by the application of water for a minimum period of at least 14 days immediately after forms have been removed. 2. Until the concrete surface is covered with the curing medium, the entire surface shall be kept damp by applying water using nozzles that atomize the flow so that the surface is not marred or washed. 3. Heavy curing mats shall be used as a curing medium to retain the moisture during the curing period. The curing medium shall be weighted or otherwise held substantially in contact with the concrete surface to prevent being dislodged by wind or any other causes. Edges shall be continuously held in place. 4. The curing blankets and concrete shall be kept continuously wet by the use of sprinklers or other means both during and after normal working hours. 5. Immediately after the application of water has terminated at the end of the curing period, the curing medium shall be removed, the entire concrete surface shall be wetted, and curing compound shall be immediately applied to the entire surface in accordance with Method 4 above. 6. The CONTRACTOR shall dispose of excess water from the curing operation to avoid damage to the WORK. H. Method 7: This method applies to concrete containing silica fume for walls and slabs and shall be used in addition to the curing methods 1 through 6, and shall be concluded within one hour of concrete placement. 1. In addition to the requirements of Method 1 for unstripped forms, Method 6 for walls after the forms are removed, and Method 4 for slabs, wall surfaces after the forms are removed and slab surfaces shall be coated with 2 coats of a white pigmented curing compound as indicated in Method 4 above. A second coat of white pigmented curing compound shall be applied to the concrete surface at 7 Days after the application of the initial coats. In addition, a prewetted burlap shall be placed over the flat work surface and kept continuously wet for a minimum of 7 Days or until the time necessary to attain 70 percent of the required compressive strength in accordance with ACI 308 Section 3.1.3. I. Dampproofing: 1. The exterior surfaces of roof slabs to be buried and walls to be backfilled shall be dampproofed as follows. 2. Immediately after completion of curing the surface shall be sprayed with a dampproofing agent consisting of an asphalt emulsion. Application shall be in 2 coats. The first coat shall be diluted to one-half strength by the addition of water and shall be sprayed on so as to provide a maximum coverage rate of 100 square feet per gallon of dilute solution. The second coat shall consist of an application of the undiluted material, and shall be sprayed on so as to provide a maximum coverage rate of 100 square feet per gallon. Dampproofing material shall be as indicated above. 3. As soon as the material has taken an initial set, the entire area thus coated shall be coated with whitewash. Any formula for mixing the whitewash may be used if it produces a uniformly coated white surface and remains until placing of the backfill. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 -25 If the whitewash fails to remain on the surface until the backfill is placed, the CONTRACTOR shall apply additional whitewash. 3.10 PROTECTION A. The CONTRACTOR shall protect concrete against injury until final acceptance. B. Fresh concrete shall be protected from damage due to rain, hail, sleet, or snow. The CONTRACTOR shall provide such protection while the concrete is still plastic and whenever precipitation is imminent or occurring. 3.11 CURING IN COLD WEATHER A. Water curing of concrete may be reduced to 6 Days during periods when the mean daily temperature in the vicinity of the Site is less than 40 degrees F; provided that, during the prescribed period of water curing, when temperatures are such that concrete surfaces may freeze, water curing shall be temporarily discontinued. B. Concrete cured by an application of curing compound will require no additional protection from freezing if the protection at 50 degrees F for 72 hours is obtained by means of approved insulation in contact with the forms or concrete surfaces; otherwise the concrete shall be protected against freezing temperatures for 72 hours immediately following 72 hours protection at 50 degrees F. Concrete cured by water shall be protected against freezing temperatures for 72 hours immediately following the 72 hours of protection at 50 degrees F. C. Discontinuance of protection against freezing temperatures shall be such that the drop in temperature of any portion of the concrete will be gradual and will not exceed 40 degrees F in 24 hours. In the spring, when the mean daily temperature rises above 40 degrees F for more than 3 successive Days, the required 72-hour protection at a temperature not lower than 50 degrees F may be discontinued for as long as the mean daily temperature remains above 40 degrees F; provided, that the concrete shall be protected against freezing temperatures for not less than 48 hours after placement. D. Where artificial heat is employed, special care shall be taken to prevent the concrete from drying. Use of unvented heaters will be permitted only when unformed surfaces of concrete adjacent to the heaters are protected for the first 24 hours from an excessive carbon dioxide atmosphere by application of curing compound; provided, that the use of curing compound for such surfaces is otherwise permitted. 3.12 TREATMENT OF SURFACE DEFECTS A. As soon as forms are removed, exposed surfaces shall be carefully examined and any irregularities shall be immediately rubbed or ground in a satisfactory manner in order to secure a smooth, uniform, and continuous surface. Plastering or coating of surfaces to be smoothed will not be permitted. No repairs shall be made until after inspection by the ENGINEER. In no case will extensive patching of honeycombed concrete be permitted. Concrete containing minor voids, holes, honeycombing, or similar depression defects shall be repaired as indicated below. Concrete containing extensive voids, holes, honeycombing, or similar depression defects shall be completely removed and replaced. Repairs and replacements shall be performed promptly. B. Defective surfaces to be repaired shall be cut back from trueline a minimum depth of 1/2-inch over the entire area. Feathered edges will not be permitted. Where chipping or cutting tools are not required in order to deepen the area properly, the surface shall be prepared for bonding by the removal of all laitance or soft material, plus not less than MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 - 26 1/32-inch depth of the surface film from all hard portions by means of an efficient sandblast. After cutting and sandblasting, the surface shall be wetted sufficiently in advance of shooting with shotcrete or with cement mortar so that while the repair material is being applied, the surfaces underneath will remain moist but not so wet as to overcome the suction upon which a good bond depends. The material used for repair shall consist of a mixture of one sack of cement to 3 cubic feet of sand. For exposed walls, the cement shall contain such a proportion of Atlas white portland cement as is required to make the color of the patch match the color of the surrounding concrete. C. Holes left by tie-rod cones shall be reamed with suitable toothed reamers so as to leave the surfaces of the holes clean and rough. Holes then shall be repaired in an approved manner with dry-packed cement grout. Holes left by form-tying devices having a rectangular cross-section and other imperfections having a depth greater than their least surface dimension shall not be reamed but shall be repaired in an approved manner with dry-packed cement grout. D. Repairs shall be built up and shaped in such a manner that the completed WORK will conform to the requirements of this Section, as applicable, using approved methods which will not disturb the bond, cause sagging, or cause horizontal fractures. Surfaces of repairs shall receive the same kind and amount of curing treatment as required for the concrete in the repaired section. E. Prior to filling any structure with water, cracks shall be "vee'd" as indicated and filled with sealant conforming to the requirements of Section 03290 - Joints in Concrete. This repair method shall be done on the water bearing face of members. Prior to backfilling, faces of members in contact with fill, which are not covered with a waterproofing membrane, shall also have cracks repaired as indicated herein. 3.13 PATCHING HOLES IN CONCRETE A. Patching Small Holes: 1. Holes that are less than 12 inches in the least dimension and extend completely through concrete members shall be filled. 2. Small holes in members that are water-bearing or in contact with soil or other fill material shall be filled with non-shrink grout. Where a face of the member is exposed to view, the non-shrink grout shall be held back 2 inches from the finished surface. The remaining 2 inches shall then be patched according to the Article above entitled "Treatment of Surface Defects." 3. Small holes through all other concrete members shall be filled with non-shrink grout, with exposed faces treated as above. B. Patching Large Holes: • 1. Holes which are larger than 12 inches in the least dimension shall have a keyway chipped into the edge of the opening all around, unless a formed keyway exists. The holes shall then be filled with concrete as indicated herein. 2. Holes which are larger than 24 inches in the least dimension and which do not have reinforcing steel extending from the existing concrete, shall have reinforcing steel set in grout in drilled holes. The reinforcing added shall match the reinforcing in the existing wall unless indicated otherwise. MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 -27 3. Large holes in members that are water bearing or in contact with soil or other fill shall have a hydrophilic type waterstop material placed around the perimeter of the hole in accordance with Section 03290 - Joints in Concrete, unless there is an existing waterstop in place. 3.14 CARE AND REPAIR OF CONCRETE A. The CONTRACTOR shall protect concrete against injury or damage from excessive heat, lack of moisture, overstress, or any other cause until final acceptance. Particular care shall be taken to prevent the drying of concrete and to avoid roughening or otherwise damaging the surface. Any concrete found to be damaged, or which may have been originally defective, or which becomes defective at any time prior to the final acceptance of the completed WORK, or which departs from the established line or grade, or which, for any other reason, does not conform to the requirements of the Contract Documents, shall be satisfactorily repaired or removed and replaced with acceptable concrete. - END OF SECTION - MWH-04082005 CAST-IN-PLACE CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03300 -28 SECTION 03315 - GROUT PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide grout, complete and in place, in accordance with the Contract Documents B. The following types of grout are covered in this Section: 1. Cement Grout 2. Non-Shrink Grout - Class I (cement based) 3. Non-Shrink Grout- Class II (cement based) 4. Non-Shrink Epoxy Grout 5. Epoxy Anchor Grout for Adhesive Anchors 6. Topping Grout and Concrete/Grout Fill 1.2 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. 1. Certified testing lab reports for tests indicated herein. 2. Test results and service report from the field tests and the demonstration and training session verifying the requirements indicated herein. 3. Certification that grouts used on the project contain no chlorides or other chemicals that cause corrosion. 4. Manufacturer's literature containing instructions and recommendations on the mixing, handling, placement, curing, and appropriate uses for each type of grout used in the WORK, and location of use. ICBO/ES report shall be submitted for epoxy anchor grout for adhesive anchors. 5. Manufacturer's certification that its non-shrink grout does not contain aluminum, zinc, or magnesium powders as a method of expansion. 6. Submit manufacturer's written warranty as indicated herein. 7. Name and telephone number of grout manufacturer's representative who will give on-Site service. The representative shall have at least one year of experience with the indicated grouts. MWH - 04082005 GROUT 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03315 - 1 1.3 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Field Tests 1. Compression test specimens will be taken from the first placement of each type of grout, and at intervals thereafter selected by the ENGINEER. The specimens will be made by the ENGINEER or its representative. 2. Compression tests and fabrication of specimens for cement grout and cement based non-shrink grout will be performed in accordance with ASTM C 1107 - Packaged Dry, Hydraulic-Cement Grout (Nonshrink), at intervals during construction selected by the ENGINEER. A set of 3 specimens will be made for testing at 7 Days, 28 Days, and each additional time period as appropriate. 3. Compression tests and fabrication of specimens for topping grout and concrete/grout fill will be performed in accordance with Section 03300 - Cast-in- Place Concrete, at intervals during construction selected by the ENGINEER. 4. Compression tests and fabrication of specimens for epoxy grouts will be performed in accordance with ASTM C 579 - Test Methods for Compressive Strength of Chemical-Resistant Mortars and Monolithic Surfacings and Polymer Concretes, Method B, at intervals during construction selected by the ENGINEER. A set of three specimens will be made for testing at 7 Days and each earlier time period as appropriate. 5. The cost of laboratory tests on grout will be paid by the OWNER except where test results show the grout to be defective. In such case, the CONTRACTOR shall pay for the tests, removal and replacement of Defective Work, and re-testing, all as part of the WORK. 6. The CONTRACTOR shall assist the ENGINEER in obtaining specimens for testing and shall furnish materials necessary for fabricating the test specimens. B. Construction Tolerances: Construction tolerances shall be as indicated in Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete unless indicated otherwise. C. Pre-Installation Demonstration and Training: 1. Cement and Epoxy-Based Non-Shrink Grouts a. The grout manufacturer shall give a demonstration and training session for the cement based non-shrink and epoxy grouts to be used on the project, before any installation of grout is allowed. b. Training session shall use a minimum of 5 bags of cement-based non-shrink class I grout mixed to fluid consistency. Tests shall be conducted for flow cone and bleed tests. Six cubes for testing at 1, 3, and 28 Days shall be made. The remaining grout shall be placed, and curing may be initiated on actual project placements such as baseplates and tie holes to provide on-the-job training for the CONTRACTOR and ENGINEER. The CONTRACTOR employees who will be doing the grouting shall participate in this training and demonstration session. The training session shall include methods for curing the grout. c. The manufacturer shall mix enough cement-based non-shrink class II grout for a minimum of 15 tie holes and shall train the CONTRACTOR's employees in MWH - 04082005 GROUT 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03315 -2 how to perform the WORK and cure the grout. The CONTRACTOR shall have the employees assisting in the mixing and sealing of the tie holes. d. If the project includes patching, throughbolt holes, epoxy anchors, and/or blockouts, the manufacturer shall also train the CONTRACTOR'S employees in the mixing and curing of the epoxy grouts for each of these applications. e. The CONTRACTOR shall transport the test cubes to an independent test laboratory, obtain the test reports, and report these demonstration and training test cube strengths to the ENGINEER. 2. Epoxy Anchor Grout for Adhesive Anchors a. Special inspection as recommended by the ICBO/ES report or as required by the building department shall be required for adhesive anchor installations. Cost of special inspection of adhesive anchors will be paid by the OWNER. b. Before installing adhesive anchors in the WORK, adhesive anchor installers shall be trained and qualified at the Site by the manufacturer's representative. Training and qualification for each installer shall include at least: 1) Hole drilling procedure, hole preparation and cleaning techniques, adhesive injection technique and dispenser training/maintenance, rebar dowel preparation and installation, and proof loading/torquing. 2) Anchors installed in both the vertical and horizontal positions in a mock- up concrete panel of adequate size and thickness. Anchors shall be tested in tension and shear loading. A minimum of 3 anchors shall be tested for each installation position. 3) Anchors shall be tested at 2 times the published allowable load in tension and in shear as indicated in the ICBO/ES report. 4) If any of the three test bolts in any installation position fail to reach the test loads, the installer shall be re-tested with the same procedure. Re- testing is required only for the failed installation position. 5) An installer who has three consecutive successful bolt tests in the first or second trial is considered qualified for adhesive anchor installation for this project. The manufacturer's representative shall issue a certificate to the qualified installer, and a copy of the certificate shall be filed with the CONTRACTOR and be submitted to the ENGINEER. 6) The test anchor size shall be the largest size adhesive anchor used on the project. The embedment length shall be long enough to develop the allowable steel strength per AISC Manual of Steel Construction. 7) Each installer shall be re-qualified every 6 months for the duration of the project by the same qualifying procedure. 8) The certification of each qualified installer shall be available for verification at the Special Inspector's request. 9) Defective anchors noted by the Special Inspector shall be replaced and re-installed by the CONTRACTOR without any additional compensation. MWH - 04082005 GROUT 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03315 - 3 1.4 SPECIAL CORRECTION OF DEFECTS PROVISIONS A. Manufacturer's Warranty 1. Furnish one-year warranty for WORK provided under this section. 2. Manufacturer's warranty shall not contain a disclaimer limiting responsibility to the purchase price of products or materials. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 APPLICATION A. Unless indicated otherwise, grouts shall be provided as listed below whether indicated on the Drawings or not. Application Type of Grout Anchor bolts and reinforcing steel required to be set in Non-Shrink - Class I grout in which the average working or operating temperature will be over 100 degrees F or in high fire risk areas. Anchor bolts and reinforcing steel required to be set in Epoxy Anchor Grout grout that is not in high temperature or high fire risk areas. Beam and column (1 or 2 story) base plates less than 16- Non-Shrink - Class I inches in the least dimension. Column base plates (greater than 2 story or larger than Non-Shrink - Class II 16 inches in the least dimension) Storage tanks and other non-motorized equipment and Non-Shrink - Class I machinery under 30 horsepower Pumps over 1000 horsepower, unless indicated otherwise Non-Shrink Epoxy Filling blockout spaces for embedded items such as Non-Shrink - Class I railing posts, gate guide frames, etc. (Class II where placement time exceeds 20 min.) Under precast concrete elements Non-Shrink - Class II Toppings and concrete/grout fill less than 3 inches thick Topping Grout Toppings and concrete/grout fill greater than 3 inches Structural Concrete thick per 03300 Surface repairs Cement Grout MWH - 04082005 GROUT 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03315-4 Repair of holes and defects in concrete members which Non-Shrink - Class I are not water bearing and not in contact with soil or other fill material Repair of holes and defects in concrete members which Non-Shrink - Class II are water bearing or in contact with soil or other fill materials Any application not listed above, where grout is called for Non-Shrink Class I, on the Drawings unless noted otherwise 2.2 CEMENT GROUT A. Cement grout shall be composed of one part cement, three parts sand, and the minimum amount of water necessary to obtain the desired consistency. Where needed to match the color of adjacent concrete, white portland cement shall be blended with regular cement as needed. The minimum compressive strength at 28 Days shall be 4000 psi. B. Cement grout materials shall be as indicated in Section 03300— Cast-in-Place Concrete. 2.3 NON-SHRINK GROUTS (cement based) A. General: 1. Cement-based non-shrink grout shall be a prepackaged, inorganic, fluid, non-gas- liberating, non-metallic, cement type grout requiring only the addition of water. Cement from kilns burning metal-rich hazardous waste fuel shall not be used. 2. Manufacturer's instructions shall be printed on each bag or other container in which the materials are packaged. The specific formulation for each class of non-shrink grout indicated herein shall be that recommended by the manufacturer for the particular application. 3. Grout shall not contain chlorides or additives that may contribute to corrosion. 4. Grout shall be formulated to be used at any consistency from fluid to plastic. 5. Cement-based non-shrink grout shall have the following minimum properties when tested at a fluid consistency, at 28 Days: a. Minimum tensile splitting strength of 500 psi per ASTM C 496 - Standard Test Method for Splitting Tensile Strength of Cylindrical Concrete Specimens. b. Minimum flexural strength of 1000 psi per ASTM C 580 - Standard Test Method for Flexural Strength and Modulus of Elasticity of Chemical-Resistant Mortars, Grouts, Monolithic Surfacings, and Polymer Concretes. c. Minimum bond strength (concrete to grout) of 1900 psi per modified ASTM C 882 - Standard Test Method for Bond Strength of Epoxy-Resin Systems Used with Concrete by Slant Shear. MWH -04082005 GROUT 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03315 - 5 d. Grout shall be certified for use in freeze/thaw environments. B. Class I Non-Shrink Grout: 1. Class I non-shrink grout shall have a minimum 28 Day compressive strength of 5000 psi when mixed at a fluid consistency. 2. Class I non-shrink grout shall meet the requirements of ASTM C 1107, Grade B or C, when mixed to fluid, flowable, and plastic consistencies. 3. Grout shall have a maximum early age height change of 4.0 percent expansion, and shall have no shrinkage (0.0 percent) in accordance with ASTM C 827 — Test Method for Early Volume Change of Cementitious Mixtures. The grout when tested shall not bleed or segregate at maximum allowed water. 4. Grout shall have no shrinkage (0.0 percent) and a maximum of 0.3 percent expansion in the hardened state when tested in accordance with ASTM C 1090 - Test Method for Measuring Changes in Height of Cylindrical Specimens from Hydraulic-Cement Grout. 5. Furnish certification that the non-shrink property of grout is not based on gas production or gypsum expansion. 6. Class I Non-Shrink Grout shall be Masterflow 713 Plus by MBT-Chemrex; Five Star Grout by Five Star Products; Sikagrout 212 by Sika Corporation; Premier by L&M Construction Chemicals; High-Flow Grout by Euclid Chemical Company; CG 200 PC by Hilti, or equal. C. Class II Non-Shrink Grout: 1. Class II non-shrink grout shall be a high precision, fluid, extended working time, grout. The minimum 28-Day compressive strength shall be 7500 psi, when mixed at a fluid consistency. 2. Grout shall have a maximum early age height change of 4.0 percent expansion, and shall have no shrinkage (0.0 percent) in accordance with ASTM C 827. 3. Grout shall have no shrinkage (0.0 percent) and a maximum of 0.3 percent expansion in the hardened state when tested in accordance with ASTM C 1090. 4. Class II non-shrink grout shall have an extended working time of 30 minutes minimum when mixed to a fluid consistency as defined in ASTM C 827 at temperature extremes of 45 to 90 degrees F in accordance with ASTM C 1107. 5. Class II non-shrink grout shall meet the requirements of ASTM C 1107, Grade B or C when tested using the amount of water needed to achieve fluid consistency per ASTM C 939. 6. The grout when tested shall not bleed or segregate at maximum allowed water content. 7. Provide certification that its non-shrink property is not based on gas production or gypsum expansion. MWH -04082005 GROUT 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03315 - 6 8. Class II non-shrink grout shall be Masterflow 928 by MBT-Chemrex; Five Star Fluid Grout 100 by Five Star Products; Crystex by L&M Construction Chemicals; or equal. 2.4 NON-SHRINK EPDXY GROUT A. Non-shrink epoxy grout shall be applied to the underside of large pump and motor bases as indicated. Application of grout shall be supervised by the grout manufacturer's representative. B. Non-shrink epoxy grout shall be a flowable, non-shrink, 100 percent solids system. The epoxy grout system shall have three components: resin, hardener, and specially blended aggregate, each premeasured and prepackaged. The resin component shall not contain any non-reactive diluents. Resins containing butyl glycidyl ether (BGE) or other highly volatile and hazardous reactive diluents are not acceptable. Variation of component ratios is not permitted unless specifically recommended by the manufacturer. Manufacturer's instructions shall be printed on each container in which the materials are packaged. C. Epoxy grout shall have a maximum early age height change of 4.0 percent expansion, and shall have no shrinkage (0.0 percent) in accordance with ASTM C 827, (modified for epoxy grouts by using an indicator ball with a specific gravity between 0.9 and 1.1). D. Epoxy grout shall have a negligible (less than 0.0006 in/in) length change after hardening, and a coefficient of thermal expansion less than 0.00003 in/in F when tested according to ASTM C 531 - Test Method for Linear Shrinkage and Coefficient of Thermal Expansion of Chemical-Resistant Mortars, Grouts, and Monolithic Surfacing. E. The epoxy grout shall develop a minimum compressive strength of 9000 psi in 24 hours and 13,000 psi in seven days when tested in accordance with ASTM C 579, method B. F. The mixed epoxy grout shall have a minimum working life of 90 to 120 minutes at 70 degrees F. G. The effective bearing area shall be a minimum of 95 percent EBA in accordance with ASTM C 1339 — Standard Test Method for Flowability and Bearing Area of Chemical- Resistant Polymer Machinery Grouts, for bearing area and flow. H. The chemical formulation of the epoxy grout shall be that recommended by the manufacturer for the particular application. Do not reduce aggregate loading or add solvents to increase flowability. I. Non-shrink epoxy grout shall have the following minimum properties when tested at 7 Days: 1. Minimum bond strength to concrete of 3000 psi per ASTM C 882 modified. 2. Minimum bond strength to steel of 1700 psi per ASTM C 882 modified. 3. Minimum flexural strength of 2500 psi per ASTM C 580. 4. Minimum tensile strength of 2000 psi per ASTM C 307 -- Standard Test Method for Tensile Strength of Chemical-Resistant Mortar, Grouts, and Monolithic Surfacings. MWH - 04082005 GROUT 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03315 - 7 J. Non-shrink epoxy grout shall be Five Star DP Epoxy Grout by Five Star Products, Inc.; Masterflow 648 CP Plus by MBT-Chemrex; Sikadur 42 Grout-Pak by Sika Corporation; or equal. 2.5 EPDXY ANCHOR GROUT A. Epoxy anchor grout shall conform to ASTM C 881 - Epoxy-Resin-Base Bonding Systems for Concrete, Type IV, Class A, B and C, Grade 3 with the exception of gel time. B. Heat deflection temperature per ASTM D 648 -- Test Method for Deflection Temperature of Plastics under Flexural Load shall be a minimum 120 degrees F. C. Manufacturer shall certify that the epoxy anchor grout will maintain 90 percent of its strength up to a temperature of 125 degrees F. D. Grout shall come in a two-chambered cartridge with a metering system that provides the proper ratio of hardener and resin. The grout shall also come with a static mixer nozzle to thoroughly mix the hardener and resin together. E. Epoxy anchor grout shall be capable of being used in submersed applications once cured. F. Compressive strength per ASTM D 695 - Test Method for Compressive Properties of Rigid Plastics shall be 10,000 psi minimum. G. If the average working or operating temperature will be over 100° F or in a high fire risk area, use cement based non-shrink grout and oversized holes. H. Overhead anchors and anchors in fire-resistive construction shall be cast-in anchors. I. Embedment of adhesive anchors/rebar shall be deep enough to develop the anchor/rebar. Embedment shall not exceed 67 percent of the member depth. J. Epoxy anchor grout shall be Epcon C6 by ITW Ramset/Red Head; Power-Fast Epoxy Injection Gel by Powers Fasteners; RE 500 by Hilti, Sikadur AnchorFix-4, or equal. 2.6 TOPPING GROUT AND CONCRETE/GROUT FILL A. Where fill is thicker than 3 inches, structural concrete, as indicated in Section 03300 - Cast-in-Place Concrete, may be used when accepted by the ENGINEER. B. Grout for topping of slabs and concrete/grout fill for built-up surfaces of tank, channel, and basin bottoms shall be composed of cement, fine aggregate, coarse aggregate, water, and admixtures proportioned and be mixed as indicated. Materials and procedures indicated for normal concrete in Section 03300 - Cast-in-Place Concrete, - shall apply unless indicated otherwise. C. Topping grout and concrete/grout fill shall contain a minimum of 564 pounds of cement per cubic yard with a maximum water cement ratio of 0.45. D. Coarse aggregate shall be graded as follows: MWH -04082005 GROUT 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03315 -8 U.S. STANDARD SIEVE SIZE PERCENT BY WEIGHT PASSING 1/2 in 100 3/8 in 90-100 No. 4 20-55 No. 8 5-30 No. 16 0-10 No. 30 0 E. Final mix design shall be as determined by trial mix design as indicated in Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete, except that drying shrinkage tests are not required. F. Strength: Minimum compressive strength of topping grout and concrete/grout fill at 28 Days shall be 4000 psi. 2.7 CURING MATERIALS A. Curing materials shall be in accordance with Section 03300, and as recommended by the manufacturer of prepackaged grouts. 2.8 CONSISTENCY A. The consistency of grouts shall be that necessary to completely fill the space to be grouted for the particular application. Dry pack consistency is such that the grout is plastic and moldable but will not flow. Where "dry pack" is called for in the Contract Documents, it shall mean a grout of that consistency; the type of grout to be used shall be as indicated herein for the particular application. B. The slump for topping grout and concrete/grout fill shall be adjusted to match placement and finishing conditions but shall not exceed 4 inches. 2.9 MEASUREMENT OF INGREDIENTS A. Measurements for cement grout shall be made accurately by volume using containers. Shovel measurements shall not be allowed. B. Prepackaged grouts shall have ingredients measured by means recommended by the manufacturer. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 PRODUCT DELIVERY, STORAGE AND HANDLING A. Grout shall be stored in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations. MWH - 04082005 GROUT 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03315 - 9 3.2 GENERAL A. CONTRACTOR shall arrange for the manufacturer of prepackaged grouts to provide on- Site technical assistance within 72 hours of request, as part of the WORK. B. Grout shall not be placed until base concrete or masonry has attained its design strength, unless authorized otherwise by the ENGINEER. C. When cementitious grouts are used on concrete surfaces, the concrete surface shall be saturated with water for 24 hours prior to placement. Upon completion of the saturation period, excess water shall be removed with clean, oil free compressed air prior to grouting. Concrete substrate shall not be wet prior to placement of epoxy grouts. D. Surface preparation, curing, and protection of cement grout shall be in accordance with Section 03300— Cast-in-Place Concrete. The finish of the grout surface shall match that of the adjacent concrete unless otherwise indicated. E. Surfaces that will be in contact with grout shall be free of dirt, loose rust, oil, wax, grease, curing compounds, laitance, loose concrete, and other deleterious materials. F. Shade the WORK from sunlight for at least 24 hours before and 48 hours after grouting. G. Contact the grout manufacturer's representative for assistance on hot and cold weather grouting techniques and precautions if applicable. 3.3 GROUTING PROCEDURES A. General: Mixing, surface preparation, handling, placing, consolidation, curing, and other means of execution for prepackaged grouts shall be done according to the instructions and recommendations of the manufacturer. B. Structural, equipment, tank, and piping support bases shall be grouted, unless indicated otherwise. 1. The original concrete shall be blocked out or finished off a sufficient distance below the plate to provide for a minimum one-inch thickness of grout, or a thickness as indicated. 2. After the base plate has been set in position at the proper elevation by steel wedges or double nuts on the anchor bolts, the space between the bottom of the plate and the original pour of concrete shall be filled with non-shrink-type grout through a headbox of appropriate size. The mixture shall be of a fluid consistency and poured continuously into the space between the plate and the base concrete. Forms for grout shall be tight against retaining surfaces, and joints shall be sealed as recommended by the grout manufacturer to be liquid-tight. Forms shall be coated as recommended by the grout manufacturer for easy form release. Where this method of placement is not practical or where required by the ENGINEER, alternate grouting methods shall be submitted for acceptance by the ENGINEER. C. Drilled anchors and Reinforcing Bars: 1. General a. Drilled anchors and reinforcing bars shall be installed in strict accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. Holes shall be roughened with a brush on a MWH - 04082005 GROUT 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03315- 10 power drill, and cleaned. Drilled anchors shall not be installed until the concrete has reached the required 28 Day compressive strength. Anchors shall not be loaded until the grout has reached its indicated strength in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. b. The CONTRACTOR shall identify position of reinforcing steel and other embedded items prior to drilling holes. Care shall be exercised in coring and drilling to avoid damaging existing reinforcing or embedded items. Notify the ENGINEER if reinforcing steel or other embedded items are encountered during drilling. Take precautions as necessary to avoid damaging prestressing tendons, electrical and communications conduit, and piping. 2. Epoxy Adhesive Anchors a. Grout shall be proportioned and mixed with automatic equipment. b. Unless otherwise indicated, embedment shall be sufficient to develop the ultimate tensile strength of the anchor or reinforcing bar per the manufacturer's ICBO/ES report, but shall not be less than 8 diameters for threaded rod or 12 diameters for reinforcing or smooth bars. c. Holes shall be dry. 3. Cement Based Non-Shrink Grout a. In places of high temperature or fire hazard, anchor bolts shall be grouted in using cement based non-shrink grout, Class I. b. Unless otherwise indicated, embedment shall be sufficient to develop the ultimate tensile strength of the anchor or reinforcing bar per the manufacturer's ICBO/ES report, but shall not be less than 16 diameters for threaded rod or 24 diameters for reinforcing or smooth bars. c. When the bolt diameter is one-inch or less, the hole diameter should be a minimum of 2 inches. When the bolt diameter is greater than one-inch, the hole diameter should be at least twice the bolt diameter. d. Drilled holes shall be saturated with water for not less than 24 hours before installation of anchor/rod/rebar. e. The non-shrink grout should be placed in the holes in a non-sag (trowelable) consistency. The grout should be placed in the holes before the anchor and then the anchor inserted and vibrated to ensure proper coverage. D. Topping Grout and Concrete/Grout-Fill: - 1. Mechanical, electrical, and finish WORK shall be completed prior to placement of topping or concrete/grout fill. To ensure bonding to the base slab, the base slab shall be given an exposed aggregate finish. Alternatively where accepted by the ENGINEER, the base slab shall be given a roughened textured surface by a close- spaced rake while the surface is green. After curing, high pressure washing shall expose the aggregates and produce not less than a 3/16-inch amplitude roughness. Jackhammers or chipping hammers shall not be used. MWH - 04082005 GROUT 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03315 - 11 2. The minimum thickness of grout topping and concrete/grout fill shall be one-inch. Where the finished surface of concrete/grout fill is to form an intersecting angle of less than 45 degrees with the concrete surface it is to be placed against, a key shall be formed in the concrete surface at the intersection point. The key shall be a minimum of 3-1/2 inches wide by 1-1/2 inches deep. 3. The base slab shall be thoroughly cleaned and wetted to saturated surface dry (SSD) condition per the International Concrete Repair Institute (ICRI) -- Technical Guide for Selecting and Specifying Concrete Surface Preparation for Sealers, Coatings, and Polymer Overlays, prior to placing topping and fill. No topping concrete shall be placed until the slab is completely free from standing pools or ponds of water. A thin coat of neat cement grout shall be broomed into the surface of the slab just before topping or fill placement. The neat cement grout shall not be allowed to dry before topping placement. If it does dry, it must be immediately removed using wet stiff brooms and reapplied. The topping and fill shall be compacted by rolling or thorough tamping, brought to established grade, and floated. Grouted fill for tank and basin bottoms where scraping mechanisms are to be installed shall be screeded by blades attached to the revolving mechanism of the equipment in accordance with the procedures outlined by the equipment manufacturer after the grout is brought to the established grade. Coat surface with evaporation retardant as needed to prevent plastic shrinkage cracks. 4. Topping grout placed on sloping slabs shall proceed uniformly from the bottom of the slab to the top, for the full width of the placement. 5. The surface shall be tested with a straight edge to detect high and low spots, which shall be immediately eliminated. When the topping or fill has hardened sufficiently, it shall be steel troweled to a smooth surface free from pinholes and other imperfections. An approved type of mechanical trowel may be used as an assist in this operation, but the last pass over the surface shall be by hand troweling. During finishing, no water, dry cement, or mixture of dry cement and sand shall be applied to the surface. 6. As soon as topping or fill finishing is completed, coat surface with curing compound. After the topping is set and sufficiently hard in clarifiers and where required by the ENGINEER, the tank shall be filled with sufficient water to cover the entire floor for 14 days. 3.4 CONSOLIDATION A. Grout shall be placed in such a manner, for the consistency necessary for each application, to assure that the space to be grouted is completely filled. 3.5 CURING A. Cement based grouts shall be cured per Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete and per the manufacturer's recommendations. - END OF SECTION - MWH -04082005 GROUT 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03315 - 12 SECTION 03450 - ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE - PLANT CAST PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. This Section includes the performance criteria, materials, production and erection of plant-precast architectural concrete units. B. Plant-precast architectural concrete includes the following: 1. Architectural precast concrete cladding: a. Custom formed and textured sill units. b. Custom formed gable wall inserts. c. Custom formed coping units. d. Custom formed wainscot panels. 2. Standard precast concrete splash blocks. 1.2 PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS A. Structural Performance: Provide architectural precast concrete units and connections capable or withstanding the following design loads within limits and conditions indicated. 1. Wind Loads: a. Basic Wind Speed: 100 MPH, 3 second gust b. Wind Importance Factor (lw): 1.15 c. Exposure Category: C 2. Snow Loads: a. Ground Snow Load: 25 PSF b. Snow Exposure Factor (CO: 1.0 c. Snow Importance Factor (le): 1.0 d. Thermal Factor (CO: 1.1 3. Seismic Loads: a. Seismic Use Group D b. Spectral Response Coefficient (Se): 1.06g c. Spectral Response Coefficient (Si): 0.37g d. Site Class: D MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE- PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450- 1 ti e. Seismic Design Category: Ill 1r, f. Seismic Importance Factor (le): 1.25 rt 4. Attachment of precast architectural concrete to the building structure shall be designed for wind, seismic and snow loads determined in accordance with the more stringent of either the local building code or IBC 2003. 5. Design framing system and connections to maintain clearances at openings, to allow for fabrication and construction tolerances, to accommodate live load deflection, shrinkage and creep of primary building structure, and other building movements. 1.3 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. General: Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 — Contractor Submittals. B. Product Data: 1. For each type of product indicated. C. Structural calculations, prepared and sealed by a structural engineer registered in the state of Oregon, showing the structural adequacy of the precast concrete units and all connections to the building structure. 1. Show governing panel types, connections and types of reinforcement, including special reinforcement. 2. Coordinate the location, type, magnitude and direction of all imposed loadings from the precast system to the building structural frame with the Engineer of Record. D. Shop (erection) drawings prepared and sealed by a qualified structural or civil engineer. Show complete information for fabrication, installation, attachment to the building and interface with other materials and methods of construction of all custom formed precast concrete units. Indicate member dimensions and cross-section; fabrication tolerances; locations, size and type of reinforcement; and lifting devices necessary for handling and erection. 1. Indicate aesthetic intent including joints, reveals and extent and location of each surface finish. 2. Indicate details at building corners. a. Show caulked joints, including expansion joints ("soft type") and grouted joints ("hard type"). b. Show location and details of anchorage devices to be embedded in other construction. 3. Indicate welded connections by AWS standard symbols. Detail loose and cast-in hardware, and connections. 4. Indicate locations, tolerances and details of anchorage devices to be embedded in or attached to structure or other construction. MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE—PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450-2 5. Plans and/or elevations to show unit location, indicating location of each architectural precast concrete unit by same identification mark placed on panel. 6. Indicate relationship of architectural precast concrete units to adjacent materials. 7. Indicate joint widths. 8. Design Modifications: If design modifications are necessary to meet the performance requirements and field conditions, do not adversely affect the appearance, durability or strength of units when modifying details or materials and maintain the general design concept. a. Modifications proposed after ENGINEER review and approval of shop drawings and calculations shall be made only after submittal and ENGINEER review of revised design calculations and drawings. E. Design Mixes: For each concrete mix along with compressive strength and water- absorption tests. F. Samples: 1. Design reference samples for initial verification of design intent, of approximately 12-inch length, to illustrate sill and coping unit shape, color, quality and texture of surface finish. a. Show samples of workmanship, color and texture for all exposed surfaces. 2. After initial sample approval and before fabricating architectural precast units, produce a minimum of two sample panels approximately 16 square feet in size for review by ENGINEER. Incorporate full-scale details of architectural features, finishes, textures, and transitions in the sample panels. a. Locate sample panels where directed by ENGINEER. b. After acceptance of panels, maintain sample panels at the project site in an undisturbed condition as a standard for judging the completed work. G. Mock-ups: After sample approval, but before production fabrication of architectural - precast concrete units, construct full sized mockups to verify selections made under sample submittals and to demonstrate aesthetic effects and qualities of materials and execution. Mockup to be representative of the finished work in all respects including sealants, anchors, connections, flashings and joint fillers as accepted on the final shop drawings. Build mock-ups to comply with the following requirements, using materials indicated for the completed work: 1. Provide full size mock-ups for ENGINEER inspection at production plant. 2. Notify ENGINEER in advance of dates and times when mockups will be constructed. 3. Obtain ENGINEER approval of mockups before starting fabrication. 4. In presence of ENGINEER, damage part of an exposed face for each finish, color and texture, and demonstrate materials and techniques proposed for repairs to match adjacent undamaged surfaces. MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE - PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450- 3 5. After acceptance of mockup panels, maintain panels at the project site in an undisturbed condition as a standard for judging the completed work. 6. Upon ENGINEER approval, full size mockup panels may be incorporated into the work. H. Statement of fabricator, engineer and erector qualifications, as required by Paragraph 1.4 Quality Assurance. 1. Include list of completed projects with project names and addresses, names and addresses of architects and owners, and other information specified. I. LEED Product Data 1. Credit MR 4: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. 2. Credit MR 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting manufacturing locations for products manufactured within a 500 mile radius of the project site. 3. Credit MR 5.2: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting location of extraction, recovery or harvest for materials contained in products addressed in item 2 above that originated within a 500 mile radius of the project site. 1.4 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Reference Specifications, Codes and Standards: Where applicable, the latest editions of the following standards shall be considered a part of these specifications. In case of conflict, these specifications shall take precedence over the listed standard. 1. Applicable building code requirements and regulations of authorities having jurisdiction, including structural, wind load and seismic forces. 2. ACI 318, "Building Code Requirements for Reinforced Concrete." 3. Concrete Reinforcing Steel Institute, "Manual of Standard Practice." 4. Prestressed Concrete Institute MNL 117, "Manual for Quality Control for Plants and Production of Architectural Precast Concrete Products." 5. Prestressed Concrete Institute MNL 120, "PCI Design Handbook - Precast and Prestressed Concrete", applicable to types of architectural precast concrete units indicated. ASTM A 36 Specification for Structural Steel ASTM A 82 Specification for Steel Wire, Plain, for Concrete ASTM A 153 Specification for Zinc Coating (Hot Dipped) on Iron and Steel Hardware ASTM A 185 Specification for Steel Welded Wire, Fabric, Plain for Concrete Reinforcement MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE- PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450- 4 ASTM A 283 Specification for Low and Intermediate Tensile Strength Carbon Steel Plates ASTM A 416 Specifications for Uncoated Seven-Wire Stress-Relieved Steel Strand for Prestressed Concrete ; ASTM A 497 Specification for Welded Deformed Steel Wire Fabric for Concrete Reinforcement ASTM A 615 Specification for Deformed and Plain Billet Steel Bars for Concrete Reinforcement ASTM A 775 Specification for Epoxy-Coated Reinforcing Steel Bars ASTM A 767 Specification for Zinc-Coated (Galvanized) Bars for Concrete Reinforcement ASTM C 33 Specification for Concrete Aggregates ASTM C 150 Specification for Portland Cement ASTM C 260 Specification for Air-Entraining Admixtures for Concrete ASTM C 494 Specification for Chemical Admixtures for Concrete B. Professional Engineer Qualifications: A professional engineer licensed to practice in the state of Oregon and experienced in providing engineering services that have resulted in successful installation of architectural precast concrete units similar in material, design and extent as required for this project. C. Fabricator Qualifications: A firm having a minimum of 5 years successful experience in fabrication of architectural precast concrete units, similar to members required for this project, and with a record of successful in-service performance. Fabricator must have sufficient production capacity to produce, transport, and deliver required units without causing delay in the work. Fabricator must comply with the following requirements. 1. Assumes responsibility for engineering architectural precast concrete units to comply with performance requirements. This responsibility includes preparation of shop drawings and comprehensive engineering analysis by a qualified professional engineer. D. Erector Qualifications: Minimum of 5 years successful experience in erection of architectural precast concrete units similar in material, design and extent to units required for this project, and whose work has resulted in construction with a record of successful in-service performance. E. Welding: Qualify procedures and personnel according to AWS D1.1, "Structural Welding Code— Steel"; and AWS D1.4, "Structural Welding Code — Reinforcing Steel". F. Design modifications may be made only as necessary to meet field conditions and to ensure proper fitting of the work. Maintain general design concept shown without increasing or decreasing sizes of members or altering profiles and alignment shown. G. Preinstallation Conference: Conduct conference at Project site to review erection sequencing, coordination with other trades and any other required matters to assure a quality installation. MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE— PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450- 5 1.5 DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING A. Deliver precast concrete units to project site in such qualities and at such times to assure continuity of installation. Store units at project site to prevent cracking, distorting, warping, staining, or other physical damage and so that markings are visible. 1. Acceptance at Site: The ENGINEER shall make final inspection and acceptance of the precast concrete products upon arrival at the jobsite. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 ACCEPTABLE FABRICATORS: A. Subject to compliance with requirements, provide products by one of the following: 1. Concrete Shop Inc., Vancouver WA (360) 573-5775. 2. Custom Concrete Casting Corp., Carnation WA (425) 333-4737. 3. Michael's Precast Concrete, Boring, OR (503) 668-4073 4. Morse Brothers, Harrisburg, OR (541) 995-6327 5. Olympian Precast, Redmond, WA (425) 868-1922 2.2 LEEDTM REQUIREMENTS: A. Product supplied for this project must be produced within a 500 mile radius of the project 1 site. 2.3 SPLASH BLOCKS A. 16" x 24" x 2-7/8", standard gray. 2.4 MOLDS AND FORMWORK A. Provide forms and, where required, form-facing materials of metal, plastic, wood, or other acceptable material that is nonreactive with concrete and will produce required finish surfaces. B. Mold Materials: Rigid, dimensionally stable, nonabsorptive material, warp and buckle free, that will provide continuous and true precast concrete surfaces, within fabrication tolerances indicated; non-reactive with concrete and suitable for producing required finishes. 1. Mold Release Agent: Commercially produced liquid-release agent that will not bond with, stain or adversely affect precast concrete surfaces and will not impair subsequent surface or joints treatments of precast concrete. 2. Maintain molds to provide completed architectural precast concrete units of shapes, lines, and dimensions indicated, within fabrication tolerances specified. a. Form joints are not permitted on faces exposed to view in the finished work. b. Edge and corner treatment: Uniformly chamfered. MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE - PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450-6 2.5 CONNECTION AND ANCHORING MATERIALS a A. Stainless Steel Plates: ASTM A 666, Type 304, of grade suitable for application. B. Steel Shapes: Stainless steel Type 316. C. Stainless Steel Anchor Bolts and Studs: ASTM F593, alloy 304 or 316, hex-head bolts and studs; stainless steel nuts; and flat, stainless steel washers. Lubricate threaded parts of stainless steel bolts with an anti-seize thread lubricant during assembly. D. Stainless Steel Headed Studs: ASTM A 276 and bearing the minimum mechanical properties for studs as indicated under MNL 117, Table 3.2.3. E. Dovetail Slots and Anchors: Hot-dipped galvanized steel conforming to ASTM A924 and ASTM A653, CQ or LFQ. 1. Slots: 1-inch by 1-inch with 3/4-inch throat, with polystyrene foam filler and continuous nail grooves along the back edge of the profile. a. Gage as determined by the precast concrete design engineer. 2. Anchors: 16 gage by 1-inch wide. a. Lengths: 3-1/2 inch and 5-1/2 inch as required. 3. Acceptable Product: "Pro-Slot Anchor Slot and Dovetail Anchors"; BoMetals Inc. or equal. 2.6 BEARING PADS AND OTHER ACCESSORIES A. Reglets: Stainless Steel, Type 302, felt or fiber filled or cover face opening of slots. B. Accessories: Provide clips, hangars, plastic or steel shims, bearing pads and other accessories required to install architectural precast concrete units. 2.7 CONCRETE MATERIALS A. See Section 03300 — Cast-in-place Concrete. 1. Use only one brand, type, and source of supply of cement throughout the project. 2. Submit proposed concrete mix design for each type and color of concrete mix required. a. Design mixes may be prepared by a qualified independent testing agency or by qualified precast plant personnel at architectural-precast concrete fabricator's option. b. When included in design mixes, add admixtures to concrete mixes according to manufacturer's written instructions. 2.8 REINFORCING MATERIALS A. See Section 03200 — Reinforcement Steel. MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE- PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450- 7 B. Supports: Suspend reinforcement from back of mold, or use bolsters, chairs, spacers, and other devices for spacing, supporting, and fastening reinforcing bars and welded wire reinforcement in place according to PCI MNL 117. 2.9 GROUT MATERIALS A. See Section 03315 - Grout. 2.10 FABRICATION A. General: Fabricate precast concrete units complying with manufacturing and testing procedures, quality control recommendations, and following dimensional tolerances, unless otherwise indicated. 1. Fabricate units straight, smooth, and true to size and shape, with exposed edges and corners precise and square unless otherwise indicated. 2. Precast units that are warped, cracked, broken, spalled, stained, or otherwise defective will not be acceptable. 3. See architectural Drawings for unit sizes and shapes. 4. Place concrete in a continuous operation to prevent seams or planes or weakness from forming in precast concrete units. Comply with requirements in PCI MNL 117 for measuring, mixing, transporting and placing concrete. 5. Thoroughly consolidate placed concrete by internal and/or external vibration without dislocating or damaging reinforcement and built-in items, and minimize pour lines, honeycombing or entrapped air on surfaces. Use equipment and procedures complying with PCI MNL 117. a. Place self-consolidating concrete with vibration in accordance with PCI Interim Guidelines for the Use of Self-Consolidating Concrete. 6. Comply with ACI 306.1 procedures for cold-weather concrete placement. 7. Comply with ACI 305R recommendations for hot-weather concrete placement. 8. Identify pickup points of architectural precast concrete units and orientation in structure with permanent markings, complying with markings indicated on Shop Drawings. Imprint or permanently make casting date of each architectural precast concrete unit on a surface that will not show in finished structure. 9. Cure concrete, according to requirements in PCI MNL 117, by moisture retention without heat or by accelerated heat curing using low-pressure live steam or radiant heat and moisture. Cure units until the compressive strength is high enough to ensure that stripping does not have an effect on the performance or appearance of the final product. 10. Repair damaged architectural precast concrete units to meet acceptability requirements or PCI MNL 117. B. Cast-in Anchors, Inserts, Plates, Angles, and Other Anchorage Hardware: Fabricate anchorage hardware with sufficient anchorage and embedment to comply with design requirements. Accurately position for attachment of loose hardware and secure in place MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE— PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450- 8 during precasting operations. Locate anchorage hardware where it does not affect position of main reinforcement or concrete placement. 1. Weld headed studs and deformed bar anchors used for anchorage according to AWS D1.1 and AWS C5.4, "Recommended Practices for Stud Welding". C. Furnish loose hardware items including steel plates, clip angles, seat angles, anchors, dowels, cramps, hangers and other hardware shapes for securing architectural precast concrete units to supporting and adjacent construction. D. Cast-in reglets, slots, holes and other accessories I architectural precast concrete units as indicated on construction drawings. E. Reinforcement: Comply with recommendations in PCI MNL 117 for fabrication, placing and supporting reinforcement. 1. Clean reinforcement of loose rust and mill scale, earth and other materials that reduce or destroy the bond with concrete. When damage to epoxy coated reinforcing exceeds limits specified in ASTM A775/A775M, repair with patching material compatible with coating material and epoxy coat bar ends after cutting. 2. Accurately position, support and secure reinforcement against displacement during concrete placement and consolidation operations. Completely conceal support devices to prevent exposure on finished surfaces. 3. Place reinforcing steel to maintain at least 3/4 inch minimum concrete cover. Increase cover requirements for reinforcing steel to 1-1/2 inches when units are exposed to corrosive environment or sever exposure conditions. Arrange, space, and securely tie bars and bar supports to hold reinforcement in position while placing concrete. Direct wire tie ends away from finished, exposed concrete surfaces. 4. Install welded wire reinforcement in lengths as long at practicable. Lap adjoining pieces at least one full mesh spacing and wire tie laps, where required by design. Offset laps of adjoining widths to prevent continuous laps in either direction. 5. Reinforce architectural precast units to resist handling, transportation and erection stresses. F. Forms: Accurately construct forms mortar-tight and of sufficient strength to withstand pressures due to concrete placing operations, temperature changes, and when prestressed, pretensioning and detensioning operations. Maintain form work to provide completed precast concrete units of shapes, lines, and dimensions indicated, within specified fabrication tolerances. G. Fabrication Tolerances: Fabricate precast architectural concrete units straight and true to size and shape with exposed edges and corners precise and true, so that each finished unit complies with PCI MNL 117 product tolerances as well as positional tolerances for cast-in items, unless a more stringent tolerance is listed below. 1. Dimensional Tolerances of Finished Units: Overall height and width measured at face adjacent to mold at time of casting: a. 10 feet or less: Plus or minus 1/8 inch. MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE— PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450-9 b. Angular deviation of plane of side mold: 1/32 inch per 3 inches depth or 1/16 inch total, whichever is greater. c. Out of square (difference in length of two diagonal measurements): 1/8 inch per 6 feet or 1/4 inch total, whichever is greater. d. Thickness: Minus 1/8 inch, plus 1/4 inch. e. Tolerances of other dimensions not otherwise indicated: Numerically greater of plus or minus 1/16 inch per 10 feet, or plus or minus 1/8 inch. 2. Positional Tolerances: For cast-in items measured from datum line locations as shown on reviewed shop drawings. a. Anchors and Inserts: Within 3/8-inch of centerline location. b. Blockouts and Reinforcements: Within 1/4-inch of position shown on shop drawings, where such positions have structural implications or affect concrete cover; otherwise within plus or minus 1/2-inch. H. Surface Finish & Color: Fabricate precast units and provide exposed surface finished as follows: 1. Panel faces shall be free of joint marks, grain and other obvious defects. Corners, including false joints shall be uniform, straight and sharp. Finish exposed face surfaces to match approved sample panels and as follows: a. Finish for exposed-face surfaces: Smooth, light acid etched surface finish, free of pockets, sand streaks and honeycomb, with uniform color and texture suitable for application of masonry sealer. 1) Protect hardware and connections from acid attack. b. Finish exposed top, bottom and back surfaces to match face surface. c. Color: natural gray. I. Expansion Joints: Free of grout, mortar, or other obstructions to expansive movement, with expansions joint filler where indicated. 1. Sills: Midpoint between mullions, with expansion filler strip. 2. Copings: Every joint between units, unless otherwise indicated. Align joints with vertical expansion joints in adjacent concrete block veneer. J. Cast-in Items: Provide reglets, slots, holes and other accessories in units to receive cramps, dowels, reglets, waterstops, fleshings and other similar work. 1. Provide inserts and anchorages cast into units, for attachment of loose hardware as required. ) MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE- PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450- 10 PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 PREPARATION A. Deliver anchorage devices that are embedded in or attached to the building structural frame or foundation before start of such work. Provide locations, setting diagrams, and templates for the proper installation of each anchorage device. 3.2 EXAMINATION A. Examine supporting structural frame or foundation and conditions for compliance with requirements for installation tolerances, true and level bearing surfaces and other conditions affecting performance. Proceed with installation only after unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. B. Do not install precast concrete units until supporting cast-in place concrete building structural framing has attained minimum allowable design compressive strength or supporting steel or other structure is structurally ready to receive loads from precast. C. Do not install precast sill units until supporting CMU veneer has attained minimum allowable design compressive strength. 3.3 SEQUENCING A. Furnish loose connection hardware and anchorage items to be embedded in or attached to other construction without delaying the work. Provide setting diagrams, templates, instructions and directions, as required, for installation. 3.4 PRODUCT DELIVERY, STORAGE AND HANDLING A. Store units with adequate dunnage and bracing; protect units to prevent contact with soil, staining, and to prevent cracking, distortion, warping or other physical damage. B. Store units, unless otherwise specified, with non-staining, resilient supports. C. Place non-staining resilient spaces of even thickness between each unit. D. Place stored units so identification marks are clearly visible, and product can be inspected. E. Deliver all architectural precast concrete units to the project site in such quantities and at such times to assure compliance with the agreed project schedule and proper setting sequence, so as to limit unloading units temporarily on the ground. F. Handle and transport units in a position consistent with their shape and design, in order to avoid excessive stresses which would cause cracking or damage. G. Lift and support units only at designated points shown on the shop drawings. H. Support units during shipment on non-staining shock absorbing material. 3.5 ERECTION A. Install loose clips, hangars, bearing pads and other accessories required for connecting architectural precast concrete units to supporting members and backup materials. MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE- PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450- 11 B. Erect architectural precast concrete level, plumb and square within the specified allowable tolerances. Provide temporary supports and bracing as required to maintain position, stability and alignment of units until permanent connections are completed. 1. Install temporary steel or plastic spacing shims or bearing pads as precast concrete units are being erected. Tack weld steel shims to each other to prevent shims from separating. 2. Maintain horizontal and vertical joint alignment and uniform joint width as erection progresses. 3. Remove projecting lifting devices and use sand-cement grout to fill voids within recessed lifting devices flush with surface of adjacent precast concrete surfaces, when recess is exposed. 4. Unless otherwise shown, provide for uniform joint widths of 3/4 inch. C. Connect architectural precast units in position by bolting, welding, grouting or as otherwise indicated on approved erection drawings. Remove temporary shims, wedges and spacers as soon as practical after connecting and/or grouting are completed. 1. Disruption of roof flashing continuity by connections is not permitted; concealment within roof insulation is acceptable. 2. ' At bolted connections, use lock washers, tack welding or other acceptable means to prevent loosening of nuts after final adjustment. 3. Grouting connections: Grout connections where required or indicated. Retain grout in place until hard enough to support itself. Pack spaces with stiff grout material, tamping until voids are completely filled. Place grout to finish smooth, level and plumb with adjacent concrete surfaces. Promptly remove grout material from exposed surfaces before it affects finishes or hardens. D. Welding: Comply with applicable AWS D1.1 and AWS D1.4 requirements for welding, welding electrodes, appearance, quality of welds, and methods used in correcting welding work. 1. Protect architectural precast concrete units and bearing pads from damage by field welding or cutting operations and provide noncombustible shields as required. 2. Welds not specified shall be continuous fillet welds, using not less than the minimum fillet as specified by AWS. 3. Clean weld affected metal surfaces with chipping hammer followed by brushing then apply a minimum 0.004 inch thick coat of galvanized repair paint to galvanized surfaces in conformance with ASTM A780. 4. Clean weld affected metal surfaces with chipping hammer followed by brushing then reprime damaged painted surfaces in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations. 5. Visually inspect all welds, critical to precast connections. Visually check all welds for completion and remove, reweld or repair all defective welds. MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE - PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450- 12 3.6 ERECTION TOLERANCES A. Erect architectural precast concrete units level, plumb, square, true and in alignment without exceeding the noncumulative erection tolerances of PCI MNL 117, Appendix I. 3.7 REPAIRS A. Repairs will be permitted provided structural adequacy of units and appearance are not impaired. 3.8 PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS A. In-place precast units may be rejected for the following: 1. Exceeding specified erection tolerances. 2. Damage during construction operations. 3. Surface finish deficiencies in exposed-to-view surfaces. 4. Other defects as listed in PCI MNL-117. 3.9 CLEANING A. Fabricator to clean all surfaces of precast concrete to be exposed to view, as necessary, prior to shipping to job site. B. General Contractor to clean mortar, plaster, fireproofing, weld slag and any other 1 deleterious material from concrete surfaces and adjacent materials immediately. C. Erector to clean exposed surfaces of precast concrete units after erection and completion of joint treatment to remove weld marks, other markings, dirt and stains. 1. Perform cleaning procedures, if necessary, according to precast concrete fabricator's recommendations. Clean soiled precast concrete surfaces with detergent and water, using stiff fiber brushes and sponges, and rinse with clean water. 2. Protect other work from staining or damage due to cleaning operations. 3. Do not use cleaning materials or processes that could change the appearance of exposed concrete surfaces or damage adjacent materials, or interfere with application of protective coating finish. - END OF SECTION - MWH-04082005 ARCHITECTURAL PRECAST CONCRETE— PLANT CAST 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03450- 13 SECTION 03520 - LIGHTWEIGHT STRUCTURAL CONCRETE PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall construct all lightweight concrete work over structural roof deck and all appurtenant work, complete, in accordance with the requirements of the Contract Documents. 1.2 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Contractor submittals shall be in accordance with the requirements of Paragraph 1.2 "Contractor's Submittal" of Section 03300 - Cast-In-Place Concrete. 1.3 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. General: 1. Tests on component materials and for compressive strength of concrete will be performed as specified herein. Test for determining slump will be in accordance with the requirements of ASTM C 143. 2. Splitting tensile strength shall conform to ASTM C 496. 3. The OWNER will engage the services of a material testing laboratory to perform testing for the purpose of verifying compliance with the project specifications. 4. The cost of trial batch laboratory tests on cement, aggregates, and concrete shall be the CONTRACTOR's responsibility. The cost of laboratory tests on field-placed cement, aggregates, and concrete will be the OWNER'S responsibility. However, the CONTRACTOR shall pay the cost of any additional tests and investigation on WORK that does not meet the specifications. The laboratory will meet or exceed the requirements of ASTM C 1077 - Practice for Laboratories Testing Concrete and Concrete Aggregates for use in Construction and Criteria for Laboratory Evaluation. 5. Concrete for testing shall be furnished by the CONTRACTOR, and the CONTRACTOR shall assist the ENGINEER in obtaining samples, and disposal and cleanup of excess material. B. Field Compression Tests: 1. Compression test specimens will be taken during construction from the first placement of each days pour to ensure continued compliance with these Specifications. Each set of test specimens will be a minimum of five cylinders. 2. Compression test specimens for concrete shall be made in accordance with Paragraph 9.2 of ASTM C 31. Specimens shall be 6-inch diameter by 12-inch high cylinders. 3. Compression tests shall be performed in accordance with ASTM C 39. One test cylinder will be tested at 7 days and two at 28 days. The remaining cylinders will be held to verify test results, if needed. MWH - 04082005 LIGHTWEIGHT STRUCTURAL CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03520-1 C. Evaluation and Acceptance of Concrete: 1. Evaluation and acceptance of the compressive strength of concrete shall be according to the requirements of ACI 318, Chapter 5 "Concrete Quality, Mixing, and Placing" and as specified herein. 2. A statistical analysis of compression test results will be performed according to the requirements of ACI 214. The standard deviation of the test results shall not exceed 640 psi, when ordered at equivalent water content as estimated by slump. 3. If any concrete fails to meet these requirements, immediate corrective action shall be taken to increase the compressive strength for all subsequent batches of the type of concrete affected. 4. When the standard deviation of the test results exceeds 640 psi, the average strength for which the mix is designed shall be increased by an amount necessary to satisfy the statistical requirement that the probability of any test being more than 500 psi below or the average of any three consecutive tests being below the specified compressive strength is 1 in 100. The required average strength shall be calculated by Criterion No. 3 of ACI 214 using the actual standard of deviation. 5. All concrete which fails to meet the ACI requirements and these Specifications, is subject to removal and replacement at no increase in cost to the OWNER. D. Construction Tolerances: Set and maintain concrete forms and perform finishing operations so as to ensure that the completed Work is within the tolerances specified herein. Surface defects and irregularities are defined as finishes and are to be distinguished from tolerances. Tolerance is the specified permissible variation from lines, grades, or dimensions shown. Where tolerances are not stated in the Specifications, permissible deviations will be in accordance with ACI 117. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 GENERAL A. Products for lightweight structural concrete shall conform to the requirement of "Part 2 - Products" of Section 03300 - Cast-In-Place Concrete except as modified herein. 2.2 CONCRETE MATERIALS A. Aggregates: 1. Requirements for aggregates as shown in Paragraph 2.1.D.3 of Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete are not applicable for lightweight structural concrete. 2. Aggregates for lightweight structural concrete shall conform to the requirements of ASTM C 330. a. Fine lightweight aggregates shall be processed or naturally occurring suitable for the production of lightweight structural concrete and properly graded with 85 to 100 percent passing the No. 4 sieve, and having a dry, loose weight not exceeding 70 lb/ft3 MWH - 04082005 LIGHTWEIGHT STRUCTURAL CONCRETE 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03520-2 b. Coarse lightweight aggregates shall be supplied from the same sources as the fine lightweight aggregates (processed or naturally occurring) suitable for the production of lightweight structural concrete, and properly graded from 100 percent passing a designated maximum size sieve, and shall have dry, loose weight not exceeding 55 lb/ft3. c. Fine lightweight and coarse lightweight aggregates shall be tested for reactivity conforming to the requirement ASTM C 33. B. Admixtures: 1. Air-entraining agent shall be used to provide a total air content of 4 to 6 percent. 2.3 CURING MATERIALS A. Curing mat as shown in Paragraph 2.2.A.5 of Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete is not required for curing of lightweight structural concrete. 2.4 MISCELLANEOUS MATERIALS A. Dampproofing agent as shown in Paragraph 2.4.A of Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete is not required for lightweight structural concrete. 2.5 CONCRETE DESIGN REQUIREMENTS A. The percentage of sand in concrete as shown in Paragraph 2.5.B of Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete is not applicable to lightweight structural concrete. B. The requirements of Paragraph 2.5.0 Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete is not applicable to lightweight structural concrete. C. Lightweight Structural Concrete 1. Unit Weight = 110 lb/ft 3 2. f'c = 4000 psi 3. minimum cement content = 564 lb/yd 3 4. slump = 4 to 6 inches 5. entrained-air content = 4 to 6 percent 6. maximum aggregates size = 3/4 inch D. Proportioning and Adjusting Mixes: The lightweight structural concrete shall be proportioned with the minimum amount of water, and other ingredients to produce a lightweight concrete with good workability and finishability, and with the limitations of this Specification. Final proportions shall be established by laboratory trial mixes, which are then adjusted to provide practical field batches in accordance with the requirements ACI 211.2. MWH - 04082005 LIGHTWEIGHT STRUCTURAL CONCRETE 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03520-3 2.6 CONSISTENCY A. Consistency requirements shall be in accordance with Paragraph 2.6, Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete. 2.7 SHRINKAGE TESTING A. Shrinkage testing as shown in Paragraph 2.8 of Section 03300— Cast-in-Place Concrete is not applicable to lightweight structural concrete. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 GENERAL A. Execution shall be in accordance with the requirements of"Part 3 - Execution" of Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete, except as modified herein. 3.2 PREPARATION OF SURFACE FOR CONCRETING A. Paragraph 3.2.A of Section 03300 —Cast-in-Place Concrete is not applicable to lightweight structural concrete. B. Prior to placing lightweight concrete on the roof the CONTRACTOR shall have the metal deck connected to the supports in accordance with the requirements of the construction documentations. The surface of the metal deck shall be free from oil, standing water, and debris at the time of placing concrete. 3.3 HANDLING, TRANSPORTING, AND PLACING A. Paragraph 3.3.D of Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete is not applicable to lightweight structural concrete. 3.4 ORDER OF PLACING CONCRETE A. Paragraph 3.5.A of Section 03300 —Cast-in-Place Concrete is not applicable to lightweight structural concrete. 3.5 TAMPING AND VIBRATING A. Paragraph 3.6.B of Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete is not applicable to lightweight structural concrete. 3.6 FINISHING CONCRETE SURFACES A. Paragraph 3.7.B and 3.7.0 of Section of 03300 Cast-in-Place Concrete are not applicable to lightweight structural concrete. B. Concrete is to be finished by a power or hand steel trowel, followed by soft hair broom to obtain light texture or "sidewalk" finish. Retardant shall not be used on light weight concrete surface receiving coating or dampproofing. C. Class U2 finish shall be used for lightweight structural concrete. MWH -04082005 LIGHTWEIGHT STRUCTURAL CONCRETE 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03520-4 3.7 ARCHITECTURAL FINISH A. Architectural finish as shown in Paragraph 3.8 of Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete is not required for lightweight structural concrete. 3.8 CURING AND DAMPPROOFING A. Curing Method 6 of Paragraph 3.9.G of Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete shall be used for curing of lightweight structural concrete except as modified herein. B. Curing period for light weight concrete shall not be less than 28 days. C. Paragraph 3.9H of Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete is not applicable to light- weight concrete. D. Light-weight concrete shall be coated with fluid applied roofing, Odor Free Auto Grid by Neogard or equal, after the curing period. 3.9 TREATMENT OF SURFACE DEFECTS A. Paragraphs 3.12.0 and 3.12.E of Section 03300 — Cast-in-Place Concrete are not applicable to lightweight structural concrete. 3.10 PATCHING HOLES IN CONCRETE A. Paragraph 3.13.B of Section 03300 —Cast-in-Place Concrete is not applicable to lightweight structural concrete. - END OF SECTION - MWH - 04082005 LIGHTWEIGHT STRUCTURAL CONCRETE 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 03520-5 SECTION 04232 - REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide concrete masonry and appurtenant WORK, complete and in place, in accordance with the Contract Documents. B. Section Includes: 1. Reinforced and grouted load bearing and non-load bearing concrete masonry units. 2. Reinforcement, anchorage, and accessories. 1.2 QUALIFICATIONS A. Installer: Company specializing in performing the work of this Section with minimum five years experience. 1.3 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Product Data: 1. Submit product data for veneer anchors, control joints, concealed flashing, and weep hole materials. 2. Submit proposed reinforcement and anchor spacing, together with manufacturer's documentation illustrating that the reinforcement and anchors meet the specified structural performance criteria at the proposed spacing. C. Product Samples: 1. Samples of concrete masonry unit colors with texture ranges indicated for selection of color. Full size samples of the blocks selected shall be submitted for final approval after color selection, if requested. If the required product is a colored and textured unit, the samples shall be colored and textured units. If the required product is a blend of integrally colored and textured units, the samples_shall be colored and textured units to represent the specified blend. a. Submit three samples of each type and size concrete masonry units to indicate manufacturer's standard variation in color and texture. 2. Samples of mortar colors for color selection. a. Submit two 16 inch long by 1/2 inch wide tooled samples of color tinted mortar. MWH-04082005 REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY 1530575 — DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04232 - 1 D. LEED Product Data 1. Credit MR 4: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. 2. Credit MR 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting manufacturing locations for products manufactured within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 3. Credit MR 5.2: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting location of extraction, recovery or harvest for materials contained in products addressed in item 2 above that originated within a 500-mile radius of the project site. E. Field-Constructed Mock-Ups: Prior to installation of unit masonry, erect sample wall panels to further verify selections made under sample submittals and to demonstrate aesthetic effects as well as qualities of materials and execution. Build mock-ups to comply with the following requirements, using materials indicated for final unit of Work. 1. Locate mock-ups on site in locations indicated or, if not indicated, as directed by ENGINEER. 2. A minimum 4-ft square by full thickness free-standing sample panel shall be erected, including face and backup wythes as well as accessories, for each type of exterior unit masonry construction. 3. Notify ENGINEER one week in advance of the dates and times when mock-ups will be erected. 4. Protect mock-ups from the elements with weather-resistant membrane. 5. Retain and maintain mock-ups during construction in undisturbed conditions as standard for judging completed unit masonry construction. 6. Accepted mock-ups in undisturbed condition at time of Substantial Completion may become part of completed unit of Work. F. Documentation 1. Reports from testing masonry units 2. Reports from mortar and grout testing. 3. Reports from prism testing. G. Grout and mortar mix design 1. Proportions for components 2. Mill tests for cement 3. Admixture certification. Include chloride ion content. 4. Aggregate graduation and certification 5. Lime certification MWH-04082005 REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04232 - 2 1.4 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Applicable Standards: Load bearing reinforced concrete masonry shall conform to ' International Building Code (IBC), American Concrete Institute ACI 530 - Building Code Requirements for Masonry Structures, ACI 530.1 - Specification for Masonry Structures, and other applicable codes and standards of the governing authorities. B. REFERENCES ASTM B370 Copper Sheet and Strip for Building Construction. ASTM C33 Concrete Aggregates. ASTM C90 Hollow Load Bearing Concrete Masonry Units. ASTM C330 Lightweight Aggregates for Structural Concrete. ASTM C744 Prefaced Concrete and Calcium Silicate Masonry Units. ASTM E-84 Surface burning characteristics of facing. UL Underwriters' Laboratories. C. Manufacturer's Test Reports: 1. Submit two copies of manufacturer's test reports on concrete masonry units. D. PRE-INSTALLATION CONFERENCE 1. THE CONTRACTOR shall conduct a conference at the Project site prior to commencement of masonry work. 2. . Attendees: Masonry Sub-contractor, CONTRACTOR, ENGINEER, OWNER and Supplier. 3. Any questions concerning the masonry work should be discussed during the conference. E. Obtain approval of all submittals prior to proceeding with the Work. F. WORK shall conform to the standard of quality established by the approved sample panel. G. Concrete block masonry units shall be sampled and tested in accordance with ASTM C 140 - Test Methods of Sampling and Testing Concrete Masonry and Related Units. H. Testing of Mortar and Grout: The CONTRACTOR shall have the mortar and grout tested to assure compliance with the Specifications and the governing codes by a recognized testing laboratory approved by the ENGINEER. Test reports shall be submitted to the ENGINEER. 1. Tests shall be taken at the following times: a. At commencement of masonry WORK, at least 2 test samples each of mortar and grout shall be taken on 3 successive Days. MWH-04082005 REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04232 - 3 b. At any change in materials or job conditions, at least 2 samples of each modified material, grout, and mortar shall be tested. is ' c. Four random tests each of mortar and grout shall be made. The random test samples shall be taken when requested by the ENGINEER. d. Additional samples and tests may be required whenever, in the judgment of the ENGINEER, additional tests beyond the random tests are necessary to determine the quality of the materials. 2. The cost of trial batch laboratory tests on mortar and grout shall be the CONTRACTOR's responsibility. The cost of laboratory tests on field-placed mortar and grout will be the OWNER'S responsibility. However, the CONTRACTOR shall } pay the cost of any additional tests and investigation on WORK that does not meet the specifications. 3. Mortar and grout for testing shall be furnished by the CONTRACTOR, and the CONTRACTOR shall assist the ENGINEER in obtaining samples, and disposal and cleanup of excess material. 4. Samples shall be stored in a moist environment until tested, unless directed otherwise by the ENGINEER or the testing laboratory. Testing for mortar shall be in accordance with ASTM C 270 - Mortar for Unit Masonry. Grout shall be tested per ASTM C 1019 - Standard Test Method for Sampling and Testing Grout. I. Test of Masonry Prisms: The OWNER will test masonry prisms to assure compliance with the Specifications and the governing codes. Testing will be by a recognized testing laboratory. 1. Tests will be made of the following items: a. Prior to construction, at least 5 masonry prisms shall be made for each type of block herein, except separate prisms are not required for block which only varies by texture. b. At any change in materials during construction, at least 5 masonry prisms shall be made for each type of block affected. c. One set of at least 5 masonry prisms shall be made for each masonry structure, besides the structure that the sample is part of, or for each week in which block is laid, for each type of block involved; whichever occurs first. d. Additional sets of at least 5 masonry prisms may be required whenever, in the judgment of the ENGINEER, additional tests are necessary to determine the quality of the materials. e. The CONTRACTOR shall submit a letter of certification from the CMU Supplier at the time of, or prior to, delivery of the materials to the Site that the materials used in construction are representative of the materials used to construct the prisms. 2. The prisms shall be constructed by the CONTRACTOR in the presence of the ENGINEER. The same personnel who are laying the block in the structure shall construct the masonry prism. MWH-04082005 REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04232-4 { 3. The masonry prism shall be constructed and will be tested in accordance with ASTM C 1314 - Test Methods for Compressive Strength of Masonry Prisms, except as modified herein. The prisms shall be composed of one complete cell using full- size blocks that are saw-cut. The minimum ratio of height to smaller width dimension shall be 1.5. The prism shall be at least 15 inches high. A minimum of 2 horizontal bed joints shall be used to form the prism. The prism shall be grouted, after the required 24 hour minimum cure period, using the same grout used in the . walls. 4. Compression tests made on sets of specimens made during construction shall include 2 prisms tested at 7 Days after grouting and 3 prisms tested at 28 Days after grouting. 5. The average compressive strength of prisms tested at 28 Days after grouting, multiplied by the appropriate correction factor as given in ASTM C 1314, shall not be less than the indicated masonry compressive strength. 6. If the tested compressive strength with correction factor of the prisms fails to meet or exceed the required strength, adjustments shall be made to the mix designs for the mortar or grout, or both, as needed to produce the required strength. The masonry units shall also be retested to verify compliance to the requirements of ASTM C 90. 7. If the tested compressive strength with correction factor of the prism fails to meet or exceed the required strength, prisms or cores shall be cut from the walls in sufficient numbers and in sufficient locations to adequately determine the strength of the walls. Those portions of the walls represented by specimens failing to meet the required compressive strength are subject to being removed and replaced. J. Inspection: Whenever required under the provisions of the Building Code, WORK hereunder will be subject to inspection by a Special Inspector selected by the ENGINEER and approved by the local Building Code representative having jurisdiction. Costs of such inspection will be paid by the OWNER. The Special Inspector will work under the supervision of the ENGINEER. K. Extreme Weather Construction: Cold weather construction shall be per the more stringent of ACI 530.1, IBC Section 2104.3, and local Code requirements. Hot weather construction shall be per the more stringent of ACI 530.1, ,IBC Section 2104.4, and local Code requirements. L. Product Storage: 1. Cement, lime, and other cementitious materials shall be delivered and stored in dry, weather-tight sheds or enclosures, in unbroken bags, barrels, or other approved containers, plainly marked and labeled with the manufacturers' names and brands. 2. Mortar and grout shall be stored and handled in a manner that prevents the inclusion of foreign materials and damage by water or dampness. 3. Masonry units shall be handled with care to avoid chipping and breakage, and shall be stored as directed in ACI 530.1. 4. Materials stored on newly constructed floors shall be stacked in such manner that the uniformly distributed loading does not exceed 30 psf. MWH-04082005 REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04232 - 5 5. Masonry materials shall be protected from contact with the earth and exposure to the weather and shall be kept dry and clean until used. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 ACCEPTABLE MANUFACTURERS— CONCRETE MASONRY UNITS A. Basalite B. Mutual Materials Company C. Willamette Graystone, Inc. 2.2 LEED REQUIREMENTS A. Product supplied for this project must be produced within a 500 mile radius of the project site. 2.3 LOAD BEARING CONCRETE MASONRY UNITS A. Concrete masonry units shall conform to ASTM C 90 - Load-Bearing Concrete Masonry Units. Units shall be medium weight units, with a density of approximately 115 pounds per cubic foot, unless indicated otherwise. 1. All concrete masonry units shall have design strength of 1500 psi minimum. 2. All exterior concrete masonry units shall contain "Dry-Block" integral additive, or approved equal. 3. Ground-face concrete masonry units: All exposed faces shall be ground to a depth sufficient to uniformly expose the aggregates. 4. Integrally-colored units shall be blend of Basalite "Rose Brown", "Cocoa", and "Cocoa Lite". Color blend shall match the existing Digester Complex Building located immediately north of the new building. B. Exterior concrete masonry units: 1. 8-inch by 4-inch by 16-inch modular size, with machine-ground faces, natural gray color. 2. 8-inch by 8-inch by 16-inch modular size, with split faces. Color of split face veneer units shall be blend of Basalite "Rose Brown", "Cocoa", and "Cocoa Lite". Color blend shall match the existing Digester Complex Building located immediately north of the new building. 3. 10-inch by 8-inch by 16-inch modular size, with machine-ground faces, natural gray color. 4. 10-inch by 4-inch by 16-inch modular size, with split faces. Color, as selected by the ENGINEER from manufacturer's standard color selection. 5. 12-inch by 8-inch by 16-inch modular size, with machine-ground faces, natural gray color. MWH-04082005 REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY 1530575 — DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04232 -6 C. Interior concrete masonry units: 1. 12-inch by 8-inch by 16-inch modular size of with smooth faces. Units shall be integrally colored. Color, as selected by the ENGINEER from manufacturer's standard color selection. D. Bond beam, corner, lintel, sill, and other specially shaped blocks shall be provided where required or necessary. Specially shaped non-structural blocks may be constructed by saw cutting. Color and texture shall match that of adjacent units. E. Concrete masonry units hidden from view entirely may be natural color units the same size as other adjacent masonry units. 2.4 MORTAR & GROUT MATERIALS A. Portland cement shall be Type I or II, low alkali, conforming to ASTM C 150 - Portland Cement. B. Hydrated lime shall be Type S conforming to ASTM C 207 - Hydrated Lime for Masonry Purposes. C. Aggregate for mortar shall conform to ASTM C 144 - Aggregate for Masonry Mortar. Aggregate for grout shall conform to ASTM C 404 -Aggregates for Masonry Grout. D. Water for mixing shall be clear potable water. E. Admixture for mortar shall be Master Builders PS-235 or Rheomix-235, Sika Co., Sika Red Label, or equal. The admixture shall not be detrimental to the bonding or help the process of efflorescence. F. Admixture for grout shall be Sika Co., Sika Grout Aid, Type II, Master Builders Pozzolith, normal, or equal. G. Water Repellent Sealer: Refer to Section 07180 — Water Repellants. 2.5 LOAD BEARING WALL REINFORCEMENT AND ANCHORAGE A. Reinforcing: Refer to structural drawings. 1. Reinforcing steel shall be deformed bars conforming to ASTM A 615 - Deformed and Plain Billet-Steel Bars for Concrete Reinforcement, Grade 60. B. Reinforcing Accessories: 1. Vertical Bar Positioner: Bent cold drawn steel wire, ASTM A 82, not less than W1.2 size, 0.124 inch nominal diameter, Bar.Positioner by A.A. Wire, D/A 810 Vertical bar positioner by Dur-O-WaI, Lock-Rite Position Ties by Lock-Rite Raker. 2. Horizontal Bar Positioner: Bent cold drawn steel wire, ASTM A 82, not less than W1.2 size, 0.124 inch nominal diameter, D/A 811 Horizontal Bar Positioner by Dur- O-WaI, Lock-Rite Bond Beam Tie by Lock-Rite Raker. 3. Grout Screen: Monofilament screen, Dur-O-Stop by Dur-O-WaI. C. Joint Reinforcement: Joint reinforcing shall conform ASTM A 951 - Masonry Joint Reinforcement. MWH-04082005 REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04232 - 7 2.6 MORTAR A. Mortar for concrete block masonry shall conform to ASTM C 270 and IBC section 2103.7 for Cement-Lime, Type S, with a minimum 28 Day compressive strength of 1800 psi. B. Mortar for use with colored masonry units shall have integral color as approved by the ENGINEER. C. All mortar at exterior concrete masonry units shall contain "Dry-Block" integral additive, or approved equal. 2.7 GROUT A. Grout shall conform to ASTM C 476 - Grout for Masonry and have a minimum 28 Day compressive strength of 2000 psi. Where the grout space is less than 4-inches, coarse aggregate shall be omitted. B. Admixtures may only be used when approved by the ENGINEER. When approved for use, admixtures shall be used in accordance with the manufacturer's published recommendations for the grout. 2.8 JOINT AND FLASHING ACCESSORIES A. Vertical Control Joints: 1. Industry Standard for Neoprene Rubber Joints: ASTM D 2000. 2. Industry Standard for Polyvinyl Chloride Joints: ASTM D 2287, Type PVC 654-4. 3. Minimum Durometer Hardness: 85 plus or minus 5. 4. Minimum Shear Strength: 450 psi. 5. Acceptable Control Joints: Wide Flange Blok-Joint by Carter-Waters, Blok-Tite by A.A. Wire, Regular or Wide Flange Rapid Control Joint by Dur-O-Wal, QS and VS by Hohmann and Barnard, Inc. B. Expansion Joint Fillers: 1. Product Data: Closed cell foam neoprene rubber, ASTM D 1056, Class RE41. 2. Nominal Size: 1/2 inch thick, 3 inches wide. 3. Acceptable Joints: Rapid Expansion Joint by Dur-O-Wai, NS by Hohmann and Barnard, Inc. C. Temporary Accessories: 1. Temporary Asphalt Saturated Unperforated Felt: ASTM D 226, 15 pound type. 2. Temporary Polyethylene: ASTM D2103, 6 mils thick. D. Cleaning solutions for natural CMU: Not harmful to masonry work or adjacent materials. Manufactured by: 1. Pro So Co., Inc. "Sure Klean 600" MWH-04082005 REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04232 - 8 2. Fabriken "Fabriklean Type L" PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 EXAMINATION A. Examine conditions, with installer present, for compliance with requirements for installation tolerances and other specific conditions affecting performance of unit masonry. B. Do not proceed until any unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. 3.2 GENERAL A. Measurements for mortar and grout shall be accurately made. Shovel measurements are not acceptable. Mortar proportions shall be accurately controlled and maintained. B. WORK shall be performed in accordance with the provisions of ACI 530 and 530.1, the IBC, and the local codes for reinforced concrete hollow-unit masonry. C. The CONTRACTOR shall set or embed anchors, bolts, reglets, sleeves, conduits, and other items as required. D. Block cutting shall be by machine. E. Masonry units shall be supported off the ground and shall be covered to protect them from rain. Only clean, dry, uncracked units shall be incorporated. F. Reinforcing steel shall be cleaned of loose rust and scale, oil, dirt, paint, laitance, or other substances which may be detrimental to or reduce bonding of the steel and concrete. G. Immediately before starting WORK, the concrete upon which the masonry will be laid shall be cleaned with water under pressure. H. Full mortar joint for first course shall be provided. I. Units shall be shoved tightly against adjacent units to assure good mortar bond. J. Equipment for mixing and transporting the mortar and grout shall be clean and free from set mortar, dirt, or other foreign matter. K. The masonry work shall be kept clean as it is constructed by standard procedures using a brush and water. L. Surface Preparation: 1. Remove loose mortar from existing adjacent masonry surfaces. 2. Add moisture to masonry units which have a high suction rate. M. Cutting Masonry Units: 1. Perform site cutting with sharp power tools to provide straight edges without chips. 2. Cut masonry for openings and joints. MWH-04082005 REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY 1530575 — DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04232 - 9 3. Avoid use of less than half size masonry units. 3.3 MIXING A. Mortar shall be mixed by placing 1/2 of the water and sand in the operating mixer, after which the cement, lime, and remainder of the sand and water shall be added. After ingredients are in the mixer, they shall be mechanically mixed for not less than 5 minutes. Retempering shall be done on the mortar board by adding water within a basin formed within the mortar, and the mortar reworked into the water. Mortar that is not used within one hour shall be discarded. 3.4 ERECTION OF CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY A. Masonry WORK shall be erected in plane, plumb, level, straight and true to dimensions, and be executed in accordance with acceptable practices of the trade and the tolerances of ACI 530.1. B. Lay out walls in advance for accurate spacing of surface bond patterns with uniform joint widths and for accurate locating of openings, movement-type joints, returns and offsets. Do not use units with less than nominal 4-inch horizontal face dimensions at corners and jambs. C. Unless indicated otherwise, masonry shall be laid up in straight uniform courses with running bond. D. Masonry shall be erected to preserve the unobstructed vertical continuity of the cells measuring not less than 3 inches by 3 inches in cross-section. Walls and cross webs shall be full bedded in mortar. Head (or end)joints shall be solidly filled with mortar for a distance in from the face of the wall or unit not less than the thickness of the longitudinal face shells. E. Installation of Masonry Accessories: 1. Install pipe sleeves where detailed and required. 2. Install masonry around steel frames, window frames, anchor bolts, and other items supplied by other trades. 3. Bed anchors for steel door and relite frames in mortar joints. F. Installation of Sheet Metal Flashings: 1. Install sheet metal flashings as shown at head of all openings. 2. Coordinate location of reglets at head and side wall flashings for roofing installer. 3. Protect flashings for damage and stains. G. Installation of Joint and Flashing Materials: 1. Install reglets in mortar joints where exposed flashing meets masonry. 2. Install vertical and horizontal control joints indicated and required to control masonry cracking. MWH-04082005 REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04232 - 10 3. Install vertical and horizontal expansion joint fillers indicated on Drawings and required to fill masonry expansion joints. 4. Install concealed flashing above veneer wall lintel angles and foundation walls and behind asphaltic felt. 3.5 JOINTS A. Vertical and horizontal joints shall be uniform and approximately 3/8-inch wide. Exterior joints and interior exposed block joints shall be concave-tooled to a dense surface. Interior or exterior non-exposed masonry and masonry behind plaster shall have flush • joints. 3.6 CLEANOUTS A. Cleanout openings shall be provided at the bottoms of cells to be filled at each lift or pour of grout where such lift or pour is over 4 feet in height. Any overhanging mortar or other obstructions or debris shall be removed from the insides of such cell walls. The cleanouts shall be sealed before grouting and after inspection. Cleanout openings shall match the finished wall in exposed masonry. 3.7 REINFORCEMENT A. Deep cut bond beam blocks shall be used where horizontal reinforcing steel is embedded. H-block bond beams may be used at locations other than openings. B. Knock-out openings shall have no steel or joint reinforcing running through the opening. Head, jambs, and sill blocks shall be used to provide an even finish surface to install window when blocks are removed. Joints at heads, jambs, and sills shall be stacked and continuous. C. Vertical reinforcement shall be held in position at top and bottom and at intervals not exceeding 112 diameters of the reinforcement. 3.8 GROUTING A. All cells and bond beam spaces shall be filled solidly with grout unless indicated otherwise. Grouting shall not be started until the wall has cured for 24 hours. Grout shall not be poured in more than 5-ft lifts. B. Grout shall be consolidated at time of pouring by puddling or vibrating. Where the grouting operation has been stopped for one hour or longer, horizontal construction joints shall be formed by stopping the grout pour 1-1/2 inches below the top of the uppermost unit. 3.9 PROTECTION A. Wall surfaces shall be protected from droppings of mortar or grout during construction. 1. Protect existing adjacent surfaces from mortar stains. 2. At the end of each work day, walls shall be covered to protect from the elements, until cap flashing is installed. Protection shall be in the form of a strong weather resistive material secured in place and extending at least two feet down each side of the wall. MWH-04082005 REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04232 - 11 3.10 FINISHING AND CLEANING A. Adjusting Defective Work: 1. Remove and reinstall masonry units not in alignment. 2. Remove misplaced, broken, and unbonded masonry units. 3. Adjust location of misplaced masonry accessories. 4. Rake and re-point defective masonry joints. B. Masonry shall not be wet-finished unless exposed to extreme hot weather or hot wind and then only by using a nozzle-regulated fog spray sufficient only to dampen the face but not of such quantity to cause water to flow down over the masonry. C. Finish masonry shall be cleaned and pointed in a manner approved by the ENGINEER, based upon the standards established by the approved sample panel. Do not use muriatic acid for cleaning. D. Interior and exterior colored masonry WORK exposed to view shall be cleaned to remove stains and other imperfections. E. Exposed masonry surfaces of openings and window and door openings such as sills, heads, and jambs shall be finish block surfaces, not formed surfaces, unless indicated otherwise. Closed bottom bond beam blocks shall be used at heads and sills. Pour holes may be used at the sill under window frame and where approved by the ENGINEER. - END OF SECTION - MWH-04082005 REINFORCED CONCRETE BLOCK MASONRY 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04232 - 12 SECTION 04320 —VENEER MASONRY SYSTEM PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide concrete masonry veneer and appurtenant WORK, complete and in place, in accordance with the Contract Documents. 1.2 QUALIFICATIONS A. Installer: Company specializing in performing the work of this Section with minimum five years experience. 1.3 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Product Information: Submit proposed veneer reinforcement and seismic veneer anchor spacing, together with manufacturer's documentation illustrating that the reinforcement and veneer anchors meet the specified structural performance criteria at the proposed spacing. C. Samples 1. Samples of concrete masonry veneer unit colors with texture ranges indicated for selection of color. Full size samples of the blocks selected shall be submitted for final approval after color selection, if requested. If the required product is a colored and textured unit, the samples shall be colored and textured units. If the required product is a blend of integrally colored and textured units, the samples shall be colored and textured units to represent the specified blend. 2. Samples of mortar colors for color selection. D. LEED Product Data 1. Credit MR 4: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. 2. Credit MR 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting manufacturing locations for products manufactured within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 3. Credit MR 5.2: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting location of extraction, recovery or harvest for materials contained in products addressed in item 2 above that originated within a 500-mile radius of the project site. E. Field-Constructed Mock-Ups: Prior to installation of masonry veneer, erect sample wall panels to further verify selections made under sample submittals and to demonstrate aesthetic effects as well as qualities of materials and execution. Build mock-ups to comply with the following requirements, using materials indicated for final unit of Work. 1. Locate mock-ups on site in locations indicated or, if not indicated, as directed by °-� ENGINEER. MWH-04082005 VENEER MASONRY SYSTEM 1 530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04320 - 1 4d w .t 2. A minimum 4-ft square by full thickness free-standing sample panel shall be if erected, including face and backup wythes as well as accessories, for each type of exterior masonry veneer construction. 1 3. Notify ENGINEER one week in advance of the dates and times when mock-ups will be erected. 4. Protect mock-ups from the elements with weather-resistant membrane. 5. Retain and maintain mock-ups during construction in undisturbed conditions as standard for judging completed masonry veneer construction. 6. Accepted mock-ups in undisturbed condition at time of Substantial Completion may become part of completed unit of Work. F. Documentation 1. Reports from testing masonry units 2. Reports from mortar and grout testing. 3. Reports from prism testing. G. Grout and mortar mix design 1. Proportions for components 2. Mill tests for cement 3. Admixture certification. Include chloride ion content. 4. Aggregate graduation and certification 5. Lime certification 1.4 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Applicable Standards: Concrete masonry shall conform to International Building Code (IBC), American Concrete Institute ACI 530 - Building Code Requirements for Masonry Structures, ACI 530.1 - Specification for Masonry Structures, and other applicable codes and standards of the governing authorities. B. Pre-installation Conference: THE CONTRACTOR shall conduct a conference at the Project site prior to commencement of masonry work. 1. Attendees: Masonry Sub-contractor,- CONTRACTOR, ENGINEER, Material Supplier and Owner's Representative. 2. Any questions concerning the masonry work should be discussed during the conference. C. Obtain approval of all submittals prior to proceeding with the Work. D. WORK shall conform to the standard of quality established by the approved sample panel. MWH-04082005 VENEER MASONRY SYSTEM 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04320 - 2 E. Environmental Requirements: Maintain materials and surrounding air temperature to minimum 50 degrees F prior to, during, and 48 hours after completion of masonry work. '1 PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 MANUFACTURERS A. Basalite B. Mutual Materials Company C. Willamette Graystone, Inc. 2.2 LEED REQUIREMENTS A. Product supplied for this project must be produced within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 2.3 CONCRETE MASONRY VENEER UNITS A. Concrete masonry veneer units shall be medium weight units unless indicated otherwise. 1. Grade N-I at all locations. 2. Block manufactured in accordance with ASTM Standard C-90, Type I, with a density of 115 pounds per cubic foot. 3. Maximum linear shrinkage of 0.035% per ASTM C90-75. 4. All exterior concrete masonry veneer units shall contain W.R. Grace "Dry-Block" integral admixture, or approved equal. 5. Ground-face concrete masonry units: All exposed faces shall be ground to a depth sufficient to uniformly expose the aggregates. B. Exterior concrete masonry veneer unit size and color: 1. 4-inch by 4-inch by 16-inch, 4-inch by 8-inch by 16-inch, 6-inch by 4-inch by 16- inch, 6-inch by 8-inch by 16-inch, 8-inch by 4-inch by 16-inch, and 8-inch by 8-inch by 16-inch modular sizes, with machine ground and split faces. Refer to drawings for unit locations. 2. Bond beam, corner, lintel, sill, and other specially shaped blocks shall be provided where required or necessary. Specially shaped non-structural blocks may be constructed by saw cutting. Color and texture shall match that of adjacent units. Provide "L-Corner" units and other special shapes as shown on the drawings. 3. Integrally-colored veneer units shall be blend of Basalite "Rose Brown", "Cocoa", and "Cocoa Lite". Color blend shall match the existing Digester Complex Building located immediately north of the new building. 4. Color of machine ground face veneer units shall be natural gray. C. REINFORCEMENT AND ANCHORAGE MWH-04082005 VENEER MASONRY SYSTEM 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04320 - 3 1. Adjustable Veneer Anchor a. Two pieces adjustable consisting of a minimum 11 gage plate pintel or 1/4 inch diameter double leg wire pintel and a minimum 12 gage anchor plate. The extended leg of the pintel shall have a lip or hook that will engage or enclose a horizontal joint reinforcement wire of No. 9 gage. 2. Concrete Masonry Veneer Walls a. Install seismic veneer anchors. b. Finish: All material, pintel and anchor plate shall be hot dipped galvanized with a minimum of 1.5 oz of zinc per square foot of surface area per ASTM A 123. Fasteners shall be stainless steel type 316. c. Structural Performance: Veneer anchors shall meet or exceed the following service criteria. 1) Minimum Tension/Compression: 175 pounds. 2) Minimum Axial Stiffness: 2,000 pounds per inch. 3) Maximum Axial Deflection: 0.09 inch. 4) Maximum Axial Mechanical Play: 0.05 inch. 5) Minimum Lateral Mechanical Play: 0.25 inch. d. Acceptable Products: 1) D/A 213S Heavy duty adjustable seismic anchor as manufactured by Dur-O-WaI, Inc. 2) DW-10HS with Byna-Tie and Seismiclip as manufactured by Holmann and Barnard, Inc. 3) Seismic Dur-O-Eye and Ladur Eye as manufactured by Dur-O-WaI, Inc. D. FLASHINGS 1. Flexible self-sealing concealed wall flashing, 40 mil membrane (32 mil. Pliable and highly adhesive rubberized asphalt compound bonded to an 8 mil high density four ply cross laminated polyethylene film). W.R. Grace "Perm-a-barrier". E. ACCESSORIES 1. Vertical Control Joints: a. Industry Standard for Neoprene Rubber Joints: ASTM D 2000. b. Industry Standard for Polyvinyl Chloride Joints: ASTM D 2287, Type PVC 654- 4. c. Minimum Durometer Hardness: 85 plus or minus 5. MWH-04082005 VENEER MASONRY SYSTEM 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04320 - 4 d. Minimum Shear Strength: 450 psi. e. Acceptable Control Joints: Wide Flange Plok-Joint by Carter-Waters, Blok- Tite by A.A. Wire, Regular or Wide Flange Rapid Control Joint by Dur-O-Wal, QS and VS by Hofmann and Barnard, Inc. 2. Expansion Joint Fillers: a. Product Data: Closed cell foam neoprene rubber, ASTM D 1056, Class RE41. b. Nominal Size: 1/2 inch thick, 3 inches wide. c. Acceptable Joints: Rapid Expansion Joint by Dur-O-Wal, NS by Hohmann and Barnard, Inc. 3. PVC Weep Hole Forms: a. Material: Clear polyvinyl chloride, 3/8 inch outside diameter, 4 inches long. b. Acceptable Forms: D/A 1005 Weep Hole by Dur-O-WaI. 4. Temporary Accessories: a. Temporary Sash Cord Weep Hole Forms: Cotton sash cords, 1/4 inch outside diameter, not less than twelve inches long. b. Temporary Asphalt Saturated Unperforated Felt: ASTM D 226, 15 pound type. c. Temporary Polyethylene: ASTM D 2103, 6 mils thick. 5. Cleaning solutions for natural CMU: Not harmful to masonry work or adjacent materials. Manufactured by: a. Pro So Co., Inc. "Sure Klean 600" b. Fabrikem "Fabriklean Type V" 6. Water Repellent Sealer: a. Refer to Section 07180— Water Repellents. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 EXAMINATION A. Verify that field conditions are acceptable and are ready to receive work. B. Verify items provided by other Sections of work are properly sized and located. C. Verify that built-in items are in proper location, and ready for roughing into masonry work. D. Beginning of installation means installer accepts existing conditions. MWH-04082005 VENEER MASONRY SYSTEM 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04320 - 5 3.2 PERFORMANCE A. Protection: 1. Protect existing adjacent surfaces from mortar stains. B. Surface Preparation: 1. Remove loose mortar from existing adjacent masonry surfaces. 2. Add moisture to masonry units which have a high suction rate. C. Cutting Masonry Units: 1. Perform site cutting with sharp power tools to provide straight edges without chips. 2. Cut masonry for openings and joints. 3. Avoid use of less than half size masonry units. D. Installation of Masonry Units: 1. Install masonry units plump, true and level in running bond. 2. Install masonry units in common running bond, unless special masonry patterns are indicated on Drawings. 3. Use special shape units where required. 4. Set masonry units flush on exposed side of wall and allow variation in unit width to run on concealed face of wall. E. Installation of Mortar: 1. Provide full face shell mortar beds for hollow masonry units. 2. Double butter masonry units to fill vertical head joints solid with mortar. 3. Do not use mortar which has begun to set, or is beyond the recommended elapsed time since initial mixing. 4. Re-temper mortar during the recommended elapsed time period only to restore workability. 5. Tool exposed joints concave and strike concealed joints flush. 6. Joint width uniform and 3/8" thick. MWH-04082005 VENEER MASONRY SYSTEM 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04320 - 6 F. Installation of Veneer Anchors: 1. Veneer anchors shall be spaced so as to support pport not more than two square feet of wall area but not more than 24 inches on center horizontally nor 18 inches on center vertically. 2. Additional veneer anchors shall be installed at not more than 8 inches on center adjacent to openings or edges of the concrete masonry veneer. 3. All veneer anchors shall be securely fastened to the steel stud back-up system through the sheathing— not to the sheathing alone. 4. All veneer anchors shall be aligned with the masonry joints to limit anchor eccentricies compatible with the manufacturer's test-rated capacities and } stiffnesses. 5. All veneer anchors shall have a lip or hook on the extended leg that will engage or enclose a horizontal joint reinforcement wire of No. 9 gage. The joint reinforcement shall be continuous with butt splice between ties and control joints. 6. Any mortar droppings on anchor pintel shall be removed. 7. Anchors at concrete masonry units shall be placed in cells grouted solid. G. Installation of Sheet Metal Fleshings: 1. Install sheet metal flashings as shown at head of all openings. 2. Coordinate location of reglets at head and side wall flashings for roofing installer. 3. Protect flashings for damage and stains. 4. Extend flashings under veneer; turn up minimum 8 inches and seal to sheathing over wood back-up. 5. Lap end joints minimum 6 inches and seal watertight. 6. Use flashing manufacturer's recommended adhesive and sealer. H. Installation of Joint and Flashing Materials: 1. Install reglets in mortar joints where exposed flashing meets masonry. 2. Install PVC or Sash Cord Weep Holes at 36 inches on center in vertical joints at first course of veneer masonry above foundation walls and steel lintel angles. 3. Install vertical and horizontal control joints indicated and required to control masonry cracking. 4. Install vertical and horizontal expansion joint fillers indicated on Drawings and required to fill masonry expansion joints. 5. Install concealed flashing above veneer wall lintel angles and foundation walls and behind asphaltic felt. .4� MWH-04082005 VENEER MASONRY SYSTEM 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04320 - 7 6. Fill cavity above concealed flashing at veneer masonry with 1/4 inch diameter pea gravel to t minimum depth of 3 inches. I. Installation of Embedded Items: 1. Install all lintels and miscellaneous items furnished per other divisions, which are embedded in or supported by masonry. 3.3 CUTTING AND FITTING A. Cut and fit for pipes, conduit, sleeves, duct work or other items to be installed flush with masonry veneer. Coordinate with other Sections of work to provide correct size, shape, and location. B. Obtain Architect/Engineer approval prior to cutting or fitting masonry work not indicated or where appearance or strength of masonry work may be impaired. 3.4 CAVITY WALL A. Do not permit mortar to drop or accumulate into cavity air space or to plug weep holes. 3.5 TOLERANCES A. Maximum Variation From Unit to Adjacent Unit: 1/32 inch. B. Maximum Variation From Plane of Wall: 1/4 inch in 10 feet and 1/2 inch in 20 feet or more. C. Maximum Variation From Plumb: 1/4 inch per story non-cumulative. D. Maximum Variation From Level Coursing: 1/8 inch in 3 feet and 1/4 inch in 10 feet; 1/2 inch in 30 feet. E. Maximum Variation of Joint Thickness: 1/8 inch in 3 feet. F. Maximum Variation From Cross Sectional Thickness of Walls: 1/4 inch. 3.6 COMPLETION A. Adjusting Defective Work: 1. Remove and reinstall masonry units not in alignment. 2. Remove misplaced, broken, and unbonded masonry units. 3. Adjust location of misplaced masonry accessories. Rake and re-point defective masonry joints. B. Final Cleaning: 1. Remove excess mortar and masonry materials from the site. 2. Clean adjacent surfaces and repair surfaces damaged by masonry work. MWH-04082005 VENEER MASONRY SYSTEM 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04320 - 8 3. Clean exposed masonry unit walls using an automatic power wash unit with high pressure hot water and cleaner. C. Protection of Masonry: 1. Protect mortar from freezing temperatures until end of curing period. 2. Cover masonry with temporary polyethylene sheet membrane or temporary asphalt saturated unperforated felt to protect exposed masonry walls from rain until end of curing period and permanent flashings are in place. Cover shall extend two feet down both sides of the masonry and be securely held in place. D. Application of Water Repellant Sealer: 1. Apply water repellant sealer in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations. The sealer manufacturer shall approve applicator. Prior to application of sealer, Contractor shall conduct a job site meeting with the Architect, Contractor, Mason and Sealer Applicator in attendance, to determine whether the concrete block is ready to receive sealer. -END OF SECTION- ', `mil MWH-04082005 VENEER MASONRY SYSTEM 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 04320 - 9 SECTION 05100 - STRUCTURAL STEEL FRAMING PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide structural steel framing and appurtenant metal parts required for permanent connection of the structural steel system, complete and in place, in accordance with the Contract Documents. 1.2 REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS, CODES, AND STANDARDS A. References herein to "Building Code" or IBC shall mean the International Building Code. The edition of the codes adopted as of the date of award of this contract shall apply to the WORK herein. B. Federal Specifications and Commercial Standards AISC Code of Standard Practice for Steel Buildings and Bridges AISC Structural Steel Buildings-Allowable Stress Design and Plastic Design AISC Allowable Stress Design Specifications for Structural Joints Using ASTM A325 and A490 Bolts approved by the Research Council on Structural Connections of the Engineering Foundation ASTM A 36 Structural Steel ASTM A 53 Pipe, Steel, Black and Hot-Dipped, Zinc-Coated Welded and Seamless ASTM A 307 Carbon Steel Bolts and Studs ASTM A 325 Structural Bolts, Steel, Heat Treated, 120/105 ksi Minimum Tensile Strength ASTM A 500 Cold-Formed Welded and Seamless Carbon Steel Structural Tubing in Rounds and Shapes ASTM A 501 Hot-Formed Welded and Seamless Carbon Steel Structural Tubing ASTM A 992 Steel for Structural Shapes for Use in Building Framing AWS D1.1 Structural Welding Code— Steel 1.3 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Submit in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Shop Drawings shall conform to AISC recommendations and specifications and shall show all holes, etc. required for other work. Drawings shall include complete details showing all members and their connections, anchor bolt layouts, schedules for fabrication procedures, and diagrams showing the sequence of erection. MWH-04082005 STRUCTURAL STEEL FRAMING 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05100-1 C. Testing laboratory certifications for shop and field welders shall be submitted in triplicate directly to the ENGINEER with copies to the CONTRACTOR and others as required. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 MATERIALS A. Structural steel Wide Flange Shapes ASTM A 992 Other Shapes, Plates, Bars ASTM A 36 Pipe, Pipe Columns, Bollards ASTM A 53, Type E or S, Grade B standard weight unless noted otherwise HSS ASTM A 500 Grade B B. Bolts for connections shall be ASTM A 325, unless indicated otherwise. Bolts used to connect dissimilar metals shall be ASTM A 193 and A 194, Type 316 stainless steel. C. Welded anchor studs shall be headed concrete anchor studs (HAS), or deformed bar anchors (DBA), or threaded studs (TAS), as indicated on the Drawings and as supplied by Nelson Stud Welding Company, Lorain, OH; Omark Industries, KSM Fastening Systems Division, Seattle, WA, or Portland, OR; or equal. D. Structural steel shall be cleaned and coated in accordance with Section 09800 - Protective Coating. E. Steel members in contact with aluminum shall be galvanized per Section 05500 - Miscellaneous Metalwork, unless indicated otherwise. F. Structural members shall be furnished full length without splices unless otherwise indicated or approved by the ENGINEER. 2.2 INSPECTION AND TESTING A. Shop inspection may be required by the OWNER at its own expense. The CONTRACTOR shall give ample notice to the ENGINEER prior to the beginning of any fabrication work so that inspection may be provided. The CONTRACTOR shall furnish all facilities for the inspection of materials and workmanship in the shop, and inspectors shall be allowed free access to the necessary parts of the WORK. Inspectors shall have the authority to reject any materials or WORK which does not meet the requirements of these Specifications. Inspection at the shop is intended as a means of facilitating the work and avoiding errors, but it is expressly understood that it will in no way relieve the CONTRACTOR from responsibility for proper materials or workmanship under this Specification. B. The OWNER may engage inspectors to inspect welded connections and high-strength bolted connections, and to perform tests and prepare test reports. MWH-04082005 STRUCTURAL STEEL FRAMING 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05100-2 1. Ten percent of all butt and bevel welds which extend continuously for 24-inches or less shall be completely tested in accordance with AWS D1.1, Part B, Radiographic Testing of Welds, Chapter 6. All butt and bevel welds which extend continuously for more than 24 inches shall be spot tested at intervals not exceeding 36 inches. 2. Welds that are required by the ENGINEER to be corrected shall be corrected or redone and retested as directed, at the CONTRACTOR's expense and to the satisfaction of the ENGINEER and/or approved independent testing lab. 3. The CONTRACTOR shall test to failure three bolts from each heat lot of bolts furnished to the job to verify compliance with this Specification. The testing laboratory shall be approved by the ENGINEER and all test reports shall be supplied to the ENGINEER in accordance with Section 01300 — Contractor's Submittals. In addition, high-strength bolts shall be inspected using one of the methods set forth in the AISC Specification "Structural Joints Using ASTM A 325 or A 490 Bolts." C. The costs for all initial testing will be paid by the OWNER. However, the CONTRACTOR shall pay for all costs for any additional testing and investigation on WORK which does not meet Specifications. The CONTRACTOR shall supply material for testing at no cost to the OWNER and shall assist the ENGINEER in obtaining material for test samples. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 MEASUREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall verify all dimensions and shall make any field measurements necessary and shall be fully responsible for accuracy and layout of work. The CONTRACTOR shall review the Drawings, and any discrepancies shall be reported to the ENGINEER for clarification prior to starting fabrication. 3.2 FABRICATION A. Structural steel shall be fabricated in accordance with the Drawings, AISC Specifications, and as shown on the Shop Drawings. B. Materials shall be properly marked and match-marked for field assembly. C. Where finishing is required, assembly shall be completed including bolting and welding of units, before start of finishing operations. 3.3 CONNECTIONS A. Shop and field connections shall be bolted or welded as indicated. All connections shall develop full strength of members joined and shall conform to AISC standard connections. B. Unless otherwise indicated, welds shall conform to AISC LRFD Specification for Structural Steel Buildings. 3.4 WELDED CONSTRUCTION A. The CONTRACTOR shall comply with the current AWS D1.1 Code for procedures, appearance, and quality of welds and welders, and methods used in correcting welding work. All welded architectural metal work where exposed to view shall have welds MWH-04082005 STRUCTURAL STEEL FRAMING 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05100-3 ground smooth. Shielded metal arc welding method or gas metal arc welding methods shall be used for welding structural steel. B. Unless otherwise indicated, all butt and bevel welds shall be complete penetration. C. Where electrical grounding cables are to be welded to structural steel, the surface of the steel must be clean to bare metal, and the welding shall be performed prior to painting or touch-up operation. 3.5 HOLES FOR OTHER WORK A. Holes shall be provided as necessary or as indicated for securing other work to structural steel framing, and for the passage of other work through steel framing members. No torch cut holes will be permitted. 3.6 SHOP PAINT PRIMER A. Shop paint primer shall be applied in accordance with Section 09800 — Protective Coating. Omit shop applied primer at field weld locations, for the portion of a member to be embedded in concrete, and where galvanizing with no further coating is required. 3.7 PRODUCT DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING A. Structural members shall be loaded in such a manner that they may be transported and unloaded without being excessively stressed, deformed, or otherwise damaged. B. Structural steel members and packaged materials shall be protected from corrosion and deterioration. Material shall be stored in a dry area and shall not be placed in direct contact with the ground. Materials shall not be placed on the structure in a manner that might cause distortion or damage to the members or the supporting structures. Repair or replace damaged materials or structures as directed. 3.8 ERECTION A. The CONTRACTOR shall comply with the AISC Specifications and Code of Standard Practice, and with indicated requirements. B. High-strength bolts shall be installed in accordance with the AISC Specification for Structural Joints using ASTM A 325 Bolts. The connections shall be the friction type, unless indicated otherwise. C. Anchor bolts and other connectors required for securing structural steel to in-place WORK and templates and other devices for presetting bolts and other anchors to accurate locations shall be furnished by the CONTRACTOR. D. The CONTRACTOR shall be responsible for designing and installing any temporary bracing required for the safe erection of all structural steel members. 3.9 SETTING BASES AND BEARING PLATES A. Prior to the placement of non-shrink grout beneath base and bearing plates, the bottom surface of the plates shall be cleaned of all bond-reducing materials, and concrete and masonry bearing surface shall also be cleaned of all bond-reducing materials and roughened to improve bonding. MWH-04082005 STRUCTURAL STEEL FRAMING 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05100-4 B. Loose and attached baseplates and bearing plates for structural members shall be set on wedges, leveling nuts, or other adjustable devices. C. Anchor bolts shall be tightened after the supported members have been positioned and plumbed and the non-shrink grout has attained its indicated strength. D. Baseplates shall be grouted with non-shrink grout to assure full uniform bearing. Grouting shall be done prior to placing loads on the structure. 3.10 FIELD ASSEMBLY A. Structural frames shall be set accurately to the lines and elevations indicated. The various members shall be aligned and adjusted to form a part of a complete frame or structure before permanently fastening. Bearing surfaces and other surfaces which will be in permanent contact shall be cleaned before assembly. Necessary adjustments to compensate for discrepancies in elevations and alignments shall be performed. B. Individual members of the structure shall be leveled and plumbed within AISC tolerances. C. Required leveling and plumbing measurements shall be established on the mean operating temperature of the structure. 3.11 MISFITS AT BOLTED CONNECTIONS A. Where misfits in erection bolting are encountered, the ENGINEER shall be immediately notified. The CONTRACTOR shall submit a method to remedy the misfit for review by the ENGINEER. The ENGINEER will determine whether the remedy is acceptable or if the member must be refabricated. B. Incorrectly sized or misaligned holes in members shall not be enlarged by burning or by the use of drift pins. C. Correction of misfits is part of the WORK. 3.12 GAS CUTTING A. Gas cutting torches shall not be used in the field for correcting fabrication errors in the structural framing, except when approved by the ENGINEER. Gas-cut sections shall be finished equal to a sheared appearance. 3.13 TOUCH-UP PAINTING A. Immediately after erection, field welds, bolted connections, and abraded areas shall be cleaned of the shop paint primer. Touch-up paint primer shall be applied by brush or spray which is the same thickness and material as that used for the shop paint. Galvanized surfaces which have been field welded or damaged shall be repaired in accordance with Section 05500 — Miscellaneous Metalwork. B. Finish painting of all structural steel shall be as indicated in Section 09800 — Protective Coating. - END OF SECTION - MWH-04082005 STRUCTURAL STEEL FRAMING 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05100-5 SECTION 05210 - OPEN WEB STEEL JOISTS PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide the open web steel joists, complete and in place, in accordance with the Contract Documents. B. Variation of Dimensions: The dimensions indicated for the joists, as well as depth of members and thickness of chords, are for general design control purposes. Minor variations from these dimensions, if required to accommodate manufacturing standards, etc., will be allowed. 1.2 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Shop Drawings 1. Design calculations, erection drawings, and shop drawings shall be designed by a professional engineer registered in the State of Oregon. 2. Complete design calculations for the particular unit or system utilized, including maximum stresses in individual members and other information pertinent to the design. 3. Complete design calculations for the connections of any special forces between the steel joists and the supporting elements of the walls, beams, and columns, where such forces are specifically indicated. 4. Shop and erection drawings shall include at least the following items: a. General layout plan with overall dimensions. b. Fabrication and erection details. c. Connections and anchoring details. d. Bridging size, location and connection details. e. Size and location of all openings. f. Size and location of all mechanical and electrical equipment supported by the roof system that may affect the design for fabrication. g. Location, details, and capacity of all lift point attachments. 5. Mill certificates for all materials. Certificates shall be approved before fabrication begins. 1.3 QUALITY CONTROL A. Joists may be inspected by the ENGINEER before shipment to ensure compliance of materials and workmanship with the requirements of these Specifications. MWH -04082005 OPEN WEB STEEL JOISTS 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05210-1 PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 DESIGN CRITERIA A. All open web steel joists and bridging shall be designed to meet the structural and fire requirements of the latest edition of the applicable building code and governing fire codes. B. All open web steel joist members and their connections shall either be designed for the uniform loads as indicated for the Steel Joist Institute designation or be designed to adequately support all indicated loads as shown or as called for by applicable codes. C. The Contractor shall coordinate the location of concentrated mechanical and electrical equipment loads on the joists. 2.2 MATERIALS A. General: Materials utilized in the WORK but not specifically mentioned in this Section shall be governed by the latest applicable ASTM Standards. B. Design: Design of steel joists and bridging shall be in accordance with the latest Steel Joist Institute Specifications. C. Steel: The steel used in the manufacture of chord and web sections shall conform to the Steel Joist Institute Standard Specifications and applicable ASTM Standards. D. Mechanical Properties: The yield strength used as basis for the design stress shall be either 36,000 psi or 50,000 psi. Mill certificates shall be submitted for all materials for review and approval before fabrication can begin. E. Design Verification Test: The manufacturer shall, at the time of design review by the ENGINEER, verify joist capacities in accordance with the Steel Joist Institute requirements. F. Welding: All welding shall conform to the latest Steel Joist Institute Specifications and AWS D1.1. G. Coating shall be in accordance with Section 09800 - Protective Coating. After erecting and welding are complete, welds and scarred surfaces on the joists shall be given a touch-up coat of the same paint as shop coat. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 ERECTION REQUIREMENTS A. Handling and Erection: Handling and erection shall be in accordance with the latest Steel Joist Institute Specifications and the requirements below: B. Care shall be exercised at all times to avoid damage through careless handling during unloading, storing, and erecting. 1. Erection of all steel joists shall be performed by personnel experienced in this type of work. MWH -04082005 OPEN WEB STEEL JOISTS 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05210-2 2. Sequence of erection shall be thoroughly outlined prior to starting and any special sequence outlined by the ENGINEER shall be strictly adhered to. 3. Base lines and elevations shall be established by the CONTRACTOR prior to the start of erection. 4. Bearing surfaces shall be prepared to a true and level line. 5. Erect and place all joists safely. Each element shall be set in proper position as shown on the reviewed erection drawings, carefully plumbed, and anchored securely to the supporting structural elements. 6. As soon as joists are erected, bridging shall be completely installed and the joists permanently fastened into place before the application of any loads. 7. Field welding shall not damage the joists. The total length of weld at any one point on cold-formed members whose yield strength has been attained by cold working and whose as-formed strength is used in the design shall not exceed 50 percent of the overall developed width of the cold-formed section. C. Completion: All units shall be in place, properly and completely anchored and approved before any finishes are applied. Any damaged units, where in the opinion of the ENGINEER, suitable and adequate repairs cannot be made, will be rejected, whether or not delivered or erected; and whole, approved replacement units shall be provided by the CONTRACTOR. - END OF SECTION - MWH -04082005 OPEN WEB STEEL JOISTS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05210-3 SECTION 05300 - METAL DECKING • PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide steel decking and accessory items, complete and in place, in accordance with the Contract Documents. 1.2 REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS, CODES AND STANDARDS A. Specifications and Commercial Standards AISI Design of Cold - Formed Steel Structural Members. SDI Design Manual for Composite Decks, Form Decks, and Roof Decks. ASTM A 446 Steel Sheet, Zinc-Coated (Galvanized) by the Hot-Dip Process, Structural (Physical) Quality. ASTM A 653 General Requirements for Steel Sheet, Zinc-Coated (Galvanized) or Zinc-Iron Alloy Coated (Galvanealed) by the Hot-Dip Process. ASTM A 611 Steel, Sheet, Carbon, Cold-Rolled, Structural Quality AWS D1.3 Structural Welding Code-Sheet Steel B. ICBO/ES Research Reports for each type of metal decking used in the WORK. 1.3 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Prior to the commencement of any WORK, the CONTRACTOR shall submit an affidavit furnished by the deck manufacturer certifying to the yield strength. The CONTRACTOR shall submit gauge and section properties of the metal deck. The CONTRACTOR shall also furnish the diaphragm shear values for the deck using the welding pattern and/or shear capacity indicated. Failure to conform to this requirement shall be justification for rejection of the material. C. Submit a layout drawing showing the location of deck sheets, end laps, side laps, types and locations of welds and details of accessories. D. Submit an ICBO Research Report for each type of metal decking used in the.WORK. 1.4 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. No insulation, roofing materials, or other permanent coverings shall be placed over the decking until the ENGINEER has inspected it for placement, welds, and accessories. Stored materials and debris shall be removed to facilitate the inspection. Welds found to be defective shall be replaced as a part of the WORK. MWH-04082005 METAL DECKING 1530575 — DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05300 - 1 1.5 MATERIAL STORAGE A. Decking stored at the Site before installation shall be stacked on the ground on platforms 1 or pallets and covered with tarpaulins or other weatherproof covering. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 STEEL DECK A. Unless indicated otherwise, metal deck shall be manufactured from steel conforming to ASTM A 611, Grades C, D, or E; or A 446, Grades A, B, C, D, E, or F, or equal, having a minimum yield strength of 33,000 psi. The maximum design working stress in the deck shall not exceed the product of 0.6 times the yield strength. B. The metal deck structural properties shall be as indicated. The moment of inertia and section modulus of the metal deck unit shall be computed in accordance with the Steel Deck Institute specifications, and in accordance with the American Iron and Steel Institute, "Specification for the Design of Cold-Formed Steel Structural Members." C. Steel decking shall be galvanized and shall conform to ASTM A 653 and to the applicable requirements of Section 05500 - Miscellaneous Metalwork. Steel deck shall be free of oil, grease, and dirt before dipping. Steel decking receiving lightweight concrete topping shall be vented. Steel decking for pitch roof shall be acoustical type. D. Steel deck shall be finished in accordance with Section 09800 - Protective Coating. Deck shall be free of oil, grease and dirt before coating application. E. The metal deck shall have sheet length that covers 3 or more spans. F. The metal deck sheets shall be formed at the longitudinal sides in such a manner that they will overlap and/or interlock. Where the end of sheets overlap, they shall be die-formed in such a manner that the sheet in the next row telescopes and snugly overlaps the sheet laid previously. G. Plates needed to connect decking to supports or to maintain deck continuity shall be 14 gauge galvanized sheet. H. Structural steel shapes, including angles and inserts, shall be in accordance with Section 05100 - Structural Steel Framing and 05500 - Miscellaneous Metalwork. 2.2 MANUFACTURERS A. The metal decking shall be manufactured by Verco Manufacturing Company, Phoenix, Arizona; ASC Pacific Inc., Tacoma, Washington; Vulcraft Nucor Corporation Inc.; or equal. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS A. The CONTRACTOR shall inspect supporting members for correct layout and alignment, and shall not proceed with installation until defects are corrected and supporting members are completely installed and secured. MWH-04082005 METAL DECKING 1530575 — DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05300 - 2 B. Metal deck sheets and accessories shall be placed in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations and the Shop Drawings. Roofs having a slope of 1/4- inch per foot or more shall be installed starting at the low side, to ensure that end laps are shingle fashion. C. Metal deck sheets shall be positioned on supporting steel framework and adjusted to final position with ends bearing a minimum of 2 inches on supporting members. Units shall be placed end to end, with ribs aligned over the entire length of the run before being permanently fastened. D. Special care shall be exercised not to damage or overload the deck during installation. The deck shall not be used for storage or as working platforms until permanently secured in position. Construction loads shall not exceed the deck carrying capacity, as recommended by the manufacturer. E. Openings in the deck shall be cut and fitted neatly and shall be reinforced with structural steel members to distribute the load. F. Where concrete fill is required, deck shall be installed with closure plates and other accessories as needed to prevent loss of water, cement, and fines during placing and consolidation of the concrete. G. Edges of any cut openings or any minor surface damage areas shall be repaired in accordance with applicable requirements of the Sections 09800 — Protective Coating and 05500 — Miscellaneous Metalwork. H. After installation, surfaces shall be cleaned and left free of grime and dirt. The CONTRACTOR shall remove unused materials, tools, scaffolding, and debris from the premises and leave the area broom clean. 3.2 WELDING A. Care shall be exercised in the selection of electrodes and amperage to provide positive welds and to prevent high amperage blowholes. Welds shall be made from the top side of the deck immediately after alignment. B. The metal deck shall be welded to supporting members with 1/2-inch effective diameter puddle welds spaced at 12 inches on center at members parallel to the ribs and at every rib valley at members perpendicular to the ribs, unless otherwise indicated. Welding washers shall be used when welding steel deck of less than 0.028-inch thickness. Welding washers shall not be used when welding steel deck of 0.028-inches or greater. C. Side laps shall be welded with 1-1/2 inch long top seam welds, spaced at 12 inches on center unless indicated otherwise. D. Welds shall be free of sharp points or edges. Welds shall be cleaned immediately by chipping or wire brushing and shall be coated with zinc dust type primer paint. E. Welding shall conform to the applicable requirements of AISC "Light Gauge Steel Design." Welders shall be AWS certified. - END OF SECTION - MWH-04082005 METAL DECKING 1530575 — DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05300 - 3 SECTION 05400 - COLD FORMED (LIGHT) METAL FRAMING PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall construct all light metal framing and appurtenant work, complete, in accordance with the Contract Documents. 1.2 REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS, CODES, AND STANDARDS A. Commercial Standards ASTM A 1011 Steel, Sheet and Strip, Hot-Rolled, Carbon, Structural, High- t Strength Low-Alloy and High-Strength Low-Alloy with Improved Formability ASTM A 653 Steel Sheet, Zinc-Coated (Galvanized) or Zinc-Iron Alloy-Coated (Galvannealed) by the Hot Dip Process ASTM C 645 Non Structural Steel Framing Members 1.3 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Product Information: Manufacturer's literature, specifications, installation instructions, technical data, and general recommendations. C. Product Selection: Manufacturer's information for typical cross sectional properties and connection details for members selected for construction. D. Certifications: Manufacturer's certification that the proposed materials comply with this Section. E. LEED Product Data: 1. Credit MR 4: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. 2. Credit MR 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting manufacturing locations for products manufactured within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 3. Credit MR 5.2: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting location of extraction, recovery or harvest for materials contained in products addressed in item 2 above that originated within a 500-mile radius of the project. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 METAL STUDS A. Non-Load Bearing: MWH-04082005 COLD FORMED (LIGHT) METAL FRAMING 1530575 — DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION PAGE 05400-1 1. Metal studs shall be of the non-load-bearing channel type, roll-formed electrogalvanized steel. Tracks and erection accessories shall be standard products of an established metal stud manufacturer, unless otherwise indicated. Metal studs shall be 25 gauge, 3-5/8-inch deep unless otherwise indicated. a. Ceiling Framing: Minimum depth 6", 20 gauge, 16" o.c. spacing. b. Wall Framing: Depth and spacing as noted on the drawings, 20 gauge. c. Wall Framing at Ceramic Tile: Twenty-gauge or heavier studs, 16" o.c. spacing, minimum depth of 3-5/8" shall be used at non-load bearing walls having a ceramic tile wainscot condition. B. Load Bearing: Metal studs of 16-gauge steel shall be used where indicated to be used. They shall be standard 16-gauge, punched steel, galvanized studs formed from steel meeting the requirements of ASTM A 1011 with 50,000 psi. 1. Studs designed for load bearing conditions and exterior use: a. Use 16-gauge, 6-inch by 1-3/8 inch C stud at 16-inch spacing unless otherwise noted. 2.2 MISCELLANEOUS MATERIALS A. Hanger Wire: Hanger wire for suspended gypsum board ceilings shall be of soft- temper, annealed and galvanized steel wire. Hanger wire size shall be not less than that required by governing code. B. Runner Channels: Runner channels shall be 1-1/2 inch cold-rolled channels and 3/4- inch stiffener channels, galvanized or factory-coated with rust-inhibitive paint. Channels shall have minimum weight of 475 and 300 Ibs/1000 L.F. respectively. C. Furring Channels: Furring channels shall be designed for screw attachment of 5/8-inch gypsum wallboard. They shall be roll-formed, galvanized Grade "A" steel conforming to ASTM A 653, with a metal thickness of 0.022-inch minimum, 7/8-inch depth, and 1-3/8 inch web. Furring channels for styrene foam-board insulation shall be as indicated in Section 07210 - Building Insulation. D. Tie Wire: Tie wire shall be galvanized, 16-gauge, annealed steel wire. E. Fasteners: Fasteners shall be stainless steel. F. Welding Materials: Welding materials shall be as recommended in the published standards of the structural stud manufacturer. G. Power-Driven Pins: Power-driven pins to be installed in concrete or steel shall be of heat-treated steel alloy. If the pins are not sufficiently corrosion-resistant for the conditions to which they are to be exposed, they shall be protected in an acceptable manner. Pins shall have capped or threaded heads capable of transmitting the loads the shanks are required to support. Pins that are connected to steel shall have longitudinal serrations around the circumference of the shank. Complete information describing pin capacity, connections, and proposed area of use shall be submitted to the ENGINEER. MWH-04082005 COLD FORMED (LIGHT) METAL FRAMING 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION PAGE 05400-2 2.3 LEEDTM REQUIREMENTS: A. Metal studs shall contain a 20% minimum weighted average recycle content. 1 PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS A. WORK shall be installed in conformance with the manufacturer's recommendations, the applicable requirements of the governing code, ANSI, and as indicated. 3.2 METAL STUDS, FURRING AND FRAMING (For Non-Bearing Walls) A. Runner Track Attachment: Floor and ceiling runner tracks shall be securely fastened to floor and overhead construction as indicated and as required. B. Stud Attachment: Studs shall be securely fastened to tracks and spaced in accordance with the stud schedule. Each stud shall be crimped into runner tracks at the top, bottom, and both sides for friction fit with 1/4-inch deflection clearance on top. C. Wall Stiffening: Walls shall be stiffened with 3/4-inch channels placed horizontally at not more than 4-1/2 foot vertical spacing. 1. Provide bracing at walls to receive ceramic tile. D. Furring Installation Requirements: 1. Fasten to concrete and concrete masonry with powder driven 0.145 inch diameter stainless steel Dome head nail, 1-1/2 " min embed, X-DNI by Hilti or equal. 2. Fasten to metal with powder driven, 0.145 inch diameter galvanized dome head nail, X-EDNI by Hilti or equal. 3. Max spacing 24 inch each way for all fasteners to furring channel. E. Stud Installation Requirements: 1. Studs shall be located at all door frame jambs, at abutting construction, intersecting walls, and corners. Each corner and intersection of walls and partitions shall be formed with not less than 3 studs. 2. Double 20 gauge studs shall be secured to the jamb anchors of each door frame by bolt or screw attachment. Studs at door openings shall extend to the structure. 3. Studs extending from door frame header to ceiling runner over door frames shall be positioned at wall board joints. Stud walls which do not extend to structures above the ceiling shall be braced to the structure at every 8 ft - 0 inches. 4. The CONTRACTOR shall install 20 gauge studs at wall-mounted fixtures and at a maximum of 12 inches on centers behind walls to receive ceramic tile. 5. Stud walls shall be braced as necessary to provide rigid construction. Double row of studs for chase walls shall be braced with cross ties of 1/2-inch or 5/8-inch thick gypsum board, 12 inches wide, installed at quarter points of studs. MWH-04082005 COLD FORMED (LIGHT) METAL FRAMING 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION PAGE 05400-3 aA 6. Parapet walls and hung exterior walls and soffits shall be framed as indicated with rA not less than 18 gauge studs. F. Openings: 1. Channels shall be provided around openings for attachment of metal frames, dampers, grilles, and ductwork in connection with metal studs and shall be securely fastened to studs. 2. Headers, sills, and jack studs shall be provided as required at openings. Headers shall overlap adjacent vertical studs and shall be securely screw-attached to adjacent studs. 3. Where 25-gauge studs are used, a 1-1/2 inch channel stiffener shall be installed 6- inches above the door openings. Stiffeners shall extend past the second single-stud on each side of the opening, and shall be saddle-tied to the structure. G. Lintels: Trussed or box-framed lintel members designed to resist applied loads without excessive deflection shall be provided and shall be secured together by screws or other approved means. H. Support for Wall-Mounted Braced Items: Solid blocking, 1-1/2 inch channels, horizontal studding or other members within walls shall be provided as required to provide secure and adequate support for wall-mounted or wall-braced items. Galvanized plates shall be provided as backing for handrail brackets, 16 gauge by 8-inch by 16-inch. CONTRACTOR shall coordinate with OWNER for size and location of OWNER supplied wall-mounted fixtures, toilet room accessories and equipment. I. Horizontal Stiffeners: Ends of horizontal stiffeners shall be securely fastened to abutting construction. J. Furring Channels: Furring channels shall be spaced 16 inches on centers, maximum, unless indicated otherwise. Spans shall not exceed manufacturer's published recommendations and governing code requirements. 3.3 STRUCTURAL LOAD BEARING STEEL STUD WALLS A. Prefabrication: Structural steel stud walls may be fabricated into panels or components prior to erection. B. Stud Spacing: Studs shall be spaced at 16-inch centers, unless noted otherwise on the drawings. C. Component Attachment: 1. Attachments of similar components shall be done by welding. Dissimilar stud components shall be attached by welding, screw attaching, or bolting. Welds shall be fillet, plug, butt, or seam welds. 2. Wire tying of framing components in structural applications will not be permitted and will not be acceptable. 3. Splices in axial hooded studs shall not be used. D. 'Butt Joints in Tracks: Butt welds or splices shall be used at all butt joints in the tracks. MWH-04082005 COLD FORMED (LIGHT) METAL FRAMING 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION PAGE 05400-4 E. Stud Track Anchorage: 1. Bottom track for structural steel studs shall be anchored to concrete floor or foundation slabs with 1/8-inch diameter shank power-driven fasteners at 6-inch on center. 2. Wall top and bottom tracks for structural steel studs connected to structural steel members shall be provided with a 3 inch long weld connection every 2 ft-6 in of run. F. Connect studs to steel beams at each level of steel framing, or anchor to side wall at 48- inch spacing. 3.4 WORKMANSHIP A. Alignment: Metal studs shall be installed rigid, in line, level, and plumb and shall be suitable for the application of the intended succeeding contiguous materials. The maximum allowable deviation in any plane shall be 3/16-inch from an 8 foot straight line and 1/2-inch maximum in a surface having a total length in excess of 8 feet. B. Component Fit: 1. Framing components shall be cut squarely or on an angle, as in bracing, to fit squarely against abutting members. 2. Tracks shall be securely anchored to the floor and overhead structure or other members. 3. Studs shall be seated squarely in the track with the stud web and flanges abutting the track web, shall be plumbed or aligned, and shall be securely attached to the flanges or web of both the upper and lower tracks. C. Temporary Bracing: 1. Framing shall be held firmly in position until properly fastened. 2. Prefabricated panels shall be square and braced against racking. Lifting of prefabricated panels shall be done in a manner as to not cause local distortion in any member. D. Jack Studs: Jack studs shall be provided between all track and window sills; between window and door headers and top track; at free-standing stair rails; and elsewhere to provide structural support. Jack studs shall be securely attached to supporting members. - END OF SECTION - MWH-04082005 COLD FORMED (LIGHT) METAL FRAMING 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION PAGE 05400-5 SECTION 05500 - MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide miscellaneous metalwork and appurtenances, complete and in place, in accordance with the Contract Documents. 1.2 REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS, CODES, AND STANDARDS A. Federal Specifications MIL-G-18015 A(3) (Ships)Aluminum Planks. (6063-T6) MIL-A-907E Antiseize Thread Compound, High Temperature B. Commercial Standards AA-M32C22A41 Aluminum Assn. AASHTO HS-20 Truck Loading AISC Manual of Steel Construction AISI Design of Light Gauge, Cold-Formed Steel Structural Members ASTM A 36 Carbon Structural Steel ASTM A 48 Gray Iron Castings ASTM A 53 Pipe, Steel, Black and Hot-Dipped, Zinc-Coated, Welded and Seamless ASTM A 123 Zinc (Hot-Dip Galvanized) Coatings on Iron and Steel Products ASTM A 153 Zinc Coating (Hot-Dip) on Iron and Steel Hardware ASTM A 193 Alloy Steel and Stainless Steel Bolting Materials for High Temperature Service ASTM A 194 Carbon and Alloy Steel Nuts for Bolts for High Pressure and High Temperature Service ASTM A 307 Carbon Steel Bolts and Studs, 60,000 psi Tensile Strength ASTM A 325 Structural Bolts, Steel, Heat Treated, 120/105 ksi Minimum Tensile Strength ASTM A 500 Cold-Formed Welded and Seamless Carbon Steel Structural Tubing in Rounds and Shapes ASTM A 992 Steel for Structural Shapes for Use in Building Framing ANSI/AWS D1.1 Structural Welding Code - Steel ANSI/AWS D1.2 Structural Welding Code - Aluminum ANSI/AWS QC1 Qualification and Certification of Welding Inspectors 1.3 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. MWH - 04082005 MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05500 - 1 B. Shop Drawings: Shop Drawings shall conform to AISC recommendations and specifications and shall show holes, etc. required for other parts of the WORK. Drawings shall include complete details of members and connections, anchor bolt layouts, schedules for fabrication procedures, and diagrams for the sequence of erection. 1. Layout drawings for grating, showing the direction of span, type and depth of grating, size and shape of grating panels, seat angle details, and details of grating hold down fasteners. Load and deflection tables shall be submitted for each style and depth of grating used. 2. An ICBO report listing the ultimate load capacity in tension and shear for each size and type of concrete anchor. CONTRACTOR shall submit manufacturer's recommended installation instructions and procedures for adhesive anchors. Upon review by ENGINEER, these instructions shall be followed specifically. 3. No substitution for the indicated adhesive anchors will be considered unless accompanied with ICBO report verifying strength and material equivalency, including temperature at which load capacity is reduced to 90 percent of that determined at 75 degrees F. C. LEED Product Data: 1. Credit MR 4: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. 2. Credit MR 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting locations for products fabricated within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 1.4 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Weld procedures and welder qualifications shall be available in CONTRACTOR's field office for review. B. Welding shall be inspected in accordance with the requirements of Section 01450 Special Inspection and Structural Observations. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 GENERAL REQUIREMENTS A. Steel Wide Flange Shapes ASTM A 992 Shapes, Plates, Bars ASTM A 36 Pipe, Pipe Columns, Bollards ASTM A 53, Type E or S, Grade B standard weight unless indicated otherwise HSS ASTM A 500 Grade B B. Corrosion Protection: Unless otherwise indicated, fabricated steel metalwork which will be used in a corrosive environment and/or will be submerged in water/wastewater shall be coated in accordance with Section 09800 - Protective Coating. MWH - 04082005 MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05500 - 2 C. Stainless Steel: Unless otherwise indicated, stainless steel metalwork and bolts shall be of Type 316 stainless steel. D. Aluminum: Unless otherwise indicated, aluminum metalwork shall be of Alloy 6061-T6. Aluminum in contact with concrete, masonry, wood, porous materials, or dissimilar metals shall have contact surfaces coated in accordance with Section 09800. E. Cast Iron: Unless otherwise indicated, iron castings shall conform to the requirements of ASTM A 48, Class 50B or better. 2.2 METAL STAIRS A. Metal Stairs: Metal stairs shall be composed of aluminum stringers and supports and shall be fabricated in accordance with standard practice of the National Association of Ornamental Metal Manufacturers. 2.3 GRATING STAIR TREADS A. Grating stair treads shall be designed to support a live load of 100 psf or a concentrated load at mid-span of 1000 pounds, whichever creates the higher stress. The maximum deflection due to the uniform live load shall be as required for metal grating below. Grating stair treads shall have an integral non-slip nosing. 2.4 SAFETY STAIR NOSINGS A. Safety stair nosing shall be provided on concrete stairs and other locations as indicated. The nosing shall be 3 inches wide extruded aluminum with cast-in abrasive strips and integral extruded anchors. The color of the cast abrasive shall be as selected by the ENGINEER from the manufacturer's standard colors. The nosing shall be Amstep Products, Style "231-A", American Mason Safety Tread Company, Figure "31A," or equal. 2.5 FABRICATED LADDERS A. Ladders which may be partially or wholly submerged or which are located inside a hydraulic structure, shall be entirely of Type 316 stainless steel. Other ladders shall be of aluminum, or as indicated. B. Ladder for roof and floor access hatch shall be equipped with a pop-up extension. Pop- up extension device shall be manufactured of the same material and finish as the ladder and have telescoping tubular section that locks automatically when fully extended. Upward and downward improvement shall be controlled by stainless steel spring balancing mechanisms. Units shall be completely assembled with fasteners for securing to the ladder rungs in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. 2.6 PREFABRICATED ROOF ACCESS LADDERS A. Roof ladder A and Roof Ladder B for access to roofs of Valve Control and Hvac Room shall be of aluminum and shall confirm to the design criteria below. B. Acceptable Manufacturers: 1. Royalite Manufacturing, Inc; 1055 Terminal Way, San Carlos, CA 94070. Tel: (650) 637-1440 or (800) 875-9548. Fax: (650) 637-9770. www.royalite-mfg.com. 2. O'Keefe's Inc., 75 Williams Avenue, San Francisco, CA 94124. MWH - 04082005 MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05500 - 3 Tel: (405) 822-4222 or(800) 227-3305. Fax: (415) 822-3888. C. Components: 1. Ladders: Provide assembled ladders that comply with OSHA, 2003 IBC and local building codes, with all edges rounded, clean, smooth, and burr free; dimensions as indicated on drawings. 2. Ladder Treads: Extruded aluminum, 6063-T5 alloy, with self-cleaning serrated top surface and rounded front and back edges; fastened to handrails with concealed stainless steel screws; capable of withstanding 300 pounds load per tread without damage. a. Cross Section for Vertical Ladders: Minimum 2 inches horizontal, nominal 1 inch (25 mm) vertical. b. Width: 24 inches. c. Spacing: 12 inches vertically. D. Landing Platforms: Made up of tread members mounted side-by-side. 3. Vertical Ladder Rails Supporting Treads: Extruded aluminum, 6063-T5 alloy, with rounded corners, approximately 4 inches deep; mounted so that centerline of tread is minimum of 7 inches from face of wall. a. Wall Brackets: Bent aluminum plate, 2 inches wide by 3/16 inch thick. b. Base Brackets: Aluminum angle floor bracket, 2 by 2 by 2 by 1/8 inch thick. c. Base Brackets: Wall bracket with additional angle brace; supporting foot of rail at least 4 inches above floor or grade. D. Extended Rails: 0.875 inch diameter aluminum tubing; formed with two parallel tubes for each length of rail, with radiused corners, assembled by welding or with stainless steel fasteners. 1. At Top of Ladders Leading to Roofs or Landings: Extending minimum of 42 inches vertically above top of parapet or landing and extending minimum of 10 inches past edge of roof or landing; with free walk-through onto roof/landing. E. Anchor Bolts: Stainless steel bolts; diameter as specified by ladder manufacturer; length as required to provide adequate anchorage into substrate. 2.7 METAL GRATING A. General: Metal grating shall be of the design, sizes, and types indicated. Grating shall be completely banded at edges and cutouts using material and cross-section equivalent to the bearing bars. Such banding shall be welded to each cut bearing bar. Grating shall be supported around an opening by support members. Where grating is supported on concrete, embedded stainless steel support angles shall be used. Such angles shall be mitered and welded at corners. 1. Pieces of grating shall be fastened in 2 locations to each support. MWH - 04082005 MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05500 -4 2. Where grating forms the landing at the top of a stairway, the edge of the grating that forms the top riser shall have an integral non-slip nosing, width equal to that of the stairway. 3. Where grating depth is not given, grating shall be provided that will be within allowable stress levels and which shall not exceed a deflection of 1/4-inch or the span divided by 240, whichever is less. For standard duty plank and safety grating, the loading to be used for determining stresses and deflections shall be the uniform live load of the adjacent floor or 100 psf, whichever is greater or a concentrated load of 1000 pounds. For heavy duty grating, the loading used for determining stresses and deflections shall be AASHTO HS-20. B. Material: 1. Except where indicated otherwise, bar grating shall be fabricated entirely of aluminum as follows: Bearing and banding bars, alloy 6061-T6; cross bars, alloy 6063-T5. • 2. Safety grating shall be fabricated of aluminum alloy 5052-H32. 3. Plank grating shall be fabricated of aluminum alloy 6063-T6. 4. Grating that may be partially or wholly submerged shall be fabricated entirely of stainless steel, Type 316. C. Standard-Duty Grating: 1. No single piece of grating shall weigh more than 80 pounds, unless indicated otherwise. Standard duty grating shall be serrated bar grating. 2. Cross bars shall be welded or mechanically locked tightly into position so that there is no movement allowed between bearing and cross bars. D. Safety Grating: 1. Safety grating shall be made of sheet metal punched into an open serrated diamond pattern and be formed into plank sections. The open diamond shapes shall be approximately 1-7/8 inch by 11/16-inch in size. Safety grating shall be Grip Strut by Metal Products Division, United States Gypsum Company; Deck Span by IKG Industries, or equal. E. Heavy-Duty Grating: Heavy-duty grating shall be welded steel, galvanized after fabrication. Cross bars shall be welded in position. F. Plank Grating: 1. Plank grating shall be extruded in 6-inch widths with a minimum of 6 integral 1-bar type bearing bars per plank. The top surface shall be solid with raised ribs, unless indicated otherwise. Where punched grating is required, the top surface shall be provided with a pattern of 3-inch by 19/32-inch rectangular openings spaced at 4 inches on center. The planks shall have continuous tongue and groove type interlock at each side; except that interlocking planks shall be arranged so that any 4-foot wide section may be removed independently from the other grating sections. 2. Plank grating shall be provided with a clear anodized finish, except that punched grating may have standard mill finish. MWH - 04082005 MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK 1530575— DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05500 -5 2.8 CHECKERED PLATE A. Checkered plate shall have a pattern of raised lugs on one face and shall be smooth on the opposite face. Lugs shall be a minimum of one-inch in length and raised a minimum of 1/2-inch above the surface. The lugs shall be located in a pattern in which the lugs are oriented at 90 degrees from the adjacent lugs in 2 orthogonal directions. The rows of lugs shall be oriented at 45 degrees from the edges of the plates. B. Where no plate material is indicated, aluminum shall be provided. Unless indicated otherwise, the minimum plate thickness shall be as required to limit deflection resulting from a live load of 100 psf to 1/4-inch or the span divided by 240, whichever is less. 2.9 HATCHES A. Where access hatches are mounted on a floor slab (including top slabs that are not covered with a roofing membrane) or on a concrete curb, the hatch shall be a flush type as indicated. B. Hatches shall be fabricated from aluminum 5086 H34, 6063-T5 or 6061-T6, unless otherwise indicated. Hatch hardware shall be Type 316 stainless steel. Hatches shall be gutter-type; Bilco Type "J" or "JD," Babcock-Davis Type B-FGA or equal. C. Hatches for Wet Well Access Room and Influent Splitter Box shall be entirely fabricated from stainless steel 316 and shall be air leak proof. Stainless steel railing type fall through protection system shall be provided for all access hatches in the Wet Well Access Room and Influent Splitter Box. Hatches shall be as manufactured by Syracuse Casting Sales Corporation or equal. D. The design live load shall be 300 psf, unless indicated otherwise. E. Hatch opening sizes, number and swing direction of door leaves, and locations, shall be as indicated. Sizes are for the clear opening. Where the number of leaves is not given, openings larger than 42 inches in either direction shall have double-leaf doors. Unless indicated otherwise, hinges shall be located on the longer dimension side. Unless indicated otherwise, ladder hatches shall be a minimum of 30 inches wide by 36 inches long, with the ladder centered on the shorter dimension, and the door hinge opposite the ladder. F. Door leaves shall be a minimum of 1/4-inch thick checkered pattern plate. Channel frames shall be a minimum of 1/4-inch material with an anchor flange around the perimeter. Hatches shall be provided with an automatic hold-open arm with release handle. Hatches shall be designed for easy opening from both inside and outside. G. Hatches shall be designed to be watertight and shall be equipped with a joint gutter and moat-type edge drain. A minimum 1-1/2 inch diameter drain connection shall be provided, located by the manufacturer. • H. Unless indicated otherwise, hatch nets shall be installed on floor hatches. Hatch nets shall conform to OSHA requirements and shall be Hatch Net 121, as manufactured by Safe Approach, Inc, Auburn, ME, or equal. Hatch Net is not required for Stainless Steel Floor Hatches in the Wet Well Access Room. 2.10 METAL DECKING A. Metal decking shall be of the size and gauge indicated and shall meet the requirements of the AISI specification for the "Design of Light Gauge, Cold-formed Steel Structural MWH -04082005 MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05500 - 6 Members." The steel shall be coated in accordance with the requirements of Section 09800 — Protective Coatings. 2.11 IRON CASTINGS A. Iron castings shall be of uniform quality, free from blowholes, porosity, hard spots, shrinkage, distortion, or other defects. They shall be smooth and well cleaned by shotblasting. B. Covers and grates shall fit together evenly, so that the cover fits flush with the surrounding finished surface and so that the cover does not rock or rattle when loading is applied. Round covers and frames shall have machined bearing surfaces. C. Covers and grates with matching frames shall be designed to support the following loadings: 1. Where located within a structure, the design loading shall match that required for the adjacent floor area, or, if no floor loading is given, a minimum of 300 pounds per square foot. 2. Exterior covers and grates shall be designed for AASHTO HS-20 loading unless indicated otherwise. 2.12 MANHOLE RUNGS A. See Section 02490 - Precast Concrete Manholes and Vaults. 2.13 FALL PREVENTION SYSTEM A. The fall protection system at each ladder shall include a carrier rung, ladder ring clamps, sleeves and full body harnesses, dismount section, and components as necessary for a complete system. The carrier rail shall be the same material as the ladder, except for fiberglass ladders, which shall have stainless steel carrier, rails, and shall be the length recommended by the manufacturer for the ladder dimensions, including extensions. • Include an extension for each ladder. The fall protection system shall be 2000 Climb Rite by Sellstrom Manufacturing Company, Saf-T-Climb by North Safety Products Ltd., or equal. 2.14 BOLTS AND ANCHORS A. Standard Service (Non-Corrosive Application): Except bolts for structural steel connections or unless otherwise indicated, bolts, rods, anchor bolts, washers, and nuts shall be stainless steel type 316 1. Structural connections: Anchor Bolts: ASTM A 307, Grade A or B, or ASTM A 36, hot-dip galvanized. 2. High strength bolts where indicated: ASTM A 325. 3. Pipe and equipment flange bolts: ASTM A 193, Grade B-7. B. All indoor or outdoor service locations: Bolts, nuts, and washers shall be stainless steel except for structural steel connections. C. Stainless steel bolts, nuts, anchor bolts, and washers shall be of Type 316 stainless steel, with bronze nuts, or cap screws (where screwed into stainless steel), of copper- MWH -04082005 MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05500 - 7 silicon alloy, conforming to ASTM B 98, alloy C 65100, designation H04, or alloy C 65500, designation H04. Wherever stainless steel bolts and nuts are indicated, it shall refer to the above material combination, unless specifically excluded. D. Bolt Requirements: 1. The bolt and nut material shall be free-cutting steel. 2. The nuts shall be capable of developing the full strength of the bolts. Threads shall be Coarse Thread Series conforming to the requirements of the American Standard for Screw Threads. Bolts and cap screws shall have hexagon heads and nuts shall be Heavy Hexagon Series. 3. Bolts and nuts shall be installed with washers fabricated of material matching the base material of bolts; except that hardened washers for high strength bolts shall conform to the requirements of the AISC Specification. Lock washers fabricated of material matching the bolts shall be installed where indicated. 4. The length of each bolt shall be such that the bolt extends at least 1/8-inch beyond the outside face of the nut before tightening, except for anchor bolts, which shall be flush with the face of the nut before tightening. E. Adhesive Anchors: Unless otherwise indicated, drilled concrete or masonry anchors shall be adhesive anchors. No substitutions will be considered unless accompanied with ICBO report verifying strength and material equivalency. 1. Epoxy adhesive anchors are required for drilled anchors for indoor installations, in submerged, wet, splash, overhead, and corrosive conditions, and for anchoring handrails and reinforcing bars. Epoxy shall comply with Section 03315 - Grout. All threaded rod shall be stainless steel Type 316. Epoxy anchors shall not be permitted in areas where the concrete temperature is in excess of 100 degrees F or higher than the limiting temperature recommended by the manufacturer, whichever is lower. Epoxy anchors shall not be used where anchors are subject to vibration or fire. Embedment depth shall be as the manufacturer recommends for the load to be supported. 2. Unless otherwise indicated, glass capsule, polyester resin adhesive anchors will be permitted in locations not included above and shall be Hilti HVA or Cobra Anchors. Threaded rod shall be stainless steel. F. Expanding-Type Anchors: Expanding-type anchors if indicated or permitted, shall be stainless steel expansion type ITW Ramset/Redhead "Trubolt" anchors; McCullock Industries "Kwick-Bolt;" or equal. Lead caulking anchors will not be permitted. Size shall be as indicated. Embedment depth shall be as the manufacturer recommends for the load to be supported. Expansion type anchors that are to be embedded in grout may be steel. Non-embedded buried or submerged anchors shall be stainless steel. G. Non-Shrink Grouted Anchors: Anchors, if indicated or permitted, shall be grouted with a non-shrink cementitious grout in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendation. Embedment depth shall be as the manufacturer recommends for the load to be supported. Non-shrink grout material shall be Class B or C in accordance with Section 03315 - Grout. H. Bolt Torque: Torque required to secure bolts shall be determined based on the application as follows: MWH -04082005 MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05500 - 8 1. General Purpose Joints: The turning effort required to secure bolt tensile stresses shall be in accordance with the requirements of Table 1.1: Table 1.1 —Turning effort to secure bolts for General Purpose Applications Recommended Torque Size Grade 5 Grade 8 18-8 SS 3/8 31 35 44 49 20 22 7/16 49 55 70 78 31 33 1/2 75 85 105 120 43 45 9/16 110 120 155 170 57 63 5/8 150 170 284 323 93 104 3/4 270 295 510 568 128 124 7/8 395 435 813 902 194 193 1 590 660 905 1030 287 289 2. Bolt for Structural Steel: Bolt installation for structural steel shall conform to the requirements of Section 05100 - Structural Steel Framing. 3. Adhesive Anchors: expanding type anchors, and non-shrink grouted anchors: Installation of adhesive anchors, expanding type anchors, and non-shrink grouted anchors shall conform to the manufacturer's recommendations. 4. Piping Flanged Joints: The turning effort required to secure bolt tensile stresses of 30,000 and 60,000 psi with different size alloy-steel bolts threaded in accordance with American Standard Screw Threads for High-strength Bolting B1.4 is given in the following Table 1.2. This table is based on tests conducted by Crane Company and represents results obtained with well-lubricated threads and bearing surfaces. They showed an increase of almost 100 percent in the torque required to secure a given bolt stress. Table 1.2 —Turning Effort to Tighten 8-pitch Thread bolts Nominal Number of Area at diameter threads root of Stress of bolt, per inch thread, 30,000 psi 60,000 psi inches square Torque, Force per Torque, Force inches ft-lbs bolt, ft-lbs per bolt, pounds pounds 1/2 13 0.126 30 3,780 60 7,500 5/8 11 0.202 60 . .6,060 120 12,120 3/4 10 0.302 100 9,060 200 18,120 7/8 9 0.419 160 12,570 320 25,140 1 8 0.551 245 16,350 490 33,060 1-1/8 8 0.728 355 21,840 710 43,680 1-1/4 8 0.929 500 27,870 1000 55,740 1-3/8 8 1.155 680 34,650 1360 69,300 1-1/2 8 1.405 800 42,150 1600 84,300 MWH -04082005 MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05500 -9 1-5/8 8 1.680 1100 50,400 2200 100,800 1-3/4 8 1.980 1500 59,400 3000 118,800 1-7/8 8 2.304 2000 69,120 4000 138,240 2 8 2.652 2200 79,560 4400 159,120 2-1/4 8 3.423 3180 102,690 6360 205,380 2-1/2 8 4.292 4400 128,760 8800 257,520 2-3/4 8 5.259 5920 157,770 11840 315,540 3 8 6.324 7720 189,720 15440 379,440 Note: The 8-pitch thread series refers to bolt diameters 1-inch and greater when 8 threads per inch are used. Basic thread dimensions throughout the 8-pitch series are the same as for the 1-inch diameter of the coarse-thread series. Coarse thread series is recommended for general purpose use; the 8-pitch thread series for high-strength bolting. 5. Machinery and Equipment Joints: Torque required to secure bolts used as part of manufactured machinery or equipment shall be in accordance with the equipment manufacturer recommendations. 2.15 POWDER-DRIVEN PINS A. Materials: Powder-driven pins for installation in concrete or steel shall be heat-treated steel alloy. If the pins are not inherently sufficiently corrosion-resistant for the conditions to which they will be exposed, they shall be protected in an acceptable manner. Pins shall have capped or threaded heads capable of transmitting the loads the shanks are required to support. Pins that are connected to steel shall have longitudinal serrations around the circumference of the shank. 2.16 IMPACT ANCHORS A. Impact anchors shall be an expansion type anchor in which a nail type pin is driven to produce the expansive force. The pin shall have a zinc sleeve with a mushroom style head and stainless steel nail pin. Anchors shall be Metal Hit Anchors, manufactured by Hilti, Inc., Rawl Zamac Nailin, manufactured by the Rawlplug Company; or equal. PART 3-- EXECUTION 3.1 FABRICATION AND INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS A. Fabrication and Erection: Except as otherwise indicated, the fabrication and erection of structural steel shall conform to the requirements of the American Institute of Steel Construction "Manual of Steel Construction." B. Steel Railings: Field welding of steel pipe handrail joints will be permitted only if approved by the ENGINEER, and then only in accordance with its instructions. C. Floor Hatches: Unless otherwise indicated, the CONTRACTOR shall provide a 1/2-inch drain line to the nearest floor drain for floor hatches. MWH - 04082005 MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05500 - 10 D. Powder-Driven Pins: Powder-driven pins shall be installed by a craftsperson certified by the manufacturer as being qualified to install the manufacturer's pins. Pins shall be driven in one initial movement by an instantaneous force that has been carefully selected to attain the required penetration. Driven pins shall conform to the following requirements where "D" = pin's shank diameter: Material Material Pin Shank Minimum Minimum Penetrated Minimum Penetration in Space From Pin by Pin Thickness Supporting Pin's CL to Spacing Material Edge of Penetrated Material Concrete 16D 6D minimum 14D 20D Steel 1/4-inch Steel thickness 4D 7D 3.2 WELDING A. Method: Welding shall be by the metal-arc method or gas-shielded arc method as described in the American Welding Society's "Welding Handbook" as supplemented by other pertinent standards of the AWS. Qualification of welders shall be in accordance with the AWS Standards governing same. B. Quality: In assembly and during welding, the component parts shall be adequately clamped, supported, and restrained to minimize distortion and for control of dimensions. Weld reinforcement shall be as indicated by the AWS Code. Upon completion of welding, weld splatter, flux, slag, and burrs left by attachments shall be removed. Welds shall be repaired to produce a workmanlike appearance, with uniform weld contours and dimensions. Sharp corners of material that is to be painted or coated shall be ground to a minimum of 1/32-inch on the flat. 3.3 GALVANIZING A. Structural steel plates shapes, bars, and fabricated assemblies required to be galvanized shall, after the steel has been thoroughly cleaned of rust and scale, be galvanized in accordance with the requirements of ASTM A 123. Any galvanized part that becomes warped during the galvanizing operation shall be straightened. Bolts, anchor bolts, nuts, and similar threaded fasteners, after being properly cleaned, shall be galvanized in accordance with the requirements of ASTM A 153. B. Field repairs to damaged galvanizing shall be made by preparing the surface and applying a coating. 1. Surface preparation shall consist of removing oil, grease, soil, and soluble material by cleaning with water and detergent (SSPC SP1) followed by brush off blast cleaning (SSPC SP7), over an area extending at least 4-inches into the undamaged area. 2. Coating shall be applied to at least 3-mils dry film thickness. Use Zinc-Clad XI by Sherwin-Williams, Galvax by Alvin Products, or Galvite by ZRC Worldwide. MWH - 04082005 MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05500 - 11 3.4 DRILLED ANCHORS A. Drilled anchors and reinforcing bars shall be installed in strict accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. Holes shall be roughened with a brush on a power drill, cleaned and dry. Drilled anchors shall not be installed until the concrete has reached the required 28-day compressive strength. Adhesive anchors shall not be loaded until the adhesive has reached its indicated strength in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. 3.5 FALL PREVENTION SYSTEM A. Fall prevention systems shall be provided on ladders used to ascend heights exceeding 20 feet. - END OF SECTION - MWH - 04082005 MISCELLANEOUS METALWORK 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05500 - 12 SECTION 05521 - ALUMINUM RAILINGS PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide aluminum railing work, complete and in place, in accordance with the Contract Documents. B. This Section does not include railings that are indicated under equipment specifications. 1.2 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Shop Drawings: Include railing layouts, post locations, and spacings, gate locations, removable railing sections, construction details, manufacturer's engineering data, installation instructions, and product data. C. Calculations: Engineering structural calculations for railings, handrail brackets, brackets, support flanges, and fasteners or anchors. D. Samples: Color samples. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 SYSTEM DESIGN AND STRUCTURAL PERFORMANCE OF RAILING COMPONENTS A. General: All railings and installation shall be in accordance with the manufacturer's published recommendations and specifications. B. Code Requirements: Railings, guardrails, and handrails shall conform to the code requirements for IBC - industrial-commercial, non-public use and the State-approved OSHA. Railings, guardrails, and handrails, when part of a means of egress as defined by the governing codes, shall conform to the requirements of the most stringent of the codes or reference standards. C. Loading Conditions: Railings and handrail brackets shall be designed in accordance with the requirements of Section 1607.7 of the IBC 2003. 2.2 MATERIALS A. Rail Section: Railings and handrails shall be round pipe design railing system unless otherwise indicated. B. Rail Material: Aluminum shall be U.S. Alloy 6061 or 6063, T-5 or T-6. Aluminum pipe rail shall be not less than 1-1/2 inch diameter, Schedule 40 pipe. C. Welding Rods: Aluminum welding rods shall be of type recommended by the aluminum manufacturer for anodized finished products. D. Isolation from Concrete: Electrolysis protective material shall be in accordance with Section 09800 - Protective Coating. MWH -04082005 ALUMINUM RAILINGS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05521-1 E. Sleeves: Sleeves shall be formed with PVC. Sleeves for removable posts shall be of steel, hot-dip galvanized after fabrication. Galvanizing of steel sleeves shall be done after fabrication to prevent raw steel from being exposed to the elements. F. Fasteners: Fasteners, screws, and bolts shall be concealed and shall be of stainless steel or aluminum. Handrail bracket fasteners and fasteners over water basins shall be of stainless steel. G. Brackets: Handrail brackets shall be aluminum with a finish that matches the handrail or railing of which they are a part. H. Kickplates: Kickplates shall be extruded (match railing system) aluminum of not less than 4 inches in height. Kickplates for picket railings shall be a special extrusion if a snap-in-centered type kickplate is not standard with the railing manufacturer. I. Grout: Non-shrink grout for handrail posts shall consist of an inorganic, non-metallic, premixed grout in accordance with Section 03315 - Grout with a minimum 28-day compressive strength of 4,000 psi. 2.3 FINISHES A. Pipe Railing System: Pipe railing system including handrails, railings, tube caps, and other miscellaneous parts of rails shall be provided with an Architectural Class I, 0.7-mil clear anodized finish, AA-M12. 2.4 SUB-ASSEMBLIES A. Height Requirements: Top of upper railing shall be 42 inches above the working surface. Kickplates shall be installed not more than 1/4-inch off the working surface and shall be provided where indicated and/or required by codes or Reference Standards. B. Guardrails: Guardrails shall be a 3-rail system with equal open spaces between rails (and kickplate when required) with no open space larger than 12 inches as required by IBC. 2.5 MANUFACTURERS, OR EQUAL A. Round Pipe Railings: 1. "C-V Pipe Rail" by CraneVeyor Corp. 2. "Wesrail" by Moultrie Manufacturing Co. B. Rectangular Tube and Square Picket Railings: 1. "Balustrade" (or Picket) by ATR Technologies, Inc. 2. "Railtec 400" vertical bar railing by CraneVeyor Corp. C. Round Tube and Round Picket Railings: 1. Oval-Tube Railing "1J" (with bottom fillers) by ATR Technologies, Inc. 2. "Baluster Railing", by CraneVeyor Corp. MWH —04082005 ALUMINUM RAILINGS 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05521-2 3. "Wesrail" by Moultrie Manufacturing Co. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 PRODUCT DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING A. Delivery of Materials: Manufactured materials shall be delivered in original, unbroken packages, containers, or bundles bearing the label of the manufacturer. B. Storage: All materials shall be carefully stored in a manner that will prevent damage and in an area that is protected from the elements. 3.2 COMPONENT SYSTEMS A. Unless otherwise indicated, aluminum handrails and railings shall be component systems, installed complete and ready for use with all anchors, attachments, balusters, brackets, caps, fasteners, gates, posts, sleeves, trim, and all other related items required or necessary for the complete installation. 3.3 CRAFTSMANSHIP A. All work shall be performed by craftsmen experienced in the fabrication of architectural metal work. Exposed surfaces shall be free from defects or other surface blemishes. Dimensions and conditions shall be verified in the field in advance. Joints, junctions, miters, and butting sections shall be precision-fitted, with no gaps occurring between sections, and all surfaces shall be flush and aligned and without sharp edges. 3.4 ALIGNMENT A. Extruded, case, molded, or bent work shall be straight with true edges. Railings and handrails shall be provided with continuous top rails, without post projections or other obstructions. 3.5 WELD FINISH A. All exposed welds shall be ground smooth and flush and shall be polished and anodized. Discoloration of exposed aluminum surfaces, whether or not due to welding, shall constitute a basis for rejection of the entire assembly. 3.6 EXPANSION/CONTRACTION A. Railings shall provide expansion joints in the railing at all expansion joints in the structure. In addition exterior railing systems shall provide for 1/4-inch expansion and contraction per 20-linear feet of railing, and interior railing systems shall provide for 1/4- inch expansion or contraction per 20-linear feet of railing. Expansion joints shall be carefully aligned and without sharp edges. 3.7 FASTENER FINISH A. Stainless steel fasteners shall be mill finish. 3.8 RAILING CONTINUITY AND END TREATMENT A. Handrails and railings shall be designed to form a continuous run system with elbow turns and bends that do not have interferences with hand movement. Handrails shall be MWH —04082005 ALUMINUM RAILINGS 1530575—DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05521-3 continuous for the full length of the stairs and landings. The handrails shall extend not less than 12-inches beyond the top and bottom risers. Whenever possible, the extension shall be at least 18-inches for the possible use by handicapped people. The ends of handrails shall be returned to wall or shall be terminated in newel posts or safety terminals. Newel posts and safety terminals may be used only when approved by the ENGINEER. 3.9 GATES AND REMOVABLE SECTIONS A. Gates shall be provided with self-closing hinges and self-closing latch bolts. Removable handrail sections shall be provided where indicated. The gate and removable railing hardware's color shall match that of the railing system of which it is a part. B. Aluminum items in contact with concrete or steel or embedded in concrete shall be provided with an electrolysis protective material. The protective material shall be applied to the aluminum surface that will be in contact with the dissimilar material. C. Handrail posts installed into sleeves shall be provided with weep holes between 1/2-inch and 1/4-inch above the finish deck for condensation drainage. - END OF SECTION - MWH -04082005 ALUMINUM RAILINGS 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 05521-4 SECTION 07410— PREFORMED METAL WALL PANELS 4 PART 1 -- GENERAL 4 1.1 SUMMARY A. The extent of the panel work is shown on the Drawings. Composite panels along with perimeter extrusions, clips, fasteners, gaskets and sealants if required. B. All engineering and manufacturing of the items listed below are to be supplied by a single manufacturer. Installer to be certified by the manufacturer. 1. Aluminum face and liner, composite factory formed wall panel units with integral reveals and integral joinery. 2. Extruded aluminum trim related to the wall system and its intersection with adjacent materials. 3. Sealants and gaskets between panels, adjoining louvers, translucent sandwich panel systems and their intersections. C. Panel fabricator/installer shall assume undivided responsibility for all components of the exterior panel system including, but no limited to attachment to sub-construction, panel to panel joinery, panel to dissimilar material joinery and joint seal associated with the panel system. 1.2 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Manufacturer and wall systems contractor shall have a minimum of ten years experience in successfully fabricating and or installing composite panels for projects using similar systems, applications and performance requirements. B. Wall systems contractor must be an authorized fabricator of the specified composite supplier and have a certification program acceptable to local code authorities. C. Manufacturer and wall systems contractor shall provide a list of five similar completed projects, in place for 10 years, with addresses of the location, architect and owner. 1.3 REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS, CODES, AND STANDARDS A. Codes 1. IBC 2003 International Building Code B. Commercial Standards 1. ASTM D1781-93 Climbing Drum Peel Test for Adhesives 2. ASTM E84 Surface Burning Characteristics of Building Materials . J MWH-04082005 PREFORMED METAL WALL PANELS 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07410- 1 3. ASTM E162 Surface Flammability of Materials Using a Radiant Heat Energy Source 4. ASTM E330 Structural Performance of Exterior Windows, Curtain Walls, and Doors Under the Influence of Wind Loads 5. ASTM E283 Rate of Leakage through Exterior Windows, Curtain Walls, and Doors 6. ASTM D3363 Method for Film Hardness by Pencil Test 7. ASTM D2794 Resistance of Organic Coatings to the Effects of Rapid Deformation (Impact) 8. ASTM D2247 Practice for Testing Water Resistance of Coatings in 100% Relative Humidity 9. ASTM 8117 Method of Salt Spray (Fog) Testing 10. ASTM D822 Practice for Operating Light and Water Exposure Apparatus (Carbon-Arc Type) for Testing Paint, Varnish, Lacquer, and Related Products 11. ASTM D1308 Effect of Household Chemicals on Clear and Pigmented Organic Finishes 12. ASCE 7-98 Minimum Design Loads for Buildings and Other Structures 13. ASTM C-297 Core Compressive Modulus 14. AAMA 2605 Paint Finish 1.4 SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. 1. No substitutions are to be made without going through the approval process. B. Two samples of each color or finish selected, to illustrate panel design, texture, color and other features specified. C. Product Data: Manufacturer's standard literature. D. Structural calculations, prepared and sealed by a structural engineer registered in the state of Oregon, showing the structural adequacy of the preformed metal wall panels and all connections to the building structure. 1. Show governing panel types and connections and types of fasteners to the building structure. MWH-04082005 PREFORMED METAL WALL PANELS 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07410-2 E. Shop drawings to show all elevations along with fasteners, details, and location of all joints, including interface of the panel system with adjoining construction. 1. Joint details shall provide a structurally sound panel system that allows no uncontrolled water penetration on the inside face of the panel system, as determined by ASTM E331. F. LEED Product Data 1. Credit MR 4: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. 2. Credit MR 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting manufacturing locations for products manufactured within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 3. MR Credit 5.2: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting location of extraction, recovery or harvest for materials contained in products addressed in item 2 above that originated within a 500-mile radius of the project. G. Submit test reports and certifications to demonstrate compliance with performance requirements and building code acceptance specified. H. Fabricator shall furnish test reports by an accredited testing laboratory. If not previously tested, fabricator must have system tested and furnish necessary reports before final approval of shop drawings. I. Submit erection procedures where required to clearly explain proper installation of fasteners, trim, gaskets and sealants. J. Evidence that the specified deflection limitations are met. K. Manufacturer and installer quality assurance qualifications. L. At Substantial Completion, submit certification of proper installation by Manufacturer. 1.5 PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS A. Structural Performance: Panels shall be designed for component and cladding wind loads determined in accordance with the more stringent of either the local building code, IBC 2003 or ASCE 7-98 for the parameters specified. . 1. Wind Loads: a. Basic Wind Speed: 100 MPH, 3 second gust b. Wind Importance Factor (I,,): 1.15 c. Exposure Category: C MWH-04082005 PREFORMED METAL WALL PANELS 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07410- 3 2. Seismic Loads: a. Seismic Use Group D b. Spectral Response Coefficient (SS): 1.06g c. Spectral Response Coefficient (Si): 0.37g d. Site Class: D e. Seismic Design Category: Ill f. Seismic Importance Factor (le): 1.25 3. Design preformed metal wall panel system and connections to maintain clearances at openings, to allow for fabrication and construction tolerances, to accommodate live load deflection, shrinkage and creep of primary building structure, and other building movements. 4. The wall system whall be designed to allow differential movement of the building roof and floor structures and shall be capable of performing within the following limitations: a. Normal to the plane of the wall: the maximum allowable deflecton of the panel perimeter shall be limited to L/175. The maximum allowable deflection of the panel stiffeners and the aluminum composite panel material shall be limited to L/60. Compliance to these deflection limitations shall be provided as part of the submittals. b. Provide allowances for vertical and horizontal movements due to thermal expansion and contraction. B. Panel material shall meet the following tests: 1. ASTM E84 Flame spread 0 smoke developed 0 2. ASTM E162 3. Factory Mutual Standard 4880 (1994) Room Fire Test. 4. Bond strength integrity. When tested in accordance with ASTM D-1781-93, simulating resistance to delamination, material shall demonstrate a result of at least 115Nmm/mm minimum or 22.4Ibs/in mina No other test may be substituted for this test. C. Panel flatness criteria: Maximum of 1/32-inch in any 2'-0" direction (non- accumulative). D. Fire Performance Characteristics: Wall panel system shall comply with requirements for finished panel performance as established by Section 1407 of the International MWH-04082005 PREFORMED METAL WALL PANELS 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07410 -4 Building Code (IBC) for use where non-load bearing, non-combustible wall construction is required. Laboratory and full scale testing including, but not limited to the following shall be available. 1. Finish panel system shall demonstrate compliance with the following criteria for surface burning characteristics per ASTM E-84. a. Flame spread — 0. b. Smoke Developed — 0. 1.6 WARRANTY A. The manufacturer shall warrant for a period of one year that the wall system materials will be free from defects. The wall systems contractor shall warrant for a period of one year that the installation workmanship will be free from defects. B. Finish warranties shall be the paint manufacturer's standard for wall panels and finished extrusions. For Kynar 500 or Hylar 5000 the warranty period is twenty (20) years against chalk, fade and delamination. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 MANUFACTURER/ MATERIALS: A. Alusuisse Composites: Alucabond composite material shall be constructed of two sheets of .51 mm aluminum face sheets with a thermoplastic core formed in a continuous process with no glues or adhesives between dissimilar materials. Total thickness of composite shall be 6mm. B. No or equal. 2.2 COMPOSITE WALL SYSTEM MATERIALS: A. Integrated Panels: Horizontal joint to be factory formed and pressure equalized. Vertical joint to have pre-formed returns as shown on the drawings with gasket and aluminum extrusion receptors and seal plates. B. Stiffeners: Structural sections shall be bonded to the rear face of the wall panels with silicone. Size and location are the manufacturer's responsibility to maintain flatness within the specified tolerances. C. Gaskets to be black, fire retardant EPSM or neoprene. D. Extrusion material: 6063, T-5 aluminum. Minimum thickness 1/16" for trim pieces and 3/32" for structural units. E. Air Infiltration Barrier: Refer to Section 07195—Air Barriers for requirements. MWH-04082005 PREFORMED METAL WALL PANELS 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07410 - 5 • 2.3 LEED REQUIREMENTS: A. The aluminum face and liner shall be manufactured from minimum 80% recycled aluminum. B. The panel fabricator shall be located within a 500 mile radius of the job site. 2.4 TRIM: A. The manufacturer shall furnish extruded trim. Installation shall be by the certified wall systems contractor, except for those that require completion of work by other trades. 2.5 FINISHES: A. Panel Finish: Exterior surfaces shall be coil coated Kynar 500 or Hylar 5000 PVDF with 75% fluorine content, consisting of 0.2 mil primer with 08. Mil top coat. Megaflons, lumiflons or bonflons not acceptable at exterior locations. Spray coated finishes acceptable only on perimeter extrusions. Manufacturer's standard stocked color as selected by the ENGINEER. B. No or equal panel finishes are allowed. C. Resin to be in conformance with the following tests; 1. ASTM D3363 2. ASTM D2794 3. ASTM D3359 4. ASTM D2247 5. ASTM 8117 2.6 PANEL FABRICATION A. Fabrication shall be done under controlled shop conditions when possible. Field fabrication only when necessary. Maximum deviation for panel flatness shall be 3mm in 2M, in any direction for assembled units. B. Fabricator shall provide a dry, route and return rainscreen system that includes complete perimeter extrusions along with guttered horizontal members. Design shall provide drainage to the exterior face of wall at every horizontal panel joint for any leakage of water occurring at the joints and/or condensation taking place within the construction. System shall not depend on caulking for water tightness. No continuous edge grip system is acceptable. System shall comply with the following tests; 1. Water Infiltration: There shall be no uncontrolled water penetration with ASTM E331-83 at a differential static pressure of 12 lbs. after fifteen minutes of testing. MWH-04082005 PREFORMED METAL WALL PANELS 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07410-6 2. Structural Performance: Shall be tested in accordance with ASTM E 330-84. At 150% of design pressure there shall be no permanent deformation exceeding L/100,for frame and L/60 for material. C. The wall panels shall be fabricated in accordance with the quality procedures established for the specified UL classifications, FM and building code approvals. D. Design Standard: KPS System "A" — P.E.R. 2.7 AUTHORIZED FABRICATORS: A. Authorized fabricators for this section are listed as follows. 1. Keith Panel Systems Co. Ltd. (604) 987-4499. 2. No or equal. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 EXAMINATION A. INSPECTION: 1. Manufacturer and fabricator shall jointly verify that members to receive panels are complete, accurately sized and located, in true plane, secure and otherwise properly prepared. 2. Prior to starting work, notify CONTRACTOR AND ENGINEER about any defects requiring correction 3. Do not start work until conditions are satisfactory. 4. All materials shall be inspected for damage and conformance to the specifications and shop drawings prior to installation. 3.2 PREPARATION A. FIELD MEASUREMENTS: 1. Verify prior to fabrication. 2. If field measurements differ from drawing dimensions, notify CONTRACTOR and ENGINEER prior to fabrication. B. PROTECTION: 1. Treat, or isolate with protective material, and contacting surfaces of dissimilar materials to prevent electrolytic corrosion. 2. Protect Work of other Trades against damage and discoloration. MWH-04082005 PREFORMED METAL WALL PANELS 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07410 - 7 3.3 INSTALLATION A. PANELS: 1. Follow wall panel fabricator's installation directions. 2. Install wall system, fasteners, trim and related items in accordance with the dimensions and procedures shown on the approved shop drawings. 3. Sealants and gaskets shall be installed where shown and in accordance with the approved shop drawings to assure air and water infiltration performance specified. 4. Paint, bituminous coating, or sealant as recommended by the manufacturer shall separate dissimilar materials. 5. Work shall be coordinated with other trades as required to insure proper flashing and seals to intersecting construction. B. ALLOWABLE ERECTION TOLERANCE: 1. Maximum Alignment Variation: 1/8 inch in 40 feet. 3.4 DAMAGED MATERIAL A. Damage caused by the manufacturer or wall systems contractor shall be replaced or repaired as to new construction. 3.5 CLEANING A. Remove debris from project site upon work completion, or sooner, if directed. B. Remove protective film from panels as soon as possible after installation. make sure weep holes are unobstructed. C. The CONTRACTOR shall be responsible for final cleaning of the wall system due to conditions that occur after wall systems contractor has completed an area. Cleaning is to be done in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. - END OF SECTION - MWH-04082005 PREFORMED METAL WALL PANELS 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07410 -8 SECTION 07412 — METAL ROOFING & SIDING • PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide preformed metal roofing, siding, soffits, trim, and accessories, complete and in place, in accordance with the Contract Documents. 1.2 REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS, CODES, AND STANDARDS A. All work specified herein shall conform to or exceed the requirements of the Building Code. B. Products and their installation shall be in accordance with the following standards, as applicable. 1. Manufacturer's printed recommendations and specifications. 2. Sheet Metal and Air Conditioning Contractors National Association "Architectural Sheet Metal Manual". 3. NAAMM, "Metal Finishes Handbook". 4. ASTM A792, "Steel Sheet, Aluminum-Zinc Alloy-Coated by the Hot-Dip Process". 5. Standards, publications and reports of the American Society for Testing and Materials (ASTM). 6. Underwriters Laboratories (UL). 1.3 METAL ROOFING & SIDING DESIGN CRITERIA A. The manufacturer shall provide an attachment schedule for the roof, siding and soffit panels with supporting calculations to resist the following loads: 1. Wind uplift loads as calculated using the 2003 Edition of the IBC. a. Basic Wind Speed: 100 MPH, 3 second gust b. Wind Importance Factor (1w): 1.15 c. Exposure Category: C 2. Drag Loading: The manufacturer shall provide an attachment schedule for the roof panels with supporting calculations to resist drag loads induced by a snow load of 25 psf. B. The manufacturer shall provide an attachment schedule for the roof panels with supporting calculations to resist the following loads: 1. Snow Loads: a. Ground Snow Load: 25 PSF MWH-04082005 METAL ROOFING AND SIDING 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07412-1 b. Snow Exposure Factor(Ce): 1.0 c. Snow Importance Factor (Is): 1.0 d. Thermal Factor (Ct): 1.1 1.4 PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS A. Testing and Certification — Roof Panels: 1. Wind uplift: UL 580 test, 24 gauge panels rated Class 90 when installed over minimum 14 gauge steel purlins spaced 5'0" on center maximum. The roof panel manufacturer must also subscribe to Underwriters Laboratories' "Follow Up Service" assuring continuing product compliance with UL requirements. 2. Air infiltration: Panel (without insulation) to meet the following standard when tested in accordance with ASTM E1680-95: a. With sidelap sealant - .003 CFM/sp. ft. at 2.86 PSF. 3. Water penetration: Panel to meet the following standard when tested in accordance with ASTM E331-70(75): a. With sidelap sealant - no leakage at 20 PSF. 1.5 SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Product Data: Submit manufacturer's technical product data, installation instructions and recommendations for each type of roofing and siding required. Include data substantiating that materials comply with requirements. Submit ICBO report for underlayment. C. Structural calculations, prepared and sealed by a structural engineer registered in the state of Oregon, showing the structural adequacy of the preformed metal roofing and siding panels and all connections to the building structure. 1. Show governing panel types and connections and types of fasteners to the building structure. D. Quality Assurance Information: Documentation of installer and manufacturer qualifications. E. Samples: Prior to ordering products, submit Manufacturer's standard color samples for ENGINEER's selections Prior to starting work, submit (three ) 12" long panel samples of each panel shape and a representative color chip for ENGINEER's acceptance. F. LEED Product Data: 1. Credit SS 7.2: Documentation from manufacturer for roofing materials indicating Energy Star compliance and indicating emmissivity of 0.9 when tested in accordance with ASTM 408. MWH-04082005 METAL ROOFING AND SIDING 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07412-2 2. Credit MR 4: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. 3. Credit MR 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting manufacturing locations for products manufactured within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 4. MR Credit 5.2: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting location of extraction, recovery or harvest for materials contained in products addressed in item 3 above that originated within a 500-mile radius of the project. G. Shop Drawings: 1. Submit complete shop drawings detailing all perimeter flashings and joints in accordance with the Manufacturer's standard recommendations. 2. Show panel layout, trim installation, and panel attachment to the building structure. 3. Describe all proposed details that deviate from what is shown on the plans. 4. Details must allow for expansion and contraction of panels. H. Attachment Schedule: Submit roof, siding and soffit attachment schedules and calculations. I. Warranty: Furnish duplicate signed copies of the specified roof and siding warranties. J. Affidavit: After installing the roofing, CONTRACTOR shall furnish a signed affidavit that the roof complies with the requirements of this Specification and the manufacturer's recommendations for the class and type of roof indicated. K. Factory Mutual Acceptance of Roofing: After installing the roofing, CONTRACTOR shall furnish a completed Factory Mutual Application for Acceptance of the Roofing System. 1.6 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. INSTALLER'S QUALIFICATIONS: 1. Installer must be approved by the roofing and siding manufacturer in writing prior to work commencing. 2. Installer shall meet the following: a. Successfully applied five metal roofs and siding of comparable size and complexity which reflects a quality weathertight installation. b. Have been in business for a minimum period of five years in the region where the work will be performed. B. MANUFACTURER'S QUALIFICATIONS: 1. Manufacturer shall have a minimum of 10 years experience supplying metal roofing and siding to the region where the work is to be done. MWH-04082005 METAL ROOFING AND SIDING 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07412-3 2. Comply with current independent testing and certification as specified. 3. Manufacturer shall provide proof of$2,000,000 liability insurance for their metal roof system and comply with current independent testing and certification as specified. 4. The roof panel manufacturer shall subscribe to Underwriters Laboratories' "Follow Up Service" assuring continuing product compliance with UL requirements. Shipment packaging of panels and attachment clips must bear UL classification markings. 5. Panel Manufacturers without full supporting literature; Flashings & Details Guides, Guide Specifications and Technical Support, shall not be considered equal to the specified product. C. REGULATORY AGENCY REQUIREMENTS: 1. Comply with IBC and local Building Code requirements if more restrictive than those specified herein. 1.7 PRODUCT DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING A. Protect against damage and discoloration B. Handle panels with non-marring slings. C. Do not bend panels. D. Store panels above ground, with one end elevated for drainage. E. Protect panels against standing water and condensation between adjacent surfaces. F. If panels become wet, immediately separate sheets, wipe dry with clean cloth, and allow to air dry. G. Painted panels shall be shipped with a protective plastic sheeting or a strippable film coating between all panels. Remove any strippable film coating prior to installation and in any case, do not allow the strippable film coating to remain on the panels in extreme heat, cold, or direct sunlight or other UV source. 1.8 PROJECT CONDITIONS A. Examine the conditions and substrates in which metal roofing work is to be installed. Substrate shall be installed level, flat and true to avoid panel stresses and distortion. B. Field measurements shall be taken prior to fabrication of panels. C. Proceed with roofing installation only after satisfactory conditions are met. 1.9 WARRANTY A. MANUFACTURER'S PRODUCT WARRANTY: 1. Manufacturer's standard coating performance warranty, as available for specified installation and environmental conditions. a. 20 year warranty for DuraTech® 5000 coated steel panels. MWH-04082005 METAL ROOFING AND SIDING 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07412-4 • a.i B. CONTRACTOR'S WARRANTY: 1. Warrant panels, flashings, sealants, fasteners and accessories against defective materials and/or workmanship, to remain watertight and weatherproof with normal usage for two (2) years following Substantial Completion. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 ACCEPTABLE MANUFACTURER • A. ASC Profiles Inc., Tacoma: 2141 Milwaukee Way, Tacoma, Washington 98421, telephone: 253-383-4955. B. No or equal. 2.2 ROOF PANEL DESIGNATION A. Design Span®- 17" panel width. Provide at typical sloped roof locations. B. Select Seam® Narrow Batten Curved — 16" panel width. Provide at curved roof location. 2.3 SIDING & SOFFIT PANEL DESIGNATION A. NU-WAVE ® CORRUGATED — Net coverage 34-2/3" (wall), rib depth 7/8" @ 2-2/3" o.c. for use at typical metal siding locations. B. Provide Factory Curved NU-WAVE ®CORRUGATED panels at soffit of curved roof. 2.4 LEEDT"" REQUIREMENTS A. Metal roofing and siding supplied for this project must be manufactured in 500 mile radius of the project site. B. Metal roofing and siding panels must contain a 20% minimum weighted average recycle content. C. Metal roofing must be ENERGY STAR® compliant (highly reflective) AND have emissivity of at least 0.9 when tested in accordance with ASTM 408. D. Metal roof panel initial IR reflectivity: 25% or higher. E. Metal roof panel IR reflectivity after 3 year exposure: 15% or higher. 2.5 MATERIALS A. PANELS: 1. Base Metal: a. Material: Steel conforming to: 1) ASTM A792 minimum yield 40,000 psi, thickness 24 gauge. b. Protective Coatings: MWH-04082005 METAL ROOFING AND SIDING 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07412-5 1) Conform to ASTM A792, AZ50 (Zincalume®). 2. Exterior Finish: a. DuraTech® 5000 (polyvihylidine Fluoride), full 70% Kynar® 500/Hylar 5000® consisting of a baked-on 0.2 mil corrosion resistant primer and a baked-on 0.8 mil finish coat for a total of 1.0 mil dry film thickness, with a specular gloss of 10-15% when tested in accordance with ASTM D-523-89 at 60°. 3. Interior Finish: a. Primer Coat Material: Corrosion-resistant primer; primer coat dry film thickness: 0.15 mils; finish coat material: polyester paint, finish coat dry film thickness: 0.35 mils. • b. Total Interior Dry Film Thickness: 0.50 mils. c. Roof Panel Color: Off-White. d. Wall Panel Color: Light Gray. 4. Exterior Panel Color: a. Design Span® Roof Panels: Color as selected by ENGINEER from manufacturer's premium color palette with special additive to qualify as an energy saving roof color. Design standard: AEP Span "Cool Jade Green". b. Select Seam® Roof Panels: Color as selected by ENGINEER from manufacturer's standard color palette. c. Siding and Soffit Panels: Color as selected by ENGINEER from manufacturer's standard color palette. 5. Factory-Applied Seam Sealant: a. Cold-applied, non-skinning, ACRYL-R®. 6. Panel Configuration: a. Design Span® Roof Panels: Integral self-locking standing seams spaced 17" on center. b. Select Seam® Roof Panels: Snap-on batten clip (24" o.c.) with continuous snap-on batten caps 3/8" W x 1"H. c. Provide factory panel striations to conceal oil canning for-Select Seam® and • Design Span® Roof Panels. d. NU-WAVE ® CORRUGATED Roof, Siding & Soffit Panels: Thru fastener wall panel with 7/8" deep corrugations. MWH-04082005 METAL ROOFING AND SIDING 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07412-6 B. ACCESSORIES: 1. Fastener Clip: a. Design Span®: L 90 assembly rated 18 gauge G-90 Galvanized steel, 40 ksi yield strength, 3-1/2" long triple fastener type. b. Select Seam®: UL 90 assembly rated clip: 24 gauge coated with minimum AZ- 50 Zinc-Aluminum coating per ASTM A792. 2. Fasteners: a. Per manufacturer's recommendation including attachment schedule. b. Self-sealing screws at NU-WAVE ® CORRUGATED panels. 3. Sealant: a. Gunnable Grade Caulking: Single component polyurethane caulk. b. Tape sealant: Butyl 4. Bearing Plate: a. 22 gauge 4"x6"Zincalume® coated steel bearing plate. 5. Ridge and hip covers: Formed sheet metal in longest possible lengths. 6. Rain gutters: Formed sheet metal to configuration shown. Provide expansion joints at locations shown on the Drawings. 7. Profile Closures: Use neoprene or polyethylene foam, die cut or formed to panel configuration. 8. All accessories shall match panel color. 9. Use manufacturer's standard trim pieces at all panel types. 10. Bird screen for soffit ventilation. C. FLASHING: 1. Material, gauge and finish to match panels. Do not use lead or copper. Remove any strippable film prior to installation. D. UNDERLAYMENT: 1. Design Span®: 30# building felt, as specified in Section 07600. 2. Select Seam® roofing and NU-WAVE ® CORRUGATED siding: Peel and stick ice and water shield. a. Install in accordance with manufacturer's instructions. b. Self-adhered rubberized asphalt sheet waterproofing underlayment, MWH-04082005 METAL ROOFING AND SIDING 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07412-7 c. Minimum thickness: 40 mil d. Minimum Membrane Elongation: 250% by ASTM D412. e. Acceptable Underlayments: 1) Grace Ice &Water Shield® manufactured by W.R. Grace & Co. 2) No or equal. E. VAPOR RETARDER: 1. Refer to Section 07210 - Building Insulation for vapor retarder requirements. F. PANEL FABRICATION: 1. Unless otherwise shown on drawings or specified herein, fabricate panels in continuous one-piece lengths and fabricate flashings and accessories in longest practical lengths. 2. Panels shall be factory formed. Field formed panels are not acceptable. 3. Panels shall be factory correctively-leveled. 4. Select Seam® roofing panels and/or battens shall be field curved, as required, to dimensions shown on drawings and verified in the field. 5. NU-WAVE ® CORRUGATED panels shall be factory curved, as required, to dimensions shown on drawings and verified in the field. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 EXAMINATION A. EXISTING CONDITIONS: 1. Verify that members to receive panels are complete, accurately sized and located, in true plane, secure and otherwise properly prepared. 2. Inspect installed work of other trades and verify that such work is complete to a point where this work may continue. 3. Verify that installation may be made in accordance with approved shop drawings and manufacturer's instructions. 4. Prior to starting work, notify General Contractor about any defects requiring correction. 5. Do not start work until conditions are satisfactory. 3.2 PREPARATION A. FIELD MEASUREMENTS: 1. Verify prior to fabrication and installation. MWH-04082005 METAL ROOFING AND SIDING 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07412-8 2. If field measurements differ from drawing dimensions, notify ENGINEER prior to fabrication. B. PROTECTION: ( 1. Treat, or isolate with protective material, and contacting surfaces of dissimilar materials to prevent electrolytic corrosion. 2. Require workmen who will be walking on roofing panels to wear clean, soft-soled work shoes that will not pick up stones or other abrasive material which could cause damage or discoloration. 3. Protect Work of other trades against damage and discoloration. C. SURFACE PREPARATION: 1. Clean and dry surfaces prior to applying sealant. 3.3 INSTALLATION A. UNDERLAYMENT: 1. Provide underlayment beneath all roof panels, unless indicated otherwise. B. PANELS: 1. Install per approved submittal drawings only. 2. Follow roof panel manufacturer's directions. 3. Install panel seams vertically. 4. Lap panels away from prevailing wind direction. 5. Do not stretch or compress panel side-lap interlocks. 6. Secure panels without warp or deflection. 7. Fully engage interlocking seams and battens. 8. Remove strippable protective film, if used, immediately preceding panel installation. C. ALLOWABLE ERECTION TOLERANCE: 1. Maximum Alignment Variation: 1/4 inch in 40 feet. D. FLASHING: 1. Follow Manufacturer's directions and ENGINEER'S approved Shop Drawings. 2. Install fleshings to allow for thermal movement. 3. Remove strippable protective film, if used, immediately preceding flashing 4. Provide flashing at all pipes and penetrations through roof. MWH-04082005 METAL ROOFING AND SIDING 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07412-9 5. Provide flashing at vertical surfaces adjoining the roof. 6. Where flashing is not detailed, do work equal to that shown in the SMACNA Architectural Sheet Metal manual to obtain a weathertight and watertight installation. 7. Overlap flashing at least 6 inches. E. CUTTING AND FITTING: 1. Neat, square and true. Torch cutting is prohibited. 2. Openings 6 inches and larger in any direction: Shop fabricate and reinforce to maintain original load capacity. 3. Openings less than 6 inches in largest dimension: Field cut as required. 4. Debur cut edge where necessary to saw-cut panels. 3.4 CLEAN UP AND CLOSE OUT A. PANEL DAMAGE AND FINISH SCRATCHES: 1. Do not apply touch-up paint to damaged paint areas that involve minor scratches. 2. Panels or flashings that have severe paint and/or substrate damage shall be replaced as directed by the ENGINEER. B. CLEANING AND REPAIRING: 1. At completion of each day's work and at work completion, sweep Panels, Flashings and Gutters clean. Do not allow fasteners, cuttings, filings or scraps to accumulate. 2. Remove debris from project site upon work completion or sooner, if directed. 3. Recycle panel debris. - END OF SECTION - MWH-04082005 METAL ROOFING AND SIDING 1530575 - DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 07412-10 ' SECTION 08110 - STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 THE REQUIREMENT A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide steel doors, frames, and related items, complete and operable, in accordance with the Contract Documents. 1.2 REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS, CODES, AND STANDARDS A. Commercial Standards ASTM A 366 Steel, Carbon, Cold-Rolled Sheet, Commercial Quality ASTM A 653 Steel Sheet, Zinc-Coated (Galvanized) or Zinc-Iron Alloy-Coated (Galvannealed) by the Hot-Dip Process ASTM B 117 Standard Practice for Operating Salt Spray (Fog) Apparatus ASTM D 1735 Standard Practice for Testing Water Resistance of Coatings Using Water Fog Apparatus ASTM E 90 Standard Test Method for Laboratory Measurement of Airborne Sound Transmission Loss of Building Partitions and Elements ANSI A115 Series Door and Frame Preparation NFPA 80 National Fire Protection Association Standard for Fire Doors and Windows UL Underwriters' Laboratories, Inc. B. Trade Standards 1. National Association of Architectural Metal Manufacturers (NAAMM). a. Hollow Metal Manufacturer's Association (HMMA). 2. Steel Door Institute (SDI) b. All SDI publications. C. Manufacturers' Standards: In addition to the standards listed above, steel doors and frames and installation shall be in accordance with the manufacturer's published recommendations and specifications. 1.3 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Manufacturer Qualifications: Manufacturer must be current member of SDI and NAAMM (HMMA). MWH-04082005 STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08110-1 1.4 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Product technical data: 1. Acknowledgement that products submitted meet requirements of standards referenced. 2. Manufacturer's installation instructions. C. Shop Drawings: 1. Show details of the products and systems and connections to adjoining materials. 2. Schedule of doors and frames, using same reference numbers as used on drawings, showing sizes, types, and locations of door louvers and glass and manufacturer's installation instructions. 3. SDI certification. 4. UL certification. D. Structural calculations, prepared and sealed by a structural engineer registered in the state of Oregon, showing the structural adequacy of the frame anchors and all connections to the building structure. E. Sound Doors and Frames: Shop Drawings, manufacturer's literature, installation recommendations, and certification of Sound Transmission Class (STC) rating shall be submitted for sound door and frame assemblies. F. LEED Product Data: 1. Credit MR 4: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. 2. Credit MR 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting manufacturing locations for products manufactured within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 3. Credit MR 5.2: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting location of extraction, recovery or harvest for materials contained in products addressed in item 2 above that originated within a 500-mile radius of the project. 1.5 PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS A. Structural Performance: Frame anchors shall be designed for loads determined in accordance with the more stringent of either the local building code or IBC 2003 1. Wind Loads: a. Basic Wind Speed: 100 MPH, 3 second gust b. Wind Importance Factor (l w): 1.15 MWH-04082005 STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08110-2 c. Exposure Category: C 2. Seismic Loads: a. Seismic Use Group D b. Spectral Response Coefficient (Sc): 1.06g c. Spectral Response Coefficient (S1): 0.37g d. Site Class: D e. Seismic Design Category: Ill f. Seismic Importance Factor (le): 1.25 3. Design frame anchors and connections to maintain clearances at openings, to allow for fabrication and construction tolerances, to accommodate live load deflection, shrinkage and creep of primary building structure, and other building movements. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 MANUFACTURERS, or equal A. Subject to compliance with the Contract Documents, the following manufacturers are acceptable. 1. Benson Industries 2. Krieger Specialty Products Company 3. Curries Company B. Other manufacturers may submit for approval of doors and frames which comply with LEED requirements. 2.2 LEEDTM REQUIREMENTS: A. Steel frames supplied for this project must be manufactured in 500 mile radius of the project site. B. Doors and frames must contain a 20% minimum weighted average recycle content. 2.3 MATERIALS AND FABRICATION - GENERAL A. General: 1. Fabricate rigid, neat in appearance and free from defects. 2. Form to sizes and profiles indicated on drawings. 3. Shop Fabrication and Assembly: Steel doors and frames shall be shop fabricated and shop assembled, where possible. Temporary stiffeners, spacers, and other accessories necessary to facilitate handling and accurate erection shall be provided. MWH-04082005 STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08110-3 After fabrication, tool marks and other surface imperfections shall be filled and ground smooth. 4. Weld all joints continuously, dress exposed joints smooth and flush. • 5. Fabricate doors and frames to tolerance requirements of SDI-117. 6. Fit doors to SDI and NFPA 80 clearances. B. Materials for Doors and Frames: 1. Exterior doors and frames: a. Fabricated entirely of steel galvanized to G60 in ASTM A 653. b. SDI Grade III, Model 4, seamless, insulated minimum R10. 2. Other doors and frames, unless otherwise indicated: a. Fabricated from prime quality, commercial grade, cold-rolled steel conforming to ASTM A 366, Type II or III. C. Clean off mill scale and foreign materials, repair damaged galvanized surfaces per ASTM A780. D. Cleaning and Priming: Doors, frames, and seal retainers shall be thoroughly cleaned, phosphatized, and factory primed with rust-inhibitive primer. The primer shall be compatible with the finish coating in Section 09800 - Protective Coating or Section 09900 - Architectural Paint Finishes, as applicable. Prime coat shall be capable of passing a 120-hour salt spray test in accordance with ASTM B 117 and a 250-hour humidity test in accordance with ASTM D 1735. E. Finish Hardware: Doors and frames shall be reinforced and drilled or tapped for fully templated mortised hardware; and shall be reinforced with plates for surface-mounted hardware, meeting ANSI A115 Series requirements. Locate hardware in accordance with SDI. Hardware shall be as indicated in Section 08710 - Finish Hardware and as indicated. F. Grout: As specified in Section 03315 - Grout. 2.4 HOLLOW METAL FRAMES A. Frames for doors, windows, and other openings shall be minimum 16-gage galvanized steel boxes welded to frame at back of all hardware cutouts. Steel plate reinforcement welded to frame for hinge, strikes, closers and surface mounted hardware reinforcing. Special frames, oversized frames, and frames with transom shall be provided where indicated. All plate reinforcement shall meet size and thickness requirements of SDI. Split type frames not acceptable. Conceal all fasteners. B. Frame Jamb Depths, Trim Profile, Stops, and Backbends: Frame jamb depths, trim profile, stops, and backbends shall be as indicated. C. Windows: Window frames shall be provided complete with anchors and metal stops for glazing. Stops shall be miter-cut and dipped for countersunk flathead fasteners. MWH-04082005 STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08110-4 2.5 FRAME ANCHORS A. Floor Anchors: Floor anchors shall be welded inside each frame jamb head, and holes • shall be provided for floor anchorage. Minimum thickness of floor anchors shall be 14- gage. B. Anchors for Masonry/Concrete Installations: Frames for installation in masonry and concrete walls shall be provided with adjustable jamb anchors of the T-strap, stirrups and strap, or wire type. The number of anchors provided per frame jamb and head shall be as follows: 1. Frames up to 7 feet 6 inches in height: 3 anchors. 2. Frames over 7 feet 6 inches to 8 feet 0 inches in height: 4 anchors. 3. Frames over 8 feet 0 inches in height: One anchor for each 2 feet 0 inches or fraction in height. 4. Frame head anchors shall be not less than those required by the Reference Standards. C. Anchors for Stud Wall Installation: Frames for installation in stud partitions shall be provided with steel anchors of suitable design for job conditions. They shall be not less than 18-gage thickness; and shall be securely welded inside each jamb and head as follows: 1. Frames up to 7 feet 6 inches in height: 3 anchors. 2. Frames over 7 feet 6 inches to 8 feet 0 inches in height: 5 anchors. 3. Frames over 8 feet 0 inches in height: 5 anchors plus one additional for each 2 feet 0 inches or fraction over 8 feet 0 inches. 4. Frame head anchors shall be not less than those required by the Reference Standards. 2.6 DUST COVER BOXES AND MORTAR GUARDS A. Dust cover boxes or mortar guards of not less than 24-gage steel shall be provided at all hardware mortises on frames to be set in masonry, concrete, or plaster walls. 2.7 SILENCER HOLES A. Appropriate holes for silencers shall be provided in the door frames which are not designated to receive weatherstripping, seals, or sound seals. 2.8 STEEL DOORS A. Design and Construction: Steel doors shall be of hollow metal construction and shall be full flush design with no visible seams. 1. Face sheets shall be not less than cold-rolled, stretcher-leveled, 16-gage steel. Doors shall have flush seamless face sheets with continuously and fully welded seam edges. Doors shall be rigid and neat in appearance, and shall be free from warpage or buckle. Corner bends shall be true and straight and shall be of not less MWH-04082005 STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08110-5 than the minimum radius for the gage of metal used. The door top and bottom shall be internally reinforced by steel members welded in place. Tops of exterior doors shall be provided with flush, water- and weather-tight top enclosures. } 2. 1-3/4 inch thick. B. Door Cores: Door cores shall be water-resistant urethane with minimum R of 10. C. Double Doors: Double doors shall be provided with a "T" type steel astragal unless otherwise indicated in Section 08710 - Finish Hardware. 2.9 ACOUSTICAL DOOR ASSEMBLIES A. Door and Frame Assemblies: Acoustical doors and frames shall be complete, factory- built, and laboratory-tested assemblies, complete with perimeter compression sound seals, cam lift hinges, threshold and automatic, door-bottom seals. B. STC Rating: Sound door assemblies shall have a minimum STC rating of 52 dB. The CONTRACTOR shall provide a written certification by the door manufacturer stating that the STC rating is in accordance with ASTM E 90 as conducted by a qualified acoustical products testing laboratory. C. Door Construction: Doors shall be formed of 16-gage steel face sheets jointed by welding along the vertical edges. Door tops and bottoms shall be reinforced and completely closed with die-formed, 16-gage steel channels welded in place. The core shall be an incombustible, noncoupling filler. D. Frame Construction: Frames shall be fabricated from 14-gage steel with the corners mitered, welded, and ground smooth. Strike, hinge, and other hardware reinforcement shall be of not less than 3/16-inch thick steel. The frame shall be provided with welded floor anchors at each jamb, and with a minimum of 3 wall anchors per jamb. E. Perimeter Seals: Perimeter seals shall be made of sturdy vinyl with a magnetic tape insert. The hinge side shall be constructed so as to avoid pinching or other distortion of the seal from opening and closing of the door. F. Automatic Door Bottoms: Automatic door bottoms shall close the entire gap between the door and the floor. The seal shall be 50-60 durometer neoprene, and the actuating mechanism shall compress or retract the seal properly when the outer face of the door is within 2-inches of the strike jamb. G. View Window Kit: View windows shall be double-glazed with 2 panes of 1/4-inch clear, laminated glass unless indicated otherwise. PART 3-- EXECUTION 3.1 DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING A. Doors and frames shall be shipped and stored with temporary stiffeners and spacers in place to prevent distortion. B. Doors and frames shall be delivered in original, unbroken packages, containers, or bundles bearing the name of the manufacturer. MWH-04082005 STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08110-6 C. Doors and frames shall be carefully stored on wood blocking in an area that is protected from the elements, in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations. Storage shall be in a manner that will prevent damage or marring of finish. 3.2 CONSTRUCTION A. General: WORK shall be in accordance with manufacturer's published recommendations and specifications. B. WORK shall be coordinated with appropriate related subcontractors work to assure a proper installation. Field conditions and dimensions shall be verified prior to fabrication. C. Install doors and frames in accordance with SDI and manufacturer's instructions. 3.3 FRAME INSTALLATION A. Frames shall be set plumb and square in a true plane, and be securely anchored to the adjoining construction. Steel shims shall be provided, set tight and rigidly attached between frame anchors and structure. Finished metal frames shall be strong and rigid; neat in appearance; and square, true, and free from defects, warp, or buckle. B. Molded members, trims, and stops, shall be clean cut, straight, and shall be of a uniform profile throughout their lengths. C. Corner joints shall have contact edges tightly closed with all trim faces mitered, welded, and finished smooth. The use of gussets will not be permitted. D. Grout fill all door frames. E. For floor anchors, provide two adjustable 3 inch wide flanged floor clips punched for anchoring. F. Number and location of anchors shall be in accordance with frame manufacturer's recommendation, with minimum of three anchors per jamb. 3.4 DOOR INSTALLATION A. Doors shall be installed plumb, square, and level. Doors shall operate freely, but not loosely. They shall be free from rattling while in a closed position. B. Door clearances shall be plus 3/32-inch or minus 1/32-inch and shall not exceed the limits in the manufacturer's printed recommendations. C. Any door that becomes warped more than 3/16-inch out-of-plane shall be replaced by the CONTRACTOR. D. Doors and finish hardware shall be removed and rehung prior to painting. E. Hollow metal doors projecting beyond frame when door is closed will be rejected. 3.5 FINISH HARDWARE A. Finish hardware shall be installed in accordance with hardware manufacturer's standard } templates and printed instructions. Operable parts shall be adjusted for correct function and operation. MWH-04082005 STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08110-7 3.6 PROTECTION ti .0 A. Protect doors and frames during construction. - END OF SECTION f MWH-04082005 STEEL DOORS AND FRAMES 1530575-DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08110-8 SECTION 08950 — TRANSLUCENT SANDWICH PANEL SYSTEMS PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. Work of this section includes all labor and materials required to install the translucent insulated sandwich panel systems, aluminum framing and fleshings, coatings of the aluminum components, and the structural and watertight design of the assembly. B. Provide translucent removable skylight units and translucent windows as shown in the Drawings. 1.2 REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS, CODES, AND STANDARDS A. Commercial Standards 1. ICBO International Conference of Building Officials 2. UL 723 Flame Spread and Smoke Developed 3. UL 972 Impact Strength 4. ASTM C-297 Bond Tensile Strength (after aging by ASTM D1037) 5. ASTM D-635 Burn Extent 6. ASTM D-1002 Bond Shear Strength 7. ASTM D-2244 Color Difference 8. ASTM D-4060 Abrasion/Erosion Resistance 9. ASTM E-72 Beam Bending Strength 10. NFRC 100 Insulation "U" Factor B. Trade Standards 1. NFRC System Certification C. Manufacturers' Standards: In addition to the standards listed above, the panels, caulking materials, and their installation, shall be in accordance with the manufacturer's published recommendations and specifications. 1.3 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Translucent panel system must be listed by International Conference of Building Officials as a sandwich panel construction. B. Quality control inspections and testing conducted at least once each year are to include manufacturing facilities, sandwich panel components and production sandwich panels for conformance with "Acceptance Criteria for Sandwich Panels" as regulated by the International Building Code. MWH -04082005 TRANSLUCENT SANDWICH PANEL SYSTEMS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08950 - 1 C. Provide materials and products manufactured by a company continuously and regularly employed in the manufacture of translucent panel systems for a period of at least fifteen (15) consecutive years and which can show evidence of the specified materials being `' satisfactorily used on at least six (6) projects of similar size and scope. At least three (3) of the projects must have been in successful use for ten (10) years or longer. D. Erection is to be performed by an installer who has been in the business of erecting insulated translucent sandwich panel systems for at least five (5) years installing this manufacturer's product, and who can show evidence of satisfactory completion of 3 projects of similar size and scope. E. Interior face sheets to be listed by Underwriters Laboratory (UL). 1.4 SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Submit structural calculations, sealed by a structural engineer registered in the state of Oregon, showing the structural adequacy of the translucent panel system and all connections to the building structure. C. Submit shop drawings showing in detail all system components, connections to the building, interface with other materials and methods of construction. Shop drawings must be prepared under the supervision of and be sealed by the engineer who provides the calculations. D. Submit certified test reports made by an independent testing organization for each type and class of panel system. Reports are to verify that the material will meet all • performance requirements of this specification. Previously completed test reports will be acceptable if current and indicative of products used on this project. L 1. Flame Spread and Smoke Developed (UL 723)— Submit UL card 2. Burn Extent (ASTM D-635) 3. Color Difference (ASTM D-2244) 4. Abrasion/Erosion Resistance (ASTM D-4060) 5. Impact Strength (UL 972) 6. Bond Tensile Strength (ASTM C-297 after aging by ASTM D1037) 7. Bond Shear Strength (ASTM D-1002) 8. Beam Bending Strength (ASTM E-72) 9. Insulation "U" Factor (NFRC 100) 10. NFRC System Certification E. Submit ICBO Listing as a Sandwich Panel: certified proof of regular, independent quality ll control monitoring under a building code review and listing program. F. Submit maintenance manuals for the panel systems with a sequence of items, materials and methods used for proper cleaning and maintenance. MWH - 04082005 TRANSLUCENT SANDWICH PANEL SYSTEMS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08950 -2 G. LEED Product Requirements: 1. SS Credit 8: Documentation from manufacturer of the light pollution reduction ;.# obtained by use of translucent fiberglass panels. 2. MR Credit 4.2: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. 3. MR Credit 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting locations for products fabricated within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 1.5 PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS A. Structural Performance: Provide translucent panels and connections capable or withstanding the following design loads within limits and conditions indicated. 1. Wind Loads: a. Basic Wind Speed: 100 MPH, 3 second gust b. Wind Importance Factor (IW): 1.15 c. Exposure Category: C 2. Snow Loads: a. Ground Snow Load: 25 PSF b. Snow Exposure Factor (Ce): 1.0 c. Snow Importance Factor (la): 1.0 d. Thermal Factor (Ct): 1.1 3. Seismic Loads: a. Seismic Use Group D b. Spectral Response Coefficient (Se): 1.06g c. Spectral Response Coefficient (Si): 0.37g d. Site Class: D e. Seismic Design Category: Ill f. Seismic Importance Factor (le): 1.25 4. Attachment of translucent panels to the building structure shall be designed for wind, seismic and snow loads determined in accordance with the more stringent of either the local building code or IBC 2003. 5. Design framing system and connections to maintain clearances at openings, to allow for fabrication and construction tolerances, to accommodate live load MWH - 04082005 TRANSLUCENT SANDWICH PANEL SYSTEMS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08950 - 3 deflection, shrinkage and creep of primary building structure, and other building movements. 1.6 PRODUCT DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING A. Delivery of Materials: Manufactured products shall be delivered in original, unbroken, packages, containers, or bundles bearing the manufacturer's label. B. Storage: Products shall be carefully stored on wood blocking in an area that is protected from the elements in a manner recommended by the product manufacturer. 1. Storage shall be in a manner that will prevent damage to the material or marring of its finish. 2. Store translucent panels on the long edge, several inches above the ground, blocked and tied off and under cover to prevent warping. 3. Allow air to circulate freely around and under the material to prevent excessive condensation in the panels. 4. Combustion type heaters must be properly vented to the exterior to prevent possible staining of the panels. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 APPROVED MANUFACTURERS A. Kalwall Corporation. 2.2 LEED Requirements A. Translucent fiberglass panels shall be manufactured with a minimum of 29% post- consumer and post industrial content by weight. B. Translucent fiberglass panels shall be fabricated within a 500-mile radius of the project site. 2.3 MATERIALS A. Translucent Face Sheets: 1. Provide translucent fiberglass face sheets that have been manufactured by the translucent panel manufacturer with glass fiber reinforced thermoset resins designed for architectural use. 2. Flammability of Interior Face Sheet a. Flame spread maximum of 50 and smoke developed maximum 250 as determined by ASTM E-84. b. Burn extent must be 1" or less as determined by ASTM D-635. c. Faces must not deform, deflect or drip when subjected to fire or flame. 1 d. Interior face sheets to be UL listed. MWH - 04082005 TRANSLUCENT SANDWICH PANEL SYSTEMS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08950 -4 3. Weather ability of Exterior Face Sheet a. Manufacture the exterior face sheet with a full-thickness colorfast resin that does not rely on a coating or film for long-term color stability. 1) ASTM D-224 Delta E (Color Difference): Less than 3.0 units when exposed to 5 years of outdoor weathering in south Florida sloping at 7 degrees facing south. Color difference determined by the average of 3 samples without a protective film or coating to ensure long term color stability. Color stability shall be unaffected by abrasion or scratching. 2) Manufacture the exterior face with a permanent glass erosion barrier embedded beneath the surface to provide maximum long-term resistance to reinforcing fiber. Exterior face surface loss shall not exceed .7 mils and 40 mgs when tested in accordance with ASTM D-4060 employing CS17 abrasive wheels at a head load of 500 grams for 1000 cycles. Films or coatings are not considered permanent and are not acceptable. 3) Provide self-cleaning thermoset 1.2 mils thick acrylic urethane surface molecularly bonded under factory-controlled conditions to the exterior face sheet. This surface finish must be fully field restorable if worn or damaged. 4. Appearance a. Provide face sheets that are uniform in color to prevent splotchy appearance, completely free of ridges and wrinkles, which prevent proper surface contact in bonding to the aluminum grid core. 1) Exterior face sheets: 070" thick, smooth, color as selected from manufacturer's standard line of tinted face sheets. 2) Interior face sheets: .045" thick, smooth, white color. Provide UL listing. b. Clusters of air bubbles or pinholes, which collect moisture and dirt, are not acceptable. 5. Strength: Provide an exterior face sheet tested to repel an impact equal to 70 ft. lbs. without fracture or tear in accordance with UL 972. B. Structural Grid Core: 1. Provide aluminum I-beams of an engineered alloy and temper with provisions for mechanical interlocking of muntin-mullion and perimeter to prevent high and low intersections that inhibit full surface bonding with the face material. I-beam to be a minimum of 7/16" wide, and flange surfaces must be machined to tolerances of not greater than + .002" for flat panels. C. Adhesive: 1. Laminate adhesive: heat and pressure type engineered for structural sandwich panels. 2. Adhesive that passes the testing requirements specified by International Conference of Building Officials "Acceptance Criteria for Sandwich Panel Adhesive". MWH - 04082005 TRANSLUCENT SANDWICH PANEL SYSTEMS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08950 - 5 IF Ir a. Tensile strength, ASTM C-297: minimum 750 PSI (517 kPa) after 2 exposures to 6 cycles each of the aging conditions prescribed by ASTM D-1037. b. Shear strength, ASTM D-1002: after exposure to five (5) separate conditions: 1) 540 PSI (372 kPa) after 50% relative humidity at 73° F (22.8° C) 2) 100 PSI (68.95 kPa) after exposure to 182° F (83.3° C) 3) 800 PSI (551.58 kPa) after Accelerated Aging at room temperature (ASTM D-1037) 4) 250 PSI (172.37 kPa) after Accelerated Aging at 182° F (83.3° C) (ASTM D-1037) 5) 1400 PSI (965.27 kPa) after 500 hour Oxygen Bomb (ASTM D-572) D. Panel Construction 1. Provide a true structural sandwich panel of flat fiberglass sheets bonded with tested adhesives to a grid core of mechanically interlocking aluminum I-beams under a controlled process of heat and pressure. Limit deflection so as not to exceed 1.9 inches at 30 pounds per square foot over 10 feet by ASTM E-72. 2. Adhesive bonding line is to be straight, cover the entire width of the I-beam and • have a neat, sharp edge. 3. Panel thickness: 2-3/4 inches. 4. Panel U-Value: 0.29 insulated 5. Grid pattern: as shown on the drawings. 6. Provide pre-engineered, removable skylight units: Kalwall, low profile "Double Pitch" units. a. Fabricate to sizes indicated on the Drawings. b. Provide lifting eyes at each end of ridge. c. Pitch angle: 20 degrees. d. Class A Roof Burning Brand Test: ASTM E-108. E. Battens and Perimeter Closure System 1. Perimeter Closure System: Extruded 6063-T5 or 6063-T6 aluminum clamp-tite screw type. 2. Pre-apply flexible sealing tape to closure system under factory controlled conditions. MWH - 04082005 TRANSLUCENT SANDWICH PANEL SYSTEMS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08950 - 6 in F. Fleshings 1. 5052 alloy aluminum, minimum 0.040 inches thick. G. Fasteners 1. Fasteners exposed to weather are to be 300 series stainless steel, mill finish. 2. Anchor bolts to the building are to be stainless steel as engineered. H. Finish 1. General: Comply with NAAMM "Metal Finishes Manual" for finish designations and application recommendations, except as otherwise indicated. Apply finishes in factory. Protect finishes on exposed surfaces prior to shipment. Remove scratches and blemishes from exposed surfaces that will be visible after completing finishing process. 2. Color: Provide custom color as selected by the ENGINEER. 3. Two Coat Flourocarbon Coating: a. Aluminum to be finished a minimum 1.0 mil thick full strength 70% resin, 2 coat Flouropolymer system. b. All aluminum shall be thoroughly cleaned, etched and given a chromated conversion pre-treatment before application of the MICA II coating. The coating shall consist of a primer and a pearlescent-pigmented PFV2 topcoat. It shall receive a bake cycle of 17 minutes at 450°F. All finishing procedures shall be one continuous operation in the plant of the manufacturer. c. Manufacturer to furnish an extended 20-year limited warranty for the Kynar/Hylar coating. This limited warranty shall begin on the date of material shipment. PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 ACCEPTABLE INSTALLERS A. Only qualified experienced craftsmen may be employed to install the work of this section. B. Installer must conform to the qualifications specified. 3.2 EXAMINATION A. Inspect the installed work of other trades and verify that it is satisfactorily completed for the proper installation of the panel systems. Do not proceed with installation until any discrepancies have been corrected. 3.3 PREPARATION A. Isolate dissimilar materials from the aluminum system, which may cause damage by electrolysis, with concealed black 10-mil vinyl all-weather corrosion protection tape. MWH -04082005 TRANSLUCENT SANDWICH PANEL SYSTEMS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08950 - 7 B. Protect surrounding work and secure staging with protection as required to prevent damage to adjacent materials. 3.4 INSTALLATION A. Install the translucent systems in strict accordance with approved engineered shop drawings. Seal the system as recommended by the manufacturer. B. Install the translucent systems level, plumb and properly aligned with uniform joints and reveals. Remove and replace any components that may be defective or are damaged during installation. C. After other trades have completed work on adjacent material, carefully inspect the • translucent panel installation and make adjustments necessary to insure proper weather- tight performance. D. Leave the interior and exterior surfaces of the translucent panel systems free of all protective material, identification labels and excess sealant. E. Clean the translucent panel systems within one week of final acceptance in accordance with manufacturer's recommended methods. - END OF SECTION - MWH - 04082005 TRANSLUCENT SANDWICH PANEL SYSTEMS 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 08950 -8 SECTION 10850 - CANOPIES PART 1 -- GENERAL 1.1 SUMMARY A. The CONTRACTOR shall provide pre-manufactured steel canopies, complete and in place, in accordance with the Contract Documents. B. Metal roofing and soffit panels at steel canopies are supplied by others, as specified in Section 07412— Metal Roofing and Siding. 1.2 REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS, CODES, AND STANDARDS A. Codes: 2003 International Building Code (IBC) State of Oregon 2004 Structural Specialty Code B. Commercial Standards: AISC Manual of Steel Construction AISI Design of Light Gauge, Cold-Formed Steel Structural Members ASTM A 36 Carbon Structural Steel ASTM A 123 Zinc (Hot-Dip Galvanized) Coatings on Iron and Steel Products ASTM A 153 Zinc Coating (Hot-Dip) on Iron and Steel Hardware ASTM A 193 Alloy Steel and Stainless Steel Bolting Materials for High Temperature Service ASTM A 194 Carbon and Alloy Steel Nuts for Bolts for High Pressure and High Temperature Service ASTM A 307 Carbon Steel Bolts and Studs, 60,000 psi Tensile Strength ASTM A 325 Structural Bolts, Steel, Heat Treated, 120/105 ksi Minimum Tensile Strength ASTM A 500 Cold-Formed Welded and Seamless Carbon Steel Structural Tubing in Rounds and Shapes ASTM A 653 Steel sheet zinc coated by the hot dip process: Structural quality ASTM A 924 General Requirements for Steel Sheet, metallic coated by the hot dip process ASTM A 992 Steel for Structural Shapes for Use in Building Framing ANSI/AWS D1.1 Structural Welding Code - Steel ANSI/AWS QC1 Qualification and Certification of Welding Inspectors MWH-04082005 CANOPIES 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 10850-1 1.3 DESIGN CRITERIA A. Wind Uplift: The canopy manufacturer shall provide design calculations showing the structure can resist the following uplift load design criteria: 1. Uplift loads as calculated using the 2003 Edition of the IBC. a. Basic Wind Speed: 100 MPH, 3 second gust b. Wind Importance Factor (Iw): 1.15 c. Exposure Category: C B. Drag Loading: The canopy manufacturer shall provide design calculations showing the structure can resist drag loads induced by the following snow load design criteria: a. Ground Snow Load: 25 PSF b. Snow Exposure Factor (Ce): 1.0 c. Snow Importance Factor(Is): 1.0 d. Thermal Factor(Ct): 1.1 C. Seismic Loads: The canopy manufacturer shall provide design calculations showing the structure can resist the following seismic load design criteria: a. Seismic Use Group D b. Spectral Response Coefficient (Ss): 1.06g c. Spectral Response Coefficient (Si): 0.37g d. Site Class: D e. Seismic Design Category: Ill f. Seismic Importance Factor (le): 1.25 1.4 CONTRACTOR SUBMITTALS A. Furnish submittals in accordance with Section 01300 - Contractor Submittals. B. Fabricator Information: Submit data substantiating that materials comply with requirements. C. Quality Assurance Information: Documentation of installer and manufacturer qualifications. D. Submit structural calculations, sealed by a structural engineer registered in the state of Oregon, showing the structural adequacy of the canopy and all connections to the building structure. E. Submit shop drawings showing in detail all canopy components, connections to the building, interface with other materials and methods of construction. Shop drawings MWH-04082005 CANOPIES 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 10850-2 must be prepared under the supervision of and be sealed by the engineer who provides the calculations. F. LEED Product Data: 1. Credit MR 4: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer of the percentage of post-consumer and post industrial content by weight for products with recycled content. 2. Credit MR 5.1: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting manufacturing locations for products manufactured within a 500 mile radius of the project site. 3. Credit MR 5.2: Submit invoices and documentation from manufacturer highlighting location of extraction, recovery or harvest for materials contained in products addressed in item 2 above that originated within a 500 mile radius of the project. 1.5 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. INSTALLER'S QUALIFICATIONS 1. Erection is to be performed by an installer who can show evidence of satisfactory completion of 3 projects of similar size and scope. 2. Installer shall have a minimum of 5 years experience installing pre-engineered steel canopies. B. FABRICATOR'S QUALIFICATIONS 1. Fabricator shall have a minimum of 10 years experience in the manufacture and supplying of steel canopies to the region where the work is to be done. PART 2 -- PRODUCTS 2.1 GENERAL A. Canopies shall be factory-built units of the sizes indicated. Canopies shall be fabricated of steel. 2.2 LEEDTM REQUIREMENTS: A. Pre-manufactured steel canopies supplied for this project shall be fabricated within a 500 mile radius of the project site. 2.3 MATERIALS A. Structural roof deck and trim shall be pre-painted, hot-dip galvanized steel meeting ASTM Specification A-653. 1. Grade 50. 2. 50,000 psi yield strength. 3. Galvanizing shall meet ASTM A-924, G-90 Class. MWH-04082005 CANOPIES 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 10850-3 4. Finish: Kynar 500 Flouropolymer Coating: a. Minimum 1.0 mil thick full strength 70% resin, 2 coat Kynar 500 Flouropolymer coating system. b. Custom color as selected by the ENGINEER. B. Structural beams, columns and other members shall comply with requirements of Section 05100— Structural Steel Framing. C. Stainless Steel: Unless otherwise indicated, stainless steel metalwork, anchors, bolts and other hardware shall be of Type 316 stainless steel PART 3 -- EXECUTION 3.1 FABRICATION A. Fabrication and Erection: Except as otherwise indicated, the fabrication and erection of structural steel shall conform to the requirements of the American Institute of Steel Construction "Manual of Steel Construction." 3.2 WELDING A. Method: Welding shall be by the metal-arc method or gas-shielded arc method as described in the American Welding Society's "Welding Handbook" as supplemented by other pertinent standards of the AWS. Qualification of welders shall be in accordance with the AWS Standards governing same. B. Quality: In assembly and during welding, the component parts shall be adequately clamped, supported, and restrained to minimize distortion and for control of dimensions. Weld reinforcement shall be as indicated by the AWS Code. Upon completion of welding, weld splatter, flux, slag, and burrs left by attachments shall be removed. Welds shall be repaired to produce a workmanlike appearance, with uniform weld contours and dimensions. Sharp corners of material that is to be painted or coated shall be ground to a minimum of 1/32-inch on the flat. C. Weld Finish: All exposed welds shall be ground smooth and flush and shall be polished and anodized. Discoloration of exposed steel surfaces, whether or not due to welding, shall constitute a basis for rejection of the entire assembly. 3.3 GALVANIZING A. Structural steel plates shapes, bars, and fabricated assemblies required to be galvanized shall, after the steel has been thoroughly cleaned of rust and scale, be galvanized in accordance with the requirements of ASTM A 123. Any galvanized part that becomes warped during the galvanizing operation shall be straightened. B. Preparing the surface and applying a coating shall make Field repairs to damaged galvanizing. 1. Surface preparation shall consist of removing oil, grease, soil, and soluble material by cleaning with water and detergent (SSPC SP1) followed by brush off blast cleaning (SSPC SP7), over an area extending at least 4-inches into the undamaged area. MWH-04082005 CANOPIES . 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 10850-4 2. Coating shall be applied to at least 3-mils dry film thickness. Use Zinc-Clad XI by Sherwin-Williams, Galvax by Alvin Products, or Galvite by ZRC Worldwide. . 3.4 STORAGE • A. Storage: Products shall be carefully stored on wood blocking in an area that is protected from the elements in a manner recommended by the product manufacturer. 1. Storage shall be in a manner that will prevent damage to the material or marring of its finish. 3.5 EXAMINATION A. Inspect the installed work of other trades and verify that it is satisfactorily completed for the proper installation of the canopies. Do not proceed with installation until any discrepancies have been corrected. B. Field verify dimensions prior to fabrication. 3.6 PREPARATION A. Work and secure staging with protection as required to prevent damage to adjacent materials. 3.7 INSTALLATION A. Install the canopies in strict accordance with approved engineered shop drawings. Ask) B. Install the canopies level, plumb and properly aligned with uniform joints and reveals. Remove and replace any components that may be defective or are damaged during installation. - END OF SECTION - MWH-04082005 CANOPIES 1530575- DURHAM FACILITY PHASE 4 EXPANSION, IPS PAGE 10850-5